Professional Documents
Culture Documents
Title page
Key to Symbols
Biography
Preface
2
Games 79-82
Games 83-86
Chapter 8 – Blockades and Prophylaxis
Games 87-91
Games 92-96
Games 97-100
Index of Games
3
Fundamental Chess Strategy in 100 Games
by
Boroljub Zlatanovic
www.thinkerspublishing.com
4
Key to Symbols
! a good move
? a weak move
!! an excellent move
?? a blunder
!? an interesting move
?! a dubious move
™ only move
N novelty
‰ lead in development
ʘ zugzwang
= equality
∞ unclear position
© with compensation for the sacrificed material
² White stands slightly better
³ Black stands slightly better
± White has a serious advantage
µ Black has a serious advantage
+– White has a decisive advantage
–+ Black has a decisive advantage
‚ with an attack
ƒ with initiative
„ with counterplay
… with the idea of
¹ better is
≤ worse is
+ check
# mate
5
Biography of Boroljub Zlatanovic
6
Preface
“Strategy without tactics is the slowest route to victory. Tactics without strategy is the noise before
defeat.”
Sun Tzu
Dear reader,
This book will bring something new to your chess library. In our computer era, focus is usually on
openings. Watching recent broadcasts, the new generation would rather choose games of a certain
opening and look for an interesting idea or even a brilliant novelty. I offer, and recommend, a different
concept altogether, based on the famous Soviet school of chess. The focus should be on understanding
strategical concepts, principles and underlying logic. Fashionable opening lines will be forgotten (or re-
evaluated) sooner or later, but understanding cannot be lost, and can be only upgraded. It is sad to see
some players that are well equipped with opening lines, who are unable to realise a big positional
advantage in an endgame. So, our advice is to concentrate on Strategy and Logic.
This book is highly recommended for club players, advanced players and masters, although even higher
rated players may also find it useful. There is no doubt that lower rated players will learn a lot about
thinking processes and decision making, while some logical principles can be put to use by more
advanced players too.
The reader may ask: Why those games? The games presented in this book cannot be classified as the
“best ever” (of course, such a classification is subjective). However, each game was chosen for its logic
and instructive value. Of course, the author understands that readers’ opinion may differ. Either way,
the games are useful for exploring many important points: How to evaluate a position and choose an
appropriate plan? Where to attack? When to attack? When to exchange? How to realise an
advantage?... Learning how to answer such important questions during your future games will improve
your chess knowledge and technique considerably. Always try and introduce logic into your games –
you will be delighted with the results!
The author also chose some instructive games with the idea to illustrate some psychologically
important moments in chess such as the counter-attack, zeitnot or realisation.
The games are separated into chapters, each focusing on a topic. This should facilitate the reader’s
navigation through the book.
Hoping that this book will be as informative as it is interesting, and wishing you all the best in your
future games,
Yours faithfully,
Boroljub Zlatanovic
7
Thank you to everyone that supported me, and to all fellow chess lovers
8
Chapter 1
The Centre
Of course, it is clear that the side that has control over the centre should have good prospects on both
flanks. But, why? Well, just remember the number of squares pieces can control from the centre,
compared to the corner. The difference is evident. It is also evident that pieces placed in the centre can
be easily transferred to any part of the board. Furthermore, if the opponent’s piece is out of play, we
should take action on the opposite part of the board. Like in real war, we should strike before the
opponent has a chance to regroup! And of course, when having more centralised pieces, it is natural to
prevent the opponent from centralising his own pieces or from allowing him to undermine ours.
Let’s remember Nimzowitsch’s famous “principle of two weaknesses”. He wrote that the side having
“better communication lines” should try to create two weaknesses in the opponent’s camp. According
to him, better communication lines (yes, that’s better control over the centre!) would lead to conquering
one of these weaknesses!
Do you think it sounds confusing? Just take a look at the brilliant masterpieces by Karpov and
Rubinstein and you will see this is actually a simple principle (their games are highly instructive for
understanding the principle of centralisation – I can’t remember other players so straight-forwardly
implementing these principles in their games). In this chapter (and, of course, in other chapters) you
will see some brilliantly conducted games in which centralisation was the key principle.
I really hope you will perfectly understand the concept of centralisation and manage to implement it
successfully into your games. “If the opponent neglects centralisation, just improve yours!”
Game 1
Rubinstein – Schlechter
San Sebastian 1912
1.d4 d5 2.Nf3 Nf6 3.c4 e6 4.Nc3 c5 5.cxd5 Nxd5 6.e4 Nxc3 7.bxc3 cxd4 8.cxd4 Bb4+
9
Position after: 8...Bb4+
With this move and the next, Black intends to finish development and exchange some material. That is
generally a good strategy against an opponent’s space advantage.
10.Bxb4 is wrong. After 10...Qxb4+ 11.Qd2 Qxd2+ 12.Kxd2 Ke7 there are no problems for Black.
After the text move, White has an extra tempo – the rook is already on b1!
10...Bxd2+
10...Nc6? is a mistake. After 11.Rxb4! Nxb4 12.Qb3 White is winning. The following line is very
pretty: 12...Qxa2 13.Bb5+ Bd7 14.Bxd7+ Kxd7 15.Ne5+ Ke8 16.Qxb4 Qa1+ 17.Ke2 Qxh1 18.Qb5+
with mate.
10
Position after: 12.Kxd2
White is slightly better due to his space advantage and better development. Black should follow the
idea ...Ke7, ...Rd8, ...b6, ...Ba6 with centralisation and patient improving. But, instead...
12...0-0?
A very bad move, neglecting centralisation principles. How should White continue? Black’s king is
now far from the centre and there must be a good move leading to a serious advantage! Rubinstein’s
next move proves he was one of the greatest players ever – no other player could so easily find such
fine moves. The next move is a testament to his amazing, colossal strategical knowledge.
13.Bb5!
Brilliant move – one of the best ever! It looks like a waste of time, but White will actually win a tempo!
The move has two points. Firstly, it prevents natural developing moves such as ...Nc6, ...Nd7 and
...Bd7. And secondly, it forces the move 13...a6, weakening the b6-square.
13.Bd3 b6 14.Rhc1 Ba6 15.Rc7 Bxd3 16.Kxd3 Na6 looks OK for Black.
15.Rhc1
11
Position after: 15.Rhc1
15...b5
A sad necessity. Black is forced to play with pawns while White’s army enjoys perfectly centralised
squares. Fixed pawns on a6 and b5 will be good targets. There are also weak dark squares on the
queenside.
12
Position after: 18.Ne5!
Absolute harmony! Please, take a look at Rubinstein’s last moves. First with 17.Ke3 he protected the
d4-pawn, making the knight ready for action. With the following move, he prevented a check on g4 –
so the king, pawn and knight nicely collaborate. Each piece supports centralisation and keeps the
opponent’s pieces far from the centre!
There were not many such masters in the past so dedicated to centralisation as Great Akiba was!
18...Bd7 19.g4! h6
20.f4!
20...Be8 21.g5 hxg5 22.fxg5 Nh7 23.h4 Rdc8 24.Rbc1 Rxc7 25.Rxc7
13
Position after: 25.Rxc7
Black’s position is hopeless. There is a big difference in activity! White’s centralised pieces are ultra-
powerful, while the black pieces are out of play.
25...Rd8 26.Ra7
26...f6
26...Rd6 allows a beautiful finale after 27.Ra8 Kf8 28.g6 fxg6 29.Nxg6+ Kf7
14
Position after: 29...Kf7
30.Nh8+! Kf8 31.e5 Now, the white pieces are placed in corners, but this setup decides the game!
30.Be2!
15
30...Be8
30...Bxe2? 31.Nf7+
33...Kh8
33...Kg6 is bad, there is a risk Black’s king will be mated. 34.h5+ Kg5 35.Rg7+ Kh4 36.exf5 exf5
37.Nh6 is winning. Now 37...Nf8 38.Nxf5+ Kh3 39.Bf1+ Kh2 40.Rg2+ Kh3 41.Rg3+ Kh2 42.Kf2
leads to mate.
34.Ne5 fxe4
16
Position after: 34...fxe4
It looks like Black consolidated his position by exchanging some material. But, Rubinstein’s next move
proves Black is desperately lost – after perfectly carrying out the game strategically, there must be
some tactics coming up!
White chooses the fastest plan. Black’s king is in danger and White goes directly for the kill.
17
Position after: 39.Kg6
Black resigns! What a triumph! From the opening, the white pieces dominated in the centre, while
Black was not allowed to activate his pieces, even for a moment! Black made only one bad move –
castling, and it was enough for Rubinstein to demonstrate his amazing understanding of chess strategy,
giving a perfect example to his followers!
1-0
Game 2
Karpov – Seirawan
Skelleftea 1989
1.d4 d5 2.c4 dxc4 3.e4 e5 4.Nf3 Bb4+ 5.Bd2 Bxd2+ 6.Qxd2 exd4 7.Qxd4 Qxd4 8.Nxd4 Bd7 9.Bxc4
18
Position after: 9.Bxc4
The game started pretty sharply and an uncommon line was chosen by the players. But, after
exchanges, it is clear the game will be a positional one. Actually, Black should be satisfied with the
position that arose from the opening. The biggest problem for Black is his opponent. Karpov always
played superbly in positions with a small but stable positional advantage – such positions were his
trademark throughout his career.
White is slightly better due to a small space advantage and slightly better development. White is about
to harmoniously place his pieces in the centre, seeking the initiative. With his next move, Black tries to
stop this.
9...Nc6 10.Nxc6!
This is the only move that keeps the advantage. It looks like a loss of tempo, but other moves would
waste time.
A) 10.Nb3? 0-0-0! with the idea of ...Nb4 or ...Ne5. Surprisingly, Black gets the initiative
immediately.
B) 10.Nf3?! Be6!? 11.Bxe6 fxe6 12.Nc3 Nf6 then placing the king on e7 and occupying the d-file
looks very solid for Black.
C) 10.Nb5? can even be fatal 10...0-0-0 11.Bxf7? Ne5 12.Bxg8 Bxb5 13.Be6+ Kb8 14.Nc3 Ba6 and
White is hopeless.
10...Bxc6 11.Nc3
19
Position after: 11.Nc3
11...Rd8?
This is the first imprecise move. Black wants to prevent White from castling long, but White actually
wants to place his king on e2 and then e3. As a result, Black will have problems with the f7-pawn,
which will soon become clear.
11...Nf6! was correct. After 12.f3 Ke7 13.Ke2 Rhd8 White’s advantage is only visual and not
significant.
20
Position after: 14.Rhd1
Comparing this position with the aforementioned line, it is clear that Black has the “wrong” rook on d8.
Evidently, he cannot capture on d1 followed by placing the other rook on d8 because the pawn on f7 is
hanging. Actually, it is not obvious how to effectively activate the h8-rook without wasting time.
14...a5
Probably played with the idea to “activate the majority”. Of course, that is not the way to activate.
Another idea might be the activation of the rook via the a-file. Black is forced to play on the flank –
that is a bad sign. He lost the struggle for the centre and is paying the price.
15.Rac1
21
Position after: 16...Rb8
Preparing to advance the b-pawn, which is ignored by White. This move would only weaken the c5-
square. Another move away from the centre.
17.Ke3 g6
22
is bad for Black. White moves his knight to d4 and rook to c1, with various threats.
18.Bb3
18...Ra8
Black still wanders. Although, it is difficult to suggest anything else. Whenever the bishop on c6
moves, White will play e5, which is crushing. On the kingside, Black cannot find any single reasonable
move either. He is forced to wait...
19.Rd4!
Typical Karpov move. After any move far away from the centre from Black, he answers with a strong
centralisation move, building stronger and stronger both positional and psychological pressure. The
rook from d4 prevents ...a4 and is also ready to be transferred to the kingside after advancing the e-
pawn.
19...Nd7
What else?
20.Bd5
Black voluntarily reduced control over the d5-square and White immediately takes his chance.
23
20.Nd5+ is wrong. After 20...Bxd5 21.Bxd5 Ne5! 22.Bxb7 Rb8 Black is not worse. His pieces finally
become active.
20...Ra6 21.f4!
Improving the kingside position, enabling e5 and waiting for the opponent to capture first.
21...f6 22.h4!
22.g4? g5! and the black knight finally gets the perfect outpost on e5.
22...h6
23.g3
Don’t rush!
24
Position after: 24...Kd8
25.Nc3!
Every simplification would be in Black’s favour. Black wanted to play ...Rd6 followed by ...c6.
25...Rb6 26.Rd2!
The rook’s job on the 4th rank is over. It now goes to the 2nd rank to support the move h5. The point is
that White wants to eliminate Black’s g6-pawn and create an outpost on f5! With three connected
pawns on the same rank, it is very natural to attack the middle one – if it is exchanged or advanced, an
outpost would be created (see comments on White’s move 22).
A) 26.b3? is the wrong move order. After 26...Rc6, whatever White chooses, the rook cannot easily be
placed on the 2nd rank. Actually, if Black moves the rook to some other square, the move b3 would not
be needed at all.
B) 26.h5 of course was strong too, but Karpov did not want to change the rhythm of play. Indeed, why
go for complications if everything is going smoothly?
25
Position after: 28.Kf3
Both the knight and king are ready to occupy the f5-square.
28...Ke7 29.Ne2?!
31.Rxd6 Kxd6 32.e5+ Ke6 would complicate White’s task. The text move leaves Black in a hopeless
situation.
31...Rxd5
26
Position after: 33.Ne3
Black resigned without waiting for White to respond. The knight is trapped. A game won in typical
“Karpovian” style. Centralisation and patient improving with fine realisation at the end. Very often he
would leave opponents confused after the game, desperately wanting to understand where they erred.
No obvious mistakes – just superb Karpov style and technique.
1-0
Game 3
Reti – Nimzowitsch
Marienbad 1925
27
Position after: 5...Nf6
Both sides played unconventionally, but now the pawn setup starts to resemble the French Defence,
exchange variation structure. It really looks like Black has no problems – White has spent time to
transfer the knight to c2.
28
Position after: 9.c5
9...Bf5
Evidently, Black will first activate his troops. White must be wary of attacks with ...b6. There is already
the direct threat to the d4-pawn.
9...b6?! 10.Bb5 Bd7 11.0-0 0-0 doesn’t give Black anything. Nimzowitch managed to attack the white
pawn chain in better fashion.
10.Bd3
10.Bb5 is another option. 10...0-0 11.Ne3 [11.Bxc6 bxc6 must be at least comfortable for Black, or
even slightly better.] 11...Bg6 12.0-0 Qd7 is one of the possible continuations. Black is doing perfectly
fine.
29
Position after: 11...b6!
12.0-0
30
13.a3 [13.b5? Nb4! and the white position collapses. Now the point of Black’s 9th move is clear – the
queen is provoked to the d3-square, and the knight jumps to b4 with tempo.] 13...axb4 14.axb4 Rxa1
15.Nxa1 bxc5 16.bxc5 Ne4 with good chances for Black.
12...0-0 13.Bg5
13...h6!
13...bxc5 14.dxc5 Ne5 15.Qg3 attacking the knight on e5, Black doesn’t have time to play ...c6, fixing
the c5-pawn on a dark square and supporting the strong d5-pawn.
14.Bh4
14.Bxf6 Bxf6 was another option for White. Black’s position is very solid.
31
Position after: 15...Ne5
16.Qd4
16...Ng6
And here is the point behind Black’s 13th move. The bishop on h4 is attacked and Black is able to
support the pawn on d5!
17.Bg3
17.Bxf6 Bxf6 18.Qxd5 Bxc3 19.Qxd8 Rfxd8 20.bxc3 Rd5 must be in Black’s favour. His rook on c5
will both attack the weak pawn on c3 and protect weak c7-pawn.
17...c6 18.Nb4
32
Position after: 18.Nb4
Intending to put that knight on d3, protecting c5 and blockading the passed d-pawn. White understands
the blockade on d4 would not be efficient, and is ready to establish it on d3. On the other hand, Black
successfully finished development and already is slightly better. The main factor for such an evaluation
is White’s exposed pawn on c5, fixed on a dark square. Black’s bishop will be more dangerous. Even
the black knights can more easily find good squares. In a few moves, Black’s pieces will dominate the
centre, while White’s pieces will be without harmony.
18...Rc8
Better than to use the queen to protect c6. This rook will temporarily be a defender – the b8-square is
controlled by the bishop on g3. Meanwhile, the black queen can be active, probably on a5.
19.h3?!
How to punish White for this inaccuracy? Instead of taking care of Black’s initiative in the centre,
White just ignored it. Well, let’s go for centralisation! Nimzowitsch convincingly increases the
initiative, proving White must play very precisely. He decided to improve his centre, while increasing
harmony and putting more pressure on the c5-pawn.
19.Nd3 was much better. The move played in the game is just a waste of time. Black would never go
for ...Nh5.
33
Position after: 21.Nd3
21...Qa5
21...Ne6 was natural and also a very good move. But, Nimzowitsch decided to give White the chance
to exchange queens.
22.Qa4
22.b4? Qa3! and after ...Ne6, Black would destroy the white pawn structure by playing ...a5.
34
Position after: 24...Ne6
Please, remember this position. You can see total disharmony in White’s army. And full harmony in
Black’s. Take a look at the white knights, which must protect the weak pawn on c5, especially the one
on a4. At the same time, the black knights are placed perfectly, controlling the entire centre. Notice, it
is very useful to place knights and pawns on squares of the same colour. Placing them this way, you
will control both light and dark squares. Also, the pawns can protect the knights. In our game, the black
knights are truly dominant, but they would not be as dangerous without the support from the pawns.
Black is much better.
25.b4 Nd4!
35
Position after: 25...Nd4!
26.Rfe1
26...Bh4
36
Position after: 26...Bh4
He who dominates in the centre can play on the flanks. The text move keeps the knight on e4 active and
puts pressure on the f2-pawn.
27.Be5?
30.Rxe1 Nc2–+
30...Bg3! 31.Nf3
31...Re8!
32.Rd1 Re6
With the idea to play ...Ng5 and then penetrate with ...Rf6–...Rf2.
33.Rc1 Kf8
37
34.Nc3 Nxc3 35.Rxc3 Re4 36.a3
White desperately wants to get rid of Black’s ultra-active pieces. But simplifications are in Black’s
favour – he has an extra pawn.
38...f5!
A demonstration of power.
38
Position after: 42.Rxd5+
It looks like White has achieved a lot. He reduced the material on the board and activated his rook...
but, there is one problem – he cannot capture on f5.
42...Kc6 43.Rd4
39
Position after: 45.Nd2
The rest is a matter of technique. Not a problem for a master such as Nimzowitsch.
45...Kd4 46.Ke2 Bf4 47.Nb3+ Kc4 48.Na5+ Kc3 49.Nb7 b4 50.Nc5 Kc2 51.g3 Bxg3
White resigned. One of the most illustrative games ever on the topic of centralisation and harmony. A
masterpiece by the great Aron.
0-1
Game 4
Bogoljubow – Reti
Moravska Ostrava 1923
A dubious move, although still playable. The problem is that White connected it with a bad plan.
5...c5
Of course, Black strikes in the centre. This natural reflex is even better due to White’s diversion on his
last move.
Black did not make a single imprecise move, so White must not go for a “winning immediately”
40
approach. There is rarely a punishment for an opponent that has played normal and healthy moves.
With his next manoeuvre, White neglects the centre and gives away full control to his opponent.
8.Nd6+?
8...Bxd6 9.Qxg7
41
Position after: 9.Qxg7
9...Bxe5?
Black returns the favour. But, this mistake is simply miscalculation or... no calculation at all. Knowing
Richard Reti, such a fine positional player, we can suppose that he was dedicated to solving problems
in the centre, probably omitting to search for a direct win.
9...Bb4+ led to a fairly easy win after 10.c3 dxc3 11.Qxh8+ Nf8 12.Kd1 cxb2 13.Bxb2 Qb6.
Having near material balance (a pawn for an exchange is not a significant deficit) and superior activity
with such a naked White king, Black will reach an absolutely winning position. White’s pieces are
undeveloped and scattered and defeat is inevitable.
42
Position after: 11...Nxf6
Black temporarily has an extra pawn and White needs some time to return material. His advantage of
the bishop pair should not be significant, because of the dangerous black pawn avalanche in the centre.
A strong central pawn formation is a more important positional factor and Black is already a bit better.
14.0-0
43
Position after: 14.0-0
14...f6!
A good move, preparing to gain space in the centre. 14...a6 forces White to take on c6, but this will be a
waste of time.
The text move is better, because it also forces White to take on c6 and must be played to prepare ...e5.
15.Bxc6 bxc6
That move should be preferred – Black’s avalanche in the centre looks even more impressive now.
16.Nxd4
44
Position after: 16.Nxd4
16...c5
This is the more precise attack on the knight. The move ...e5 is unstoppable as well.
16...e5 allows White to fight for the c5-square after 17.Nb3.
17.Ne2 Kf7
There are many good moves here. Black chose this one, it is a matter of style...
Of course, other good options include 17...e5, 17...Rc8, 17...Rb8, 17...Rg8.
45
Position after: 19...e5
As a result of the risky (and bad) excursion of the white knight, Black is better. White has no more
bishop pair, and the black pawn centre looks strong and impressive. Also, Black has more space, better
piece centralisation and the better bishop.
Note: do not think Black has all that advantage randomly. No, usually one advantage leads to another...
White has problems in finishing development, and even after finishing it there will be a lack of
harmony in his camp due to a lack of space.
20.Ba3 Rac8
That rook, of course. Black predicts the other rook will probably be needed on the d-file, in order to
prepare advancing the pawns.
21.Rad1 d4
46
Position after: 21...d4
Please, remember the following quote: “pawns and knights should stay on squares of the same colour,
and bishops on opposite ones.”
Take a look at the black central pawns and minor pieces – there is full harmony! All central squares are
perfectly covered! Now, imagine the black knight and bishop swapping places – instead of harmony
there would only be light-squared weaknesses!
22.Nc1 Nf5
24...Bf5 was also a good move, but still the text move should be preferred.
25.b4
Only one brief look at the position is enough to reach an evaluation – White is hopeless.
47
Position after: 25.b4
His pieces are cramped while Black’s pieces dominate, together with the central pawns. Here, Black
found a beautiful manoeuvre...
29.Bb2 c3
48
Position after: 29...c3
30.Nb3
This move delays resignation. Black is forced to find more good moves to convert.
30...Bxb3! 31.axb3
49
Position after: 34...Rxd3
35.Bxd2 Rxd2
Taking with the pawn was also winning. Black transposes to a trivial endgame – the rook behind the
passed pawn decides the game.
36.Ra1 Ke6 37.Kf1 Rxf2+ 38.Kxf2 c2 39.Rc1 Kd5 40.Ke3 Rc3+ 41.Kd2 Kd4
50
Position after: 41...Kd4
White is in some kind of zugzwang. Black’s king will inevitably collect the white kingside pawns, with
a win to follow.
42.h4 Rd3+
White resigned. A terrible defeat. Never forget about the centre and never go for a flank attack if your
centre is not secured. White’s centre simply collapsed in this game after his 8th move. Afterwards,
White could not get control back over the centre and the punishment was well deserved.
0-1
51
Game 5
Stolberg – Botvinnik
Moscow 1940
6...c5
Black decides to crush the white pawn centre immediately. 6...dxc4 7.Bxc4 c5 was also very solid.
8...Nxd5 is bad. After 9.Nxd5 Qxd5 10.a3 Ba5 11.Qc2, White attacks pawns both on c5 and h7 with a
clear advantage.
9.a3
52
Position after: 9.a3
9...cxd4
9...Bxc3 10.bxc3 c4 11.Bc2 b5 is also playable, of course. But that plan simplifies White’s task. White
will organise the e4-advance with Ng3 and f3. The text move poses more problems to White.
10.exd4
10.axb4 dxc3 11.bxc3 Ne5 gives comfortable play to Black. White will dominate the d4-square, but on
the other hand Black can use the squares c4 and e4.
10...Bd6 11.h3
11.Bf4 was a logical move, finishing development and exchanging a bad bishop for a good one. Instead
of that, White made his bishop a worse piece... You’ll see.
11...h6
53
Position after: 11...h6
12.b4?!
White wanted to secure a spot for the queen on b3. Alas, advancing pawns on the queenside misses its
mark. In open positions, pawn play is rarely promising. Piece play should be preferred!
54
Position after: 14...Qd7
Black harmoniously finished development and is already better. The idea of the last few moves is the
exchange of the light-squared bishops.
15.f4?
It looks like suicide. One is not allowed to play on the flank if worse off in the centre. Also, attacking
the black king is just an illusion. Take a look at the pawn on f4, restricting the rook, bishop and knight.
Try to move or exchange such pawns in your games. And, what’s more, e4 and e3 are now desperately
weak squares. Black’s idea of exchanging light-squared bishops is even more logical and dangerous
now.
17.b5?
The game is over now. White invites so many black pieces into his camp. The knight goes to c4, along
with future invasions on the c- and e-files. White is without counterplay. With careless advances, White
simply gave Black full control over the centre.
17...Bxd3 18.Qxd3
18.bxc6 Qf5–+
55
Position after: 19...Nc4
20.Bc1
20.Nxd5 is not good. After 20...Nxd5 21.Qxc4 Ne3 22.Bxe3 Rxe3 things are bad for White. There is
no good place for the knight to retreat to and Black will keep the initiative with ...Rc8.
20...Rac8
White cannot oppose the black occupation of light central squares. His position is hopeless.
21.Ra2 Bf8
Supporting the d5-pawn and freeing the d6-square for the knight.
22.a4
This leaves the b4-square without control, but what else is there to suggest for White...?
22...Bb4
56
Position after: 22...Bb4
Black would be happy to exchange the bishop for the knight – the e4-square will be easier to control.
Trying to die for something... With some precise moves, Black eliminates all threats on the kingside.
57
27...Bf6! 28.Bxh6
It looks like White got some chances, but that was just an illusion.
28...Bxd4+
The pawn on d4 is more important than the one on h6. See how Black invades on central squares. Very
soon, a storm will break out in the centre.
If you follow games by such great masters, chess looks like a really simple game. Actually, it is
sometimes. Dominate the centre and you will dominate all over the board.
32.Qb1 Rc4
Black used his last move to achieve full centralisation. At the same time, White regrouped his troops...
to the first rank! Botvinnik convincingly realises his advantage.
58
Position after: 37.Qc2
Not that many squares are available for the white pieces...
Dominating in the centre gives you excellent prospects on both flanks. Botvinnik chooses the fastest
way – he attacks White’s king. White’s cramped pieces on the queenside are of no help.
40.Qc1
59
Position after: 40.Qc1
40...Rxh3+! 41.gxh3 d4
A sad fate for White. Paralysed pieces in open positions is not a common site. There is no way to
prevent ...Qd5, with mate. White resigned. A terrible defeat. Recklessly advancing pawns, White
invited the black pieces to comfortable central positions. The realisation of a big positional advantage
should be carefully studied and it depicts Botvinnik’s impressive technique.
0-1
Game 6
Tal – Kochyev
Leningrad 1977
1.e4 c5 2.Nf3 e6 3.d4 cxd4 4.Nxd4 a6 5.Nc3 Qc7 6.Bd3 Nc6 7.Be3 Nf6 8.0-0
8...Ne5!?
9.h3
60
The dark-squared bishop is a valuable one.
11...Qxc4 12.Qd3!
The last move strengthens the centre and makes ...b4 useless.
12...Bb7?!
12...Qc7 was perhaps better. Black renews the motif of advancing ...b4. The waste of time was not
significant.
13.a4!
Simply an excellent move. Using the fact that the queen is protected by the b-pawn, White strikes.
Black’s advance ...b4 forces him to prematurely capture on d3.
61
Position after: 15.Nce2
This is the point. White’s pawns on d3 and e4 restrict the black knight and b7-bishop. They also
perfectly fit with White’s minor pieces and will make for a perfect shield for the king later on. Black’s
advanced queenside pawns are in trouble.
White wants to occupy the important a5-square with the knight, so Black would be forced to advance
the a-pawn, making it vulnerable. Also, Black is unable to open the position – any advance will only
create weaknesses. White will gain control over the c-file. And, most importantly, White has a strong
and harmonious formation in the centre, while Black has only exposed queenside pawns. The diagnosis
is evident – White is much better.
15...Bc5 16.Kf2!
Protecting the bishop, activating the king and supporting the centre.
16...d6 17.Nb3
White’s centralised cavalry starts to dance. So many weak squares on the queenside are on the menu.
62
Position after: 19.Ned4
Both sides have activated their troops. White must find a plan to grasp the initiative and reach some
degree of harmony.
21.Nd2!
63
Again, a simple and strong solution. Black’s main weakness is the pawn on a5. White regroups to place
the knights on b3 and c4.
Once you find the opponent’s weakness, make it your target! Tal effectively uses his cavalry in this
game.
25...Kd8 [or 25...Kb8 26.Nec6+! Bxc6 27.Nxc6+ Ka8 28.dxe4] 26.Nxf7+ Ke8 27.Ng5 with an
advantage for White.
23...d5 24.Nc5
64
Position after: 24.Nc5
24...Ra7
24...Rc6 25.Ndb3+–
25.Rc1
Compare White’s control over the centre to Black’s. From a strategical point of view, the game is
already over. There are, of course, remaining technical issues that Tal has no problems with.
65
Position after: 26...Kb8
How to penetrate? How to attack the weakness on a5? Well, there is a simple solution.
27.Nxb7
Tal chooses the simplest and most direct way. Black’s pieces will get some activity, but that is
irrelevant.
27...Kxb7
66
Position after: 31.Kd4!
Desperately trying to activate the rook, but this costs Black more material. The rest is trivial.
33.fxe5 fxe5+ 34.Nxe5 Rc2 35.Nxd7 Kxd7 36.Ra7+ Ke6 37.Rxg7 Rxb2
67
38.g4 h5 39.gxh5 b3 40.h6
Black resigned. This game shows the great champion Tal under a new light. This game, like many
others of his remarkable games, are all important and instructive on the topic of gaining and supporting
central initiative.
1-0
Game 7
Tarrasch – Noa
Hamburg 1885
Young Tarrasch preferred this move. Later, he would create theory on 3.Nd2.
8...Bb4+
With this move, Black wants to cause confusion in White’s camp, pressuring both the b2- and d4-
pawns and instantly finishing development. The downside is exchanging the dark-squared bishop.
68
Position after: 12...Nb6
The knight will be badly placed on b6, but it liberates d7 for the bishop.
13.Nc3
13...Rd8?!
Strange move. Black probably wanted to be able to take with the d-pawn after the knights are
exchanged on c4. Still this “mysterious” rook move should not be considered as good.
13...Nc4 is nothing special in view of 14.Bxc4 Qxc4 15.Ne2 Nb4 16.0-0 with a small advantage for
White.
14.Nb5! Bd7
69
Position after: 17.Kxd2
17...Nc8
Black’s knight achieved nothing on b6 and it is reasonable to exchange it for the knight on d6. But,
White keeps the knight alive – a good idea because of the space advantage White has.
17...a6 was more logical, after which the exchange of knights would be inevitable.
18.Nb5 a6 19.Nc3
70
Position after: 21.b3
With the idea to protect the knight on a4 and avoid some discovered attack from the d7-bishop.
21...Nb4
An unreasonable move. White will, of course, allow the bishop to be captured. One simple attack and
the knight must retreat.
White gains space on the queenside while eliminating the possibility of ...Na5. White is ready to
organise a kingside expansion. He who stands better in centre can and should play on the flanks.
23...h6
This move actually does nothing to prevent White’s expansion on the kingside.
23...h5!? would be a more typical plan. By putting pawns on light squares (g6 and h5), Black will be
able to exchange many pawns on the kingside, which is generally a good idea when playing for a draw.
24.h4 Nb8
71
Position after: 24...Nb8
Black loosens the pressure on the base of the pawn chain, d4. His pieces are stuck. They look
centralised, but they are actually without prospects, blocked by the pawns on d5 and e6. White’s pieces
are centralised, and in much better shape. They are very active and can easily be deployed to anywhere
on the board.
25.Ke3
The king should not be excused – every piece should be placed optimally before pawn action is taken!
Previous moves from both sides were logical. Both sides consistently regrouped their pieces: doubled
the rooks and improved the position of their kings. White is ready for action.
72
Position after: 29.Nd2
White has better control over the central squares and having more space gets you the most out of a
position. Before further pawn action, the knight goes to c5.
29.f5 of course, was possible. Black would wait with 29...Nd7.
29...Nd7 30.Nb3
73
Position after: 32...dxc4
33.N5e4
Of course, this knight. The other one is a blockading piece and should stay put.
33...b5
33...h5!? would be an interesting try. 34.Nd6 [34.gxh5 Nf5+ is good for Black.] 34...hxg4 35.Nxc8
Nf5+ gives solid compensation to Black.
Missing an opportunity on move 33, Black is forced to patiently endure White’s action. Situations in
which the opponent controls the entire centre are very unpleasant.
35...Bd7 36.Rf2
74
Position after: 36.Rf2
36...Nd5+?!
Black wants to eliminate the blockading piece, which is generally a good idea. Still, the c-pawn can
easily be stopped. More important is the fact that the white phalanx now gets great dynamic energy.
75
After full preparation, White chips away at Black’s kingside defence.
40.g6! f6?
40...fxg6 was better, but after 41.fxg6 Be6 42.Kf4, Black’s position looks hopeless.
41.Re2!
44.Rxe5!
44...Kf8
45.Nf7
Very neat final manoeuvre. The knight inevitably gets to h7 and the rooks will then penetrate.
Black resigned.
76
1-0
Game 8
Averbakh – Panno
Buenos Aires 1954
6.Bg5
Averbakh chose this variation to later be named after him. Black’s first reaction is logical – opening the
diagonal for the g7-bishop...
77
Position after: 9.Bd2
However, his next reaction is completely wrong – he shuts off the bishop. Even more importantly, he
loses the possibility to undermine White’s central pawn structure.
As a result, Black will have less space and inactive pieces.
9...e5?
In this position, the d6-pawn is the “double base” of the pawn chain. Black, naturally, should insist on
preparing the advances ...b5 and ...f5. The first one is already stopped and, with his next move, White
prevents the other. White’s next move is considered thematic and logical nowadays, but in those days it
was a revolutionary idea!
9...e6 is logical and leads to a balanced position after 10.Nf3 exd5 11.exd5 [or 11.cxd5 Re8] 11...Re8.
10.g4!
The idea is to prevent ...f5. Also, White may attack the opponent’s king. With the centre being blocked,
action must take place on the flank.
10...Ne8
11.h4 f5 12.h5!
That is the point, White crushes Black’s kingside, alongside the Black king’s shelter. Please, look at the
white king, it is perfectly safe in the centre. The centre is blocked and flank activities are encouraged!
78
Position after: 12.h5!
12...f4
With the idea to enclose the d2-bishop. White’s next move is forced, but still multi-purposed and very
strong.
13.g5!
Otherwise, Black will advance his own g-pawn, refuting White’s attack. Now, White threatens to play
14.h6!, locking in the black bishop forever. The other idea is to achieve an important strategical goal –
the exchange of the light-squared bishops!
13...Rf7
Only move.
79
Position after: 15...Qxc8
White has achieved a lot. Black’s pieces are cramped and his king is in trouble. White is ready to place
the king on e2, to connect rooks and continue attacking. His next move is proof of a deep understanding
of this position and chess in general... The knight makes a shield for the king on e2 and is ready to jump
to h4 and attack the g6-pawn.
16.Nf3!
Less advanced players would probably go for 16.f3, but there is no necessity to support the pawn chain.
It can be, if needed, played later.
80
Position after: 18.Rh4
The pawn on g6 is protected, so White doubles up, using h4 for his rook. He is even ready to triple.
Everything is going smoothly. Black has no counterplay. Don’t forget, by advancing both c- and e-
pawns, Black lost the chance to open either the c- or e-file, which would have brought him some active
play.
From a strategical point of view, the game is over. White just needs to find the final strike.
23...Rb8
81
Position after: 23...Rb8
Conducting the game in purely strategical fashion so far, tactics are now required. This can be observed
in countless games.
24.Bxf4! Qc7
24...exf4 25.Rh4+–
25.Qh2
The bishop is brave and untouchable. Its next target is the e5-pawn. Black prevents another sacrifice.
25...Nd7 26.Qh3
26...Nf8
82
Position after: 26...Nf8
27.Rxf8+!
Beautiful, isn’t it? White keeps the bishop hanging and goes for the next sacrifice.
A convincing defeat.
83
1-0
Remember, in positions with central pawn chains, action must be taken on the flank(s). Though one
must tread carefully, as any inaccurate opening or closing of the position can be fatal. Black’s move
...e5 was a serious mistake. Throwing away the opportunity to undermine White’s centre he hoped for
the advances ...b5 and ...f5. White turned those thrusts into illusions and Black was unable to achieve
anything active. He was forced to wait for White’s attack and defeat was unavoidable.
A brilliant masterpiece by Averbakh, which served as a real torch for the next generations.
84
Chapter 2
Bishop versus Knight
Bishop or knight? The eternal dilemma! The legendary Bobby Fischer would vote for the bishop. Some
other authorities such as Nimzowitsch would prefer the knight. The truth lies somewhere in between.
Of course, it is clear that the bishop usually dominates in open positions, while the knight should be
favoured in blocked positions. But, what does that “usually” mean? Are there exceptions? Sure, a
bishop can dominate even in “blocked” positions if a certain diagonal is very important. Conversely, a
knight can dominate in “open” positions, where it may occupy an outpost or an influential square.
Pawn structure definitely determines minor pieces’ prospects. Therefore, it is extremely important to be
able to predict the properties of all kinds of pawn structures. Nowadays, it is not enough to start
thinking about the endgame in the middlegame. No, today’s masters base their opening plans on
potential endgames!
This chapter (and book) will help you discover many of the properties that belong to the bishop and
knight, which will undoubtedly open new horizons.
Game 9
Efimenko – Neverov
Rivne 2005
1.e4 c5 2.Nf3 e6 3.d4 cxd4 4.Nxd4 a6 5.Be2 Qc7 6.0-0 Nf6 7.Nc3 Nc6 8.Be3 Bb4 9.Na4 Be7
10.Nxc6 bxc6 11.Nb6 Rb8 12.Nxc8 Qxc8 13.Bd4
85
Not a common Sicilian line. White got the bishop pair advantage, but Black cannot complain – he has a
stable position without weaknesses.
13...c5
13...d5 putting pawns on light-squares seems more logical, but leads to the opening of the position after
14.exd5 cxd5 15.c4 which must be in White’s favour.
Black has reached some kind of Hedgehog setup, controlling the centre well...
Now he decides to advance. A double-edged move. It frees the black pieces, but also helps White to
open the position for his bishops.
18.exd5
18.e5 Nd7 19.f4 c4 20.bxc4 Rc6!? 21.Qh3 Nb6 22.Bd3 g6 23.Rf3 Re8 24.Rg3 Qc7 25.Bd4 Nxc4„
86
Position after: 25...Nxc4„
18...Nxd5
18...exd5 keeps a solid pawn structure, but Black wanted to use the d-file.
19.Be5
19...Rd8
87
19...Bf6 20.Bxf6 Nxf6 21.Rad1²
20.Qg3
The situation has stabilised. White enjoys a long-lasting advantage due to having a better minor piece
and a more compact pawn structure. However, the black major pieces are ready to fight back. Black is
ready to double or triple, so White’s urgent task is to neutralise the opponent’s domination of the d-file.
22.Rfd1 h6 23.h3?
88
Position after: 23.h3?
23...Rd5
23...Nd5 24.Rd2²
24.Bc4
A) 24.Rxd5 exd5=
B) 24.Bf3 Rg5 25.Qf4 e5„
24...Rd7
24...Rg5 25.Qf3
25.Qe5
89
Position after: 25.Qe5
A very fine move. Having no direct options, White goes for a normal, centralising move. Unpleasant
for Black.
25...Qd8?
90
Position after: 27.Rd1!
27...Qc8
Another fine move. The idea is to fix the weakness on a6. If Black prevents it, a hole on b5 will be a
new important positional factor.
29...Ne8
91
Position after: 29...Ne8
30.Be2
Intending to transfer the bishop to a better diagonal. Meanwhile, the black knight wanders, having no
good outposts to aim for.
30.a5 Rc6 31.c3 was another evidently good option.
30...Rc6
30...Rb4 31.Qe3²
92
Position after: 32.Bf3
32...Rc7
33.Rd6
Black’s position is hopeless. White has infiltrated and material loss is unavoidable.
33...Nd7 34.Qc3
34.Qf4±
34...c4
93
Position after: 34...c4
35.b4!
Of course, advancing the majority and leaving the weak c4-pawn on the board.
94
Position after: 39.Qc6!
39...Qd8
39...Qxc6 40.Bxc6+–
40.Qa8
40.Qxa6 was a better move from the engine’s point of view. However, the text move should be the first
choice. Maybe it wins a bit more slowly, but also definitely avoids some risk.
95
Position after: 42...Nc7
Black protects the pawn, maintaining material balance. But, White perfectly evaluated the position –
Black is desperately lost. The c4-pawn cannot be protected. The knight is paralysed and hinders the
monarch.
96
45...Nd5
Only chance to keep the material balance, but now a typical realisation method takes place – reduction
and transfer into a winning pawn endgame. White wins because he will create an outside passed pawn
on the queenside. Here, we suggest the reader ensures White wins in all variations. The game is over.
45...Kd6 46.Kc3+–
49.c3
49.g4 was better from a pedagogical point of view – the white c-pawn can be used for a tempo, if
needed.
49...f6 50.g4 g6 51.h4 h5 52.gxh5 gxh5 53.f3 Kd6 54.b5 a5 55.b6 Kc6 56.b7 Kxb7 57.Kxd5
Black resigned. Patient play by White exploited the advantage of a superior bishop. Black was unable
to find a stable spot for the knight and the result was logical.
1-0
Game 10
Marshall – Lasker
USA 1907
1.e4 e5 2.Nf3 Nc6 3.Bb5 Nf6 4.d4 exd4 5.0-0 Be7 6.e5
97
Position after: 6.e5
Marshall was known as a fabulous attacking player, but Lasker was fearless and ready to take risks.
6...Ne4 7.Nxd4
9.Nxe7+ Nxe7 gives nothing to White. The bishop pair cannot be efficiently used and e5 is exposed.
98
Position after: 12...f6
Lasker takes a chance to put pressure on White’s position. Marshall counters logically.
13.f3 fxe5!?
A wise decision. He knew about Marshall’s personality and character and decided to attack him.
Marshall was never a fan of defending positions, even with a material advantage. He would always
rather be the one to sacrifice.
13...Ng5 was the normal continuation. Although this is playable, Lasker makes a psychological choice.
He knows that the complications that would arise after the piece sacrifice would put his opponent on
the back foot. Lasker was also a brilliant attacking player and did not like to be under attack himself.
14.fxe4 d4
99
Position after: 14...d4
15.g3
A) 15.Bd2? Bg4 16.Qc1 Rf2! 17.Bg5 Rxg2+ 18.Kxg2 Bh3+ 19.Kh1 Qf2–+
B) 15.Bc1? Qf2+ 16.Kh1 Bg4! 17.Qd2 Qf1+ 18.Rxf1 Rxf1#
15...Qf6 16.Bxd4?
Perhaps Marshall expected to easily make a draw after refuting the opponent’s attack. But, for an
endgame wizard like Lasker, the game has just started.
100
Position after: 19.Kxf1
Black’s bishop is traditionally better than the knight and e4 can be a target. With all pieces inactive and
Black’s next move, it is clear that Black will get the initiative.
19...Rb8
20.b3 Rb5!
101
Position after: 20...Rb5!
21.c4?
Marshall immediately errs. Admittedly, it was not easy to find the best move.
A) 21.c3? Re5 with an advantage for Black.
B) 21.Na3? Re5 22.Re1 Ra5 is losing material.
C) 21.Nd2! should be satisfactory: 21...Rc5 22.Rc1 Ba6+
23.Kf2 [23.Ke1? Rc3!] 23...Bd3 [23...Rc3 24.Nb1!] 24.Nf3 Rxc2+ 25.Rxc2 Bxc2 26.Nxd4 Bxe4
27.Ne6 Bb1 28.a3 Ba2 29.Nc5
102
Position after: 29.Nc5
21...Rh5
22.Kg1
103
22.h4? g5! 23.hxg5 Rh1+ would win by paralysing White’s army.
22...c5
The strong d4-pawn is supported and Black is ready to put pressure on e4. White’s queenside pawn
phalanx is fixed on light squares and can be a target for the bishop.
25.a3?!
25...Rh6!
26.h4
26.b4 Ra6
26...Ra6
104
Position after: 26...Ra6
27.Ra1
27...Bg4!
This bishop keeps the white king far away from the centre. See the total domination of the bishop over
the knight.
The bishop both controls weak squares and is ready to attack some pawns. It also paralyses both the
white king and knight. Moreover, Black’s rook is much more active than its counterpart.
28.Kf2 Ke6
105
Position after: 28...Ke6
29.a4
29...Ke5
The weakest part of Marshall’s play were endgames, while they were Lasker’s bread and butter. It is no
wonder that only ten moves into the endgame White is completely lost.
106
Position after: 31...d3
35.a5 a6 36.Nb1
107
Finally the knight makes its second jump! Ironically, the black bishop was moved only once.
The pawn structure makes the bishop ultra-powerful, it doesn’t even need to move.
36...Kxe4
Zugzwang!
41.Nb1 Kf3 42.Nc3 Kxg3 43.Na4 f4 44.Nxc5 f3 45.Ne4+ Kf4 46.Nd6 c5 47.b4 cxb4 48.c5 b3
49.Nc4 Kg3
White resigned. One of the most illustrative games for exploring psychology behind moves. Once
again, Lasker’s erudition, intuition and psychological skill helped him confuse the opponent and win
the game convincingly.
0-1
Game 11
Fischer – Petrosian
Buenos Aires 1971
108
Paulsen (or Taimanov) Sicilian. Petrosian was recognised as an expert as Black. But, Bobby Fischer
was one of the greatest attackers of all time as White in the Sicilian. So, the game was bound to be
interesting.
7.0-0 d5
8.c4!
Nowadays this is a typical shot. White wants to open the centre before Black activates his kingside
pieces.
8...Nf6
8...d4 9.e5 gives White excellent prospects on the kingside. He is ready to finish development
following the scheme f4, Nd2-e4. The d4-pawn can be a liability in the endgame.
109
Position after: 10.exd5
10...exd5
A) Knowing the rest of the game, 10...Nxd5 should have been preferred. Now, either 11.Nc3 or some
other knight move only gives White a small visual advantage due to a better majority. Black would
have good centralisation and harmoniously finished development.
B) 10...Qxd5?! Is ill-advised. After 11.Nc3 Qd7 12.Bf4 Be7 13.Qe2 Bb7 14.Rac1 White has some
initiative.
11.Nc3 Be7
110
Position after: 11...Be7
12.Qa4+
12.Be3 to place the bishop on the powerful d4-square would have been a good option.
12...Qd7?
Iron Tigran blunders. The positional master liked to exchange queens against great attackers. He
probably evaluated that solid centralisation would guarantee a promising endgame. However, problems
with the d-pawn are serious. Very soon, trouble on the dark squares will also arise – a logical
consequence of the presence of an isolated pawn placed on a light square.
12...Bd7 was correct. Now 13.Qd4 0-0 14.Nxd5 Nxd5 15.Qxd5 Bb5 16.Qxd8 Rfxd8 17.Bxb5 axb5 is
a forced line that gives Black enough counterplay for the lost pawn. A draw is more than likely.
111
Position after: 14.Nxa4
14...Be6 15.Be3!
Fischer conducts the game like a great strategist. He aims to exchange dark-squared bishops. The
squares c5, d4 and e5 would then be under his control.
112
Position after: 18.b4
Once again, a very dangerous move for Black. White fixes the a6-pawn on a light square.
18...Kf8
20...Rea7?
A strange move. The great champion was evidently not having a good day. Black probably wanted to
overprotect a6 to carry out the manoeuvre ...Bd7-b5. Alas, that can easily be prevented.
21.Re5 Bd7
White’s advantage is obvious. Black’s idea of exchanging bishops with ...Bb5 is not dangerous. It can
be either prevented or declined. Fischer was known as a player who respected the bishop over the
knight. He has a remarkable collection of victories having a bishop against a knight. This game is one
pearl in that collection.
22.Nxd7+!
Exclamation mark because Fischer made that move almost automatically, shocking Petrosian. White’s
bishop will dominate over the black knight and the rooks are active. To be fair, some other authorities
113
like, let’s say, Nimzowitsch, or even Petrosian, would probably not have exchanged that strong knight
for the bad bishop. That is the beauty of chess – relativity!
22.a4 preventing 22...Bb5 was evidently very strong too.
22...Rxd7 23.Rc1
White absolutely dominates. Both the black weak pawns are under attack, fixed on the bishop’s colour.
Black’s knight cannot find an outpost in a very open position. With such passive pieces, defeat is
almost inevitable.
Trying to do something with that poor knight. But it is just a one move attack – there are no special
prospects for this knight.
25.Re2 g6 26.Kf2
114
Position after: 26.Kf2
The king should not be forgotten. White plays patiently – Black is paralysed.
26...h5 27.f4
Fischer wants to demolish Black’s kingside pawn structure. 27.a4 playing on the other side was also an
option.
27...h4
115
Position after: 27...h4
Black must play something. Being paralysed, it is normal to go for bad moves – good moves cannot be
found.
30...Nb6
Capitulation.
116
Position after: 34.Bc4
Black resigned. Petrosian was undoubtedly out of form that day, but Fischer’s play was simply inspired
and fluent. He superbly punished Black’s indolent play.
1-0
Game 12
Andersson – Franco Ocampos
Buenos Aires 1979
117
Position after: 6.dxc3
Not as efficient as it is with a black pawn on c5 (see game 62), but still playable and solid. Also, it is
typical of Ulf Andersson’s patient playing style.
With this move, White wants to provoke the exchange of the light-squared bishops.
9.Bc4 can be played immediately, of course.
11.Nxc4 Nd7
118
Position after: 11...Nd7
12.b4!
A very good decision. Not only gaining space on the queenside, but also keeping the bishops on the
board as the white one is better!
12...Nb6 13.Na5!
119
Position after: 13.Na5!
13...0-0-0+ 14.Kc2
14.Ke2? allows for some tactics: 14...Na4 15.Bd2 [15.Rac1? Nxc3+ 16.Rxc3 Bxb4µ] 15...h5 with the
idea to exchange the bishop via h6 – Black is maybe even slightly better.
14...Be7 15.a3
15...f5!?
With his last move, Black wanted to seize the initiative on the kingside due to the white knight being
“misplaced” on the queenside. However, this is an illusion. Andersson superbly proves that the knight
on a5 is ready for a big role in the endgame.
In this interesting position, both sides want to force the opponent to capture the pawn first. Black
should take the challenge!
120
Position after: 17.Nc4
17...Bf6?
A mistake. Black cannot wait forever – White would double on the e-file(!), forcing Black to decide the
fate of the f5-pawn. Whatever Black chooses, the white knight will clearly dominate the bishop.
17...fxe4! 18.Rae1 Rhf8! A counterattack on f2. 19.Rhf1 Bh4
121
20.g3 [20.Rxe4 Rxf2+ 21.Rxf2 Bxf2 22.Rxe5=] 20...Bg5 21.Rxe4 b5! 22.Ne3 Bxe3 23.Rxe3 with only
a visual advantage for White.
18.a4!
Must be played before doubling! The knight must be secured on c4. Also, with his last move, White
avoids fixing his queenside pawns on dark squares.
20.b5
Fixing Black’s pawn structure on the queenside and giving additional weight to an advance of the a-
pawn.
20.a5? b5„
20...f4?
Playing this voluntarily must be positional suicide! Black fixes more of his pawns on the bishop’s
colour. Black should have been able to counter-double on the e-file in case White doubled. Of course,
Black’s task was difficult even without the last bad move – White can combine play down the a-file
and play against the e-pawn.
21.a5
122
Position after: 21.a5
Now, without tension in the centre, nor hope for Black to activate his bishop, White is free to organise
an attack on the queenside.
25...Rde8 26.Kb3
Even the king should not be left out – it is ready, at the right time, to infiltrate along the light-squared
diagonals.
123
Position after: 27...Kd7
28.Ra2!
Andersson was a real master in cramping the opponent’s forces. There is no more reason to keep both
rooks on the a-file, the 8th rank is also closed for the white rooks. One of them belongs on the d-file!
30...Rc8 31.Rd5
31...Ke8 32.h3
124
Position after: 32.h3
Don’t rush. This move, together with White’s 40th, have an aesthetic quality to them.
32...Ke7 33.Nb2!
Amazing regrouping!
The knight has done its job. Now, it will travel to c6 or d5 via b4. Even more important is that the c-
pawn has been liberated – ready to crash Black’s defences.
34...c6 35.Rdd7+–
125
Position after: 36.c5
With tempo, the rook goes to the promising c6-square, also preparing the knight’s jump to e6.
As previously mentioned, there was no particular need to make this move. But the final position is so
beautiful – it would not be as perfect with the pawn on f2.
126
Position after: 40.f3
Black resigned. In the final position, ALL the white pieces and pawns are placed on light squares.
Notice the sad destiny of Black’s bishop, the direct result of his 20th move.
42.Rc6 Rc8 [42...Rb7 43.Rd8+ Kf7 44.Rf8#] 43.b6+–
1-0
Game 13
Naiditsch – Blagojevic
Valjevo 2011
Black chooses a line where he gets free play but, in return, the bishop on g2 is not restricted.
127
Position after: 8.a3
8...Ba5
White has a small edge due to a space advantage and slightly better development. Naiditsch’s next
move is very simple, but has depth. He thinks that the dark-squared bishop is not needed and gives it
away for the knight that is controlling the centre. White wants to base his queenside play on his
powerful g2-bishop, his potentially dangerous knights and the open c-file.
8...Bxc3 would just strengthen White’s centre. The c4-pawn will eventually fall.
128
Position after: 11.Ne4
11...Qd8
11...Qf5 was definitely more active and was best. 12.Ned2 Bxd2 13.Qxd2 e5 is a possible
continuation, giving Black a solid position without problems.
Black’s pieces are somewhat out of play and his next move is a reasonable option to liberate his
queenside troops.
13...Na5 14.Ne5
129
Position after: 14.Ne5
14...Qe8
15.Qxe8
15.Qb4 allows 15...Nb3 16.Rab1 Nxd4 where activity would give White compensation for a pawn, but
there is no need to go for this line.
130
Position after: 19...Bc6
After a series of exchanges, White has a small, but stable advantage. Having more space is his main
achievement. Also, the black pieces are lacking prospects, especially the b6-bishop. Black would like to
capture on e4, reaching a comfortable opposite coloured bishop endgame. Of course, White keeps the
knight on the board – it will be more active than the b6-bishop.
In this endgame, Black wants to play ...c5 or ...e5, opening the position for his bishop. White’s first task
is to prevent both ideas. Secondly, White wants to advance his pawns – Black is almost without active
play. White’s next move is typical.
131
Position after: 21...c6
22.g4!
Extremely instructive. This move does not allow Black to fix White’s pawns on the bishop’s colour.
Other kingside advances would have.
A) 22.f4 f5!?
B) 22.h4 h5!
22...Kf8
23.h4
132
Position after: 23.h4
23...Ke7
Black cannot avoid being fixed. The following line is clearly in White’s favour 23...h5 24.gxh5 Ke7
25.Na4 Rh8 26.Rb4.
Preventing 25...c5.
25...Bc7 26.f4
White has achieved a lot, making sure Black is out of satisfactory pawn moves.
133
Position after: 27...Kd7
How to proceed? The space advantage is evident, White’s pieces are very active and the king is
centralised. Naiditsch’s plan is very logical. It is based on preventing the opening of the position. His
rooks are busy on the queenside but, of course, he wants to play on the kingside. So, let’s transfer the
rooks!
28.Ne4!
The knight should be placed on d3 – from there it will prevent both ...c5 and ...e5.
134
Position after: 30.Nd3
Naiditsch has found an excellent square for the knight, Black is definitely unable to open the position
for his bishop!
30...Rg8 31.Rh1
Placing the knight on d3, the white rooks now have their hands free. The last move prevents ...g6 in
some positions. White should not hurry to take action.
31...Ra8
Black feels uncomfortable and makes the decision to activate his rooks via the a-file. Alas, there is not
enough time.
32.Rc2
32...a5
135
Position after: 32...a5
33.f5
White decides that it is time for action. He wants to open the position in his favour. He did not want to
spend more time on rook moves, as it is not quite clear what files will be opened.
33...Rge8
136
Position after: 34.gxf5
would lead to pressure along the g-file and the advance of the dangerous central pawns.
34.e4
34...e5?!
Risky. Opening the d-file with the white rooks ready to double up cannot be good. However, it is not
clear whether or not Black could simply stay put.
137
Position after: 38.Rcd2
White infiltrates.
38...Rae8
After this simple move, the white king finds safety and Black loses material.
41...Re2
138
Position after: 41...Re2
42.b3?
White misses a simple win and gives Black a chance to prolong the resistance.
42.Rxg7! Rxb2 43.Rh7 was easily winning.
42...Rh2?
139
Position after: 44.Rf3
Black resigned. A very instructive game, illustrating that a knight can be better than a bishop, even in
unblocked positions. Actually it all comes down to pawn structure and potential pawn advances. White
successfully prevented the opening of the position at first, and waited for the right moment to open the
position himself to his advantage.
1-0
140
Game 14
Andersson – Quinteros
Olot 1971
Black’s queen is probably not on the safest or the best square. If Black wanted to provoke the advance
of the e-pawn, 2...Nf6 makes more sense.
6...d6 7.Be2
141
Position after: 10.Re1
10...Bd7 11.Bf1
White has activated the kingside troops, and it is now time for the rest of the army. There are two
possibilities: to prepare Nc3 with Bd2 or to go for Nbd2 with Nb3 or Ne4 in mind.
11...Be7 12.Bd2
142
Position after: 14...Nb4
Good idea. Black wants to place the knight on d5 and bishop on c6. After putting the rooks on c8 and
d8, he will have an excellent position.
15.Bxb4!
A very good decision. White is almost forced to go for it. Black’s aforementioned plan is obvious but
dangerous for White, and cannot be permitted.
15...Bxb4 16.Re4
The point of the previous move. White gets some tempi and places pieces on comfortable squares.
143
Position after: 17...Bc6
18.Bb5!
18...Rfd8 19.Qc2 Qb6 20.Bxc6 Rac8 21.Rc4 Rxc6 22.Rxc6 Qxc6 23.Qxc6 bxc6 24.Kf1
Very logical and simple. The king goes towards the centre and the threat to c6 is renewed.
144
24...c5
25.Rc3
25...Rb8
26.Rc2
White is definitely better – his pawn structure is better and his knight dominates over the bishop.
It is an essential fact that White controls the c4-square, which can be occupied by all the white pieces.
On the other hand, it looks like there are no promising plans for Black. Of course, he will centralise the
king. But, what next? In such cases, when your opponent is out of plans, it is very useful to play
patiently. Patient play reduces the risk of blunders, and can potentially confuse the opponent.
145
Position after: 27...Rb4
An interesting position. Black just played some active moves and White must be accurate. Of course, it
is bad to capture on f6, because Black would answer with ...gxf6. After this, Black will inevitably
centralise the king and the bishop will get some freedom. Also, Black cannot capture on e5. This would
definitely harm his pawn structure and restrict his bishop – White will occupy the e4- and c4-squares
with the knight and rook respectively. White’s next move organises a blockade on c4 and eventually e4
(after Black captures on e5). It also prevents ...Re4+.
Establishing control over the e4-square and allowing the knight to jump to c4.
Insisting on attacking the e5-pawn, Black achieved nothing. The rook retreats to control the 7th rank
again.
32...Kf7 33.Ra6
146
Position after: 33.Ra6
33...fxe5
Finally, Black took. He couldn’t find anything better. If 33...f5 34.Kd3 Rd7+ [34...g5 35.g4!] 35.Nd6+
is very dangerous.
36...Rc7 37.Rd6
147
Position after: 37.Rd6
Of course, White keeps the rooks. There is no reason to exchange an active piece for a passive one,
even though the knight dominates the bishop. Black would probably be able to hold the position by
placing the king on c6 and waiting. It would be very difficult for White to create another weakness on
the kingside.
The rook returns to the less active a6-square but, as previously mentioned, White should not rush.
148
Position after: 42.g3!
White’s kingside pawns are not completely fixed on dark squares – they are simply being used to
restrict the opponent’s bishop.
The rook goes back, it is needed on the d-file! The d7-square is controlled by the knight, so the black
rook cannot oppose it.
45...Rb8 46.Rc4
149
Position after: 46.Rc4
46...Kd6
46...Rd8 47.Nd3 Rd5 48.f4 with expansion on the kingside is also very promising for White.
150
Position after: 50.g5!
Excellent play. Black must choose between three bad options. He chose to allow White to penetrate via
the f-file and to create an outside passed pawn.
50...hxg5
A) 50...h5 51.Rh3+–
B) 50...Re7 51.gxh6 gxh6 52.Rh3 Rh7 53.Rxh6!+–
51.fxg5
51...Ke7 52.Rf3
151
Position after: 52.Rf3
52...Ke8
53.Rh3
152
Position after: 55.h4
Black resigned. It is really difficult to identify a serious mistake Black made. The endgame was simply
in White’s favour due to the better knight, which was demonstrated superbly. This makes Ulf
Andersson’s triumph convincing and glorious. Once again, he proved that he was a real master of R+N
vs R+B endgames.
1-0
Game 15
Karpov – Sokolov
Linares 1987
153
Position after: 4...Ba6
Black chooses the Queen’s Indian Defence. The point of this move and the next is to deflect the white
knight from the natural c3-square, or the bishop from b2.
154
8...d5
9.cxd5
The king travels a bit, but space will be gained after advancing the e-pawn.
9...Bxf1 10.Kxf1 exd5 11.e5 Ne4 12.Qe2 Nxc3 13.Bxc3 Qd7 14.Kg2
The pawn structure is defined. White will play on the kingside, Black on the queenside – these
activities are dictated by pawn majorities. Black’s next move looks bizarre, because it blocks the c-
pawn, but Black intends to transfer the knight to e6.
14...Nc6
14...c5 was natural. Perhaps Black was afraid of 15.Rhe1, with the threat of 16.e6, forcing Black to put
the queen on e6. [15.dxc5 bxc5 16.e6 Qxe6 17.Qxe6 fxe6 18.Rhe1 is an interesting line, leading to an
unclear position.]
15.Rhe1
Knowing White’s next move, perhaps 15.Rae1 was better, with the idea to place the king’s rook on the
f-file.
15...Nd8
155
Position after: 15...Nd8
16.Ng1!?
Karpov was famous for knight retreats – one of his favourite manoeuvres. This time, the idea is to set
the kingside in motion.
Before putting the knight on e6, Black wants to keep the queen active. The weakened light squares
should be controlled.
156
Position after: 20...Ne6
Not seeing a promising way to eliminate the blockade on f5, Karpov chooses the simplest solution –
offering an exchange of queens.
The endgame is dynamically balanced. White has more space and a more compact pawn structure, but
Black currently has more active minor pieces and control over the c-file. In the next stage of the game,
everything will depend on the players’ technique.
157
Position after: 27...Rc1
The position is open, and it may look like the bishop should be the better piece. This is not the case –
the knight has promising squares and the pawn on d5 is weak. Many pieces have disappeared, and the
statements on move 22 are still valid. With his next move, Karpov continues expanding on the
kingside. White’s advanced pawns get support, and the rook gets further access to the 3rd rank.
158
White succeeds in placing the king in the centre.
31...h6
Black wants to protect the h-pawn from attacks down the h-file.
31...Rf1+? 32.Nf3
32.h4
Continuing to expand. White’s position looks better at the moment, but nothing much is on the horizon.
32...Ke8 33.Nf3
33...Rc2
33...Rc5 was a normal move. White would probably continue with 34.g5.
34.a4
159
36...a6 37.Kf3!
A very good move. Direct in view of transferring the knight to the vacated f4-square, and prophylactic
because some checks are avoided. Always try to find multi-purpose moves in your own games – they
are often good. Step-by-step, the black bishop becomes a spectator.
37...Bc5 38.Ne2 d4
White’s advantage is now concrete. The d4-pawn is weak and the e4-square is free for the white pieces,
which is a very important factor. From this square, the knight and especially the king can support the
launched majority.
40...fxe6! 41.Nxe6 leads to the loss of the g7-pawn, but still after 41...Kd6 42.Nxg7 Ke5
160
Position after: 42...Ke5
nothing is clear. Actually, maybe that was a good chance for Black. Two dangerous manoeuvres would
be on the agenda: ... Rc2-c3 or ...Rb1-f1.
41.Ke4 a5
Voluntarily setting the pawns on dark squares with the idea to eliminate White’s threat a5. The bishop
161
has become a “big pawn”. It is clear that Black did something wrong.... although, it is difficult to
pinpoint the mistake.
Not uncommon if your opponent is Karpov.
It looks like Black achieved a lot, but White found a nice tactic...
44.Kd3! Rxg4?
162
Position after: 46...Re1
45.f6!
45...Bd6
163
45...fxe6 46.f7+ Kd7 [46...Kf8 47.Nc7] 47.Nxb6+ followed by 48.Nc4 looks winning.
164
Position after: 53.Nxd4
53...Bb4
53...Kg5?? 54.Nf3++–
Finally, Karpov goes for the win. He calculated until the end.
57...Kg5
165
Position after: 57...Kg5
58.Nxa5! Bxa5 59.b4 Bd8 60.a5 Kxh5 61.Kb5 Bg5 62.a6 Be3 63.Kc6
Black resigned. Such a tense game. Both players played 40 moves almost impeccably, but finally
Sokolov’s imprecise move allowed Karpov to demonstrate his magnificent endgame knowledge. A
perfectly conducted game by both players with clearly visible and notable plans for the reader. One
more instructive and interesting example on chess relativity: in a relatively open position, the knight
166
prevailed over the bishop.
1-0
Game 16
Ljubojevic – Karpov
Linares 1981
1.e4 c6 2.d4 d5 3.Nc3 dxe4 4.Nxe4 Bf5 5.Ng3 Bg6 6.Nf3 Nd7 7.h4 h6 8.h5 Bh7 9.Bd3 Bxd3
10.Qxd3 e6
Against such an inventive opponent as Ljubojevic, it is good advice to choose a solid opening.
Karpov’s decision is the Caro-Kann, of which he was a great expert.
Another good option is the plan invented by Spassky 14.Qe2 with the idea of 15.Ne5.
14...0-0-0 15.g3
167
Position after: 15.g3
15...Nc5!
A very direct answer. Black gets rid of one knight – it is good to exchange pieces when the opponent
has a space advantage. Black also takes control of d6, opens the d-file and eliminates White’s threats.
Simple and strong.
168
Position after: 18...Kb8
19.Ne5
19...Nd5
19...Nd7 20.f4 [20.Nc4 Nb6=] 20...Nb6 was suggested by Karpov as an even simpler solution.
169
Position after: 21...Bxe5!
That knight must be eliminated, and it is better for Black to give away the bishop than the knight.
Keeping the knight, Black can hope for more than an equal endgame. Black chose the perfect moment
to capture – White cannot recapture with the f4-pawn, so there won’t be any pressure along the f-file.
22.dxe5 Nd5
22...c5!?, with the idea to put the queen on the long diagonal, was evidently solid. But after 23.Ba5 Qc6
24.Bxb6 Black does not have serious chances to fight for the initiative.
23.c4
It looks like this move should be played sooner or later – the knight is very dominant on d5.
170
Position after: 23.c4
Preventing the bishop from getting to d6, and paralysing it. Black’s queen also gets good prospects on
the longest diagonal.
26...Rxd1+ 27.Qxd1 b6
171
Position after: 27...b6
28.Qd3?!
With this move, White just forces Black to make a move he wanted to make anyway. 28.g4 looks
logical, but after
A) 28...Qb7!= Black is worry free. 29.Qd6+ Kc8 Black is fine due to threats along the diagonal.
B) 28...Qc6?! is risky due to complications arising after 29.Qd6+ Qxd6 30.exd6 Ng8 [30...Nc6
31.g5±] 31.g5 Kb7 32.b4! cxb4 33.Bd4ƒ.
28...g6!
172
Position after: 28...g6!
29.hxg6
leads to a typical position Capablanca would use to support his theory: “Queen and knight is a stronger
duo than queen and bishop in the endgame!”. White’s bishop is useless – Black has a safer king and
pawns. Black’s knight is planted on f5 and the h5-pawn will be in danger, whereas the h6-pawn will
173
not. Definitely enough for Karpov to convert.
29...fxg6
30.a3
White senses Black’s upcoming initiative on the kingside and is ready to undertake active play on the
queenside in return.
30.Qe4 Nf5 31.Bf2 h5 32.Kc2=
30...a5
Preventing 31.b4.
31.b3
31...h5
It has become clear that Black has outplayed the opponent. The knight will be placed on f5, putting
strong pressure on the g3-pawn, and is ready to approach the white king.
174
Position after: 33...Qd7
34.a4?
34...Kc7!
An excellent move which highlights the downside of White’s last move. White’s queen cannot infiltrate
because of ...Qd3, with devastating effect.
35.Kc2
175
Position after: 35.Kc2
35...Qd8!!
Immediately achieving a much better position. From d8, the queen controls both the a8-square and the
d-file. 36...g5 is also on the cards. White is in big trouble.
35...Qc6?! 36.Qxc6+ Kxc6 37.Kd3=
36.Kc1
A) 36.Qd3 Qa8!ƒ
B) 36.Qf3 Qd4!!
176
Position after: 36...Qd4!!
37.Qe2 Qa1ƒ
36...g5!
37.fxg5
177
37...Qxg5+ 38.Kc2 Ne7 39.Qh7 Kd7
Exchanging queens immediately with 39...Qg6+ is good, but Black wanted to gain a tempo.
42.Qxf5
42.Be1 Qxe5µ
42...exf5!
Of course! Allowing the king to attack the e5-pawn. The game is decided. Now, Karpov demonstrates
his classy endgame technique.
42...Nxf5 43.Kd3 Kd7 44.Ke4 looks safe for White.
178
Position after: 45.Bg5
45...Kxe6 46.Kd2
46...f4!
179
Position after: 46...f4!
47.gxf4 h4
50.Kg3
180
Position after: 53...Nxb3
Black’s king is coming for the pawns, while his counterpart could not be any further away.
Karpov decides not to collect the a4-pawn with the king. He chooses the safer plan. The pawn will fall
later.
181
58.Bf6+ Kc2 59.Be5
59.Kd5 Kd3–+
62.Ke2
62.Kd4 Nxa4 63.Kc4 Nb6+ 64.Kb5 a4 65.Kb4 Nd5+–+ with a nice fork at the end, was a variation
shown by Karpov.
62...Kb3
White resigned. Against a master like Karpov in the 80’s, you must play very precisely, even in simple
positions. Leaving the d3-square uncovered, White lost the option to have counterplay by penetrating
via a8. This allowed Black to prepare ...g5 and obtain a decisive initiative on the kingside. A typical
example that confirms Capablanca’s statement that a queen and knight collaborate more efficiently than
a queen and bishop.
0-1
182
Chapter 3
The Bishop Pair
Everything about “Bishop against Knight” is also valid for the bishop pair. The bishop pair is even
more of a dangerous weapon in open positions. So often, you can see these “scissors” in action, or two
bishops attacking the opponent’s king. Overall, principles for play with or without the pair of bishops
are well-known. Nevertheless, I would like to mention four important principles when having the
bishop pair:
1. The side with the bishop pair (against a pair of knights or against a bishop and knight, of course)
should open the position.
2. Having the bishop pair, it is a good idea to gain space (without creating “holes” for the opponent’s
knight).
3. Put pawns on squares of the same colour as the opponent’s bishop in order to restrict it. As a result of
this, our counterpart-free bishop will dominate!
4. The pair of bishops often allows you to easily exchange one of the bishops for the opponent’s bishop
or knight, with the idea of simplifying or transferring into a desired endgame.
Of course, the side playing against the bishop pair should try to oppose the above.
I would add that the side playing with the bishop pair against a bishop and knight should insist on
making the counterpart-free bishop a dangerous weapon.
My coaching experience has confirmed that it is useful to remind students of the aforementioned
principles, which are instructive concepts.
The games analysed in this chapter explain perfectly both the advantages and disadvantages of having
the bishop pair – which depends on pawn structure, of course. Games 17-23 in this chapter are
instructive for using the powerful bishop pair. Games 24-26 illustrate how some pawn structures cause
problems to the side with the bishop pair.
My statistics suggest that the bishop pair is “good” in almost 80% of cases, which is why I pay much
more attention to games showing their power.
After analysing games in this chapter (and the entire book), you will be able to recognise the
advantages and disadvantages of having the pair of bishops and to evaluate the position. Furthermore,
you will be able even from the opening to predict if the pawn structure will benefit the bishop pair or
not. Logically, you can adapt your plan accordingly.
Game 17
Englisch – Steinitz
London 1883
183
Position after: 3...g6
This move is played even nowadays, but for the 19th century it must be criticised – Black “neglects”
the centre. Actually, Steinitz always preferred moves he liked rather than those suggested by
“theoreticians”. As a result, we enjoy his gigantic legacy today.
184
White is more active and has more space. Of course, visually, White should be better. Still, Black has
not made a particularly bad move yet. So, the position is fairly balanced and it is just the start of the
game. Steinitz’s next move looks antipositional, but actually it is directed at controlling the centre – he
prepares ...d5.
8...Ne7!? 9.Qd2
11...Qxd5
With this move, Black aims for more than equality. The knight on d4 protects the bishop and can be the
target of an attack – Black intends to play ...Ng4.
11...Nxd5 of course, is also good. 12.Bh6 Bxh6 13.Qxh6 c6 leads to quite a balanced position.
12.Be2?
12...Ng4!
185
Position after: 12...Ng4!
Simple decision. Black gets the advantage of the bishop pair, which will be extremely dangerous given
that the position is completely open.
186
Position after: 17.Nb3
A typical position where the bishop pair dominates. From here, Steinitz demonstrates all the
possibilities and advantages of having the pair of bishops. The position is open and there is hence no
need to open it further. Instead, Black focuses on gaining space and restricting the opponent’s minor
pieces. Gaining space should be done patiently – avoiding the creation of holes for the opponent’s
knight. Restricting pieces would be achieved after placing most of the pawns on dark squares. It does
not matter that Black’s dark-squared bishop would be passive for a while. The point is that the light-
squared bishop would be very powerful. Finally, Steintz demonstrates the ability to easily exchange the
right pieces – such a method is very common in the phase of realising a positional advantage. Let’s see
the rest of the game, carrying out a step-by-step explanation of these properties.
17...b6!
Taking away the a5- and c5-squares from White’s minor pieces.
Very simple, isn’t it? Even the d4-square is taken away. Step-by-step, Black’s bishop on e6 becomes
more and more powerful. The g7-bishop awaits his time to shine.
187
Position after: 22...g5!
23.Rxd8
23.Bg3 f5!µ
23...Rxd8 24.Be3 h6
25.Re1
188
Position after: 25.Re1
25...f5!
Some pawns can be on light squares. Black intends ...f4 to get more space. White prevents it.
26.f4 Bf6
26...g4 should have been preferred. It forces White to decide what to do with the h-pawn. Another
benefit is that Black’s dark-squared bishop is not obliged to protect the g5-pawn. 27.hxg4 [27.h4 Bf6
28.g3 a5] 27...fxg4 and Black is ready to launch his h-pawn, with a dangerous initiative on the
kingside.
A must.
189
Position after: 30.Kf2
Black has achieved a lot. The white pieces are cramped. Black’s pieces dominate, especially the c4-
bishop. White has many holes on the queenside and the potential same-coloured bishop endgame must
be in Black’s favour, if his king reaches c4. However, it is difficult to transfer the king to the queenside.
It is also difficult to advance the b-pawn as the pawn on c5 needs protection. Steinitz delivers a high-
level performance in the rest of the game, leaving us with a perfect example on playing with a bishop
pair advantage.
Now, it is time for the last principle to take effect – the ability to exchange one of the bishops!
30...gxf4!
I am sure that fewer than half of current masters would opt for this amazing solution.
31.Bxf4
31.gxf4?? Bh4+–+
190
Position after: 31.Bxf4
31...Bg5!
33...Kf6
Black has various possibilities: to penetrate via the d- or e-file, advance the f-pawn, attack the h-pawn...
White’s position is hopeless.
34.h4
191
Position after: 34.h4
34...gxh4!
192
37...Kg6! The strongest! Next is ...Rd2 while after 38.Rxh3 Rd1 the white knight is lost.
38.Ne2
38.Kf2 Kf4–+
193
Position after: 41...f4+
A brilliant game which perfectly illustrates all plans for the side having the bishop pair: opening the
position, restricting the opponent’s minor pieces by putting pawns on his bishop’s colour, gaining space
and exchanging one of the bishops at the right time in order to convert. Actually, that was the first
published game explaining the luxury of having the bishop pair in open positions, helping to establish
some principles and theory on the topic.
0-1
Game 18
Arnason – Kasparov
Moscow 1980
1.e4 c5 2.Nf3 d6 3.d4 cxd4 4.Nxd4 Nf6 5.Nc3 a6 6.Be2 e5 7.Nb3 Be7 8.Bg5 Be6
194
Position after: 8...Be6
9.Bxf6
9.0-0 0-0 10.Bxf6 Bxf6 11.Qd3 Nc6 12.Nd5 Bg5 13.Rfd1 was later suggested as a correct move order.
The point is that Black cannot play 13...Ne7.
195
Position after: 14...Rd8
15.Na5
15...0-0
16.Nc4
White played the opening without aggression. Moreover, he did not even attempt to fight for an
advantage. Perhaps he respected young Kasparov, who, even in 1980, was already close to the world’s
elite. White intends, after 17.Nb6, to establish a blockade on d5. Black prevents it, of course, opening
the position for the bishop pair.
Missing 15.c4, it was clear that White would not play it a move later. 16.c4 would be better, but then
the move 15.Na5 would appear rather strange. White was consistent, but the knight will not get to d5.
16...d5!
196
Position after: 16...d5!
17.exd5
Black’s strategy is clear. He has fully activated his troops. Potential exchanges will not do him any
harm – his bishop pair will dominate in the endgame.
197
Position after: 20...b5
Making space for the king and continuing the correct strategy – putting pawns on light squares. This
will restrict both the white minor pieces.
198
Position after: 25.Qd7
25...Qe7
26.Qd3 e4
Black’s bishop does nothing on the long diagonal. It is therefore better to close it, gaining more space.
27.Qd2
Due to his careless play, White was forced to switch to defence. Black dominates with two ultra-
powerful bishops. His next plan could be connected with using his majority on the kingside, though
advancing pawns would leave the king unprotected. So, it is natural to exchange queens before
expanding. Kasparov plays pragmatically, exchanging material doesn’t worry him.
Good move. White vacates the c2-square to activate his minor pieces
29...Kg7
29...f5 was more precise. Black should not voluntarily choose the longer path to the centre for the king.
If possible, the king gets there faster using the light-squared diagonal. Moreover, the f-pawn would be
sure to advance anyway.
199
30.a4
Once again, a good move. White wants to create a weak pawn in Black’s camp and to reduce material.
Exchanging material will improve his chances of a draw.
30...bxa4!
Only move to play for a win. It is extremely important for Black to keep at least one queenside pawn.
A) 30...Kf6 31.axb5 axb5 32.Be2 would lead to the elimination of the b5-pawn.
B) 30...Bc6 31.axb5 Bxb5 would lead to the same structure, but the bishop can be exposed – White
would be able to launch the pawns with a tempo.
200
Position after: 33.h4
With his last two moves, White is ready to parry Black’s expansion on the kingside. His strategy
remains the same: exchanging as many pawns as possible. Then possibly sacrificing the knight (yes,
knight, because two bishops versus knight would be theoretically winning for Black) for the opponent’s
pawns would lead to a draw.
33...Bc8
34.Bd1
201
Position after: 36...Ke5
37.Nc4+?!
White wants to disturb the king, but it was heading to the queenside anyway.
202
It looks like Black took risks and will lose a pawn on the kingside. However, Kasparov calculated
correctly.
43...Kc4!
43...f3 would save material, but White establishes a barrier after 44.Ne3.
44.Nxf4?!
46...Kxc3 47.Kf1
203
Position after: 47.Kf1
A very interesting position. White has stopped the pawn and is ready to bring the knight and king over.
Black must watch White’s idea to sacrifice the knight for the pawn. Black’s first task is to keep the
white king and knight far away from the pawn.
47...Kd2!
48.Bb5
48...Bf5 49.Nd5?
49...Bd3+!
204
Position after: 49...Bd3+!
Finally, Black reaches the win. One of the most important properties of the bishop pair is the ability to
exchange one of the bishops easily.
52.Kd1 a3 53.Kc1 Kc4 54.Ne3+ Kb3 55.f4 Bc7 56.Kb1 a2+ 57.Ka1
205
Position after: 57.Ka1
57...Ba5
58.Nd5 Bd2
White resigned. Docile play in the opening was punished. The result was a problematic endgame for
White. It is no wonder the legendary Kasparov posed so many problems – the outcome was fair.
0-1
Game 19
Zlatanovic – Mladenovic
Paracin 2012
The so-called Botvinnik setup in the English Opening. White may want to prepare the d4-advance, and
keeps possibilities of playing on either the queenside or kingside.
This is the first small mistake. Black wants to prepare ...f5, but this knight is badly placed if White
plays d4. More logical was the move 8...Nd7, with the same idea.
206
9.Be3
9...Be6
10.Nd5
10...Ne7
It looks like Black forgot about his plan to play ...f5. Black’s knights should be placed on d4 and d7.
They are retreating, and this is a signal for White to strike in the centre.
10...Nd4 was still better.
11.d4
207
Position after: 11.d4
11...Bxd5?
12.cxd5 f5
208
Position after: 12...f5
Black is finally consistent, but at the wrong moment. He opens the position for White’s bishops and
allows access to the e6-square, which was weakened after parting with the light-squared bishop.
13.Qb3!
A very fine move. Attacking the pawn on b7, White also prepares to capture on e5. Black is unable to
recapture with the pawn due to the discovered check. Recapturing with the bishop allows the white
knight to get to e6.
13...a5
14.dxe5 Bxe5
209
Position after: 14...Bxe5
15.Nd4
Maybe including the moves 15.f4 Bg7 was more precise. Now it is dangerous for Black. 16.Nd4
That was the point of Black’s plan. He is threatening to crush White’s pawn centre and is attacking b2.
210
White must play accurately to keep an advantage.
The b2-pawn is lost, but White can choose how to lose it.
20.Rab1 Rxb2
20...Bxb2 21.Bd4 a3 22.Bxb2 axb2 23.Rfd1 leads to the loss of the pawn on b2.
21.Rxb2 Bxb2
The end of a series of forced moves. Inventive black play helped him retain material balance.
The material is equal and reduced but White is better due to the advantage of the bishop pair. After
deeper analysis of the position, it becomes clear that Black actually has a dangerous plan to target the
a2-pawn! His idea is to play ...a3 and transfer the knight to the queenside using the route Ne8-f6-e4-c3.
This would force White to exchange the light-squared bishop, which could result in problems regarding
the d5-pawn. White’s next move is superb and highlights the superiority of the bishop pair in such
positions.
22.Bh3!
The knight must change its route. The f5-pawn is under attack, so the aforementioned threat is
eliminated. Black has problems to reactivate his kingside pieces.
211
22...Ng7
23.Rd1
23...Rb8
23...a3 24.Rd3 with the idea of 25.Rb3. 24...Rb8 25.Bd2 is better for White.
24.Bf1
The knight is deflected from its route, and now the bishop prevents the move ...Rb5 in some lines.
212
Position after: 27...Bxb2
After some fine manoeuvring, a2 is finally safe. It is time to find the best squares for the bishops and to
centralise the king.
28.Bb5!
29...Bc3 was a better way to protect the c7-pawn, but now White’s king goes for the a3-pawn and
attacks the bishop on its way. 30.Kf1 and Black is in big trouble.
213
Position after: 32.f4
A funny situation. Black can only activate the king and knight without losing material by playing
...Kg6 and ...Nh5, but then White will exchange the bishop for the knight after Be8+ and gets a
probably winning position due to so many black pawns being fixed on dark squares.
32...Nh5?!
Black goes for active play, but runs into some tactics.
32...Ke7 33.Bc8 gives nothing to Black. After 33...Kf6 34.Kf2 Kg6 35.Bd7!
214
Position after: 35.Bd7!
White keeps the black knight out of play. 35...Nh5 36.Be8+ Kh6 37.Bxh5 Kxh5 38.h3, as mentioned
above, should be winning for White.
33.Bxf5 Nf6
34.Bd3!
34...Nxd5
35.Bc4+–
215
Position after: 35.Bc4+–
Black can only get rid of this annoying pin by allowing his pawns to be doubled. White is winning.
39.g4 Ba5 40.Bd4 Bb4 41.f5 Bd2 42.Kf3 Be1 43.g5 Kf7 44.Kg4 Bd2 45.h4 Bc1 46.h5 Bb2 47.g6+
216
hxg6 48.hxg6+ Kg8 49.Bb6 Kg7 50.Bd8 Bc1 51.Be7 d4
52.Bxd6
52...d3 53.Be5+ Kf8 54.Kf3 Kg8 55.f6 Bg5 56.f7+ Kf8 57.Bd6+ Be7 58.Bxe7+ Kxe7 59.Ke3 1-0
Black resigned. A very interesting game. After badly playing the opening, Black resourcefully carried
out the middlegame and found some practical chances. Still, the bishop pair advantage was a decisive
positional factor which, along with some fine tactics, helped White to convert.
Game 20
Polugaevsky – Ivkov
Belgrade 1969
1.Nf3 Nf6 2.c4 c5 3.Nc3 Nc6 4.d4 cxd4 5.Nxd4 Nxd4 6.Qxd4 g6 7.e4 d6 8.Be3 Bg7 9.f3 0-0
10.Qd2 Be6 11.Rc1 Qa5
217
Position after: 11...Qa5
In Maroczy’s system, White traditionally enjoys a slightly better position due to a space advantage. In
return, Black hopes to organise an initiative on the queenside. The next move leads to pawn symmetry
and actually turns the queenside into White’s playground – the powerful bishops will thrive there. This
move is one of the few logical possibilities here.
218
13...Bxd5
With this move, Black hopes to carry out queenside play on the dark squares and, if possible, to transfer
the game into an endgame with Black’s knight against White’s light-squared bishop. However, it is a
very risky decision to play against the powerful bishop pair.
A) 13...Rae8 is playable, but definitely looks dull. The a7-pawn is without protection, and there is even
the option of 14.Nc7, capturing the pair of bishops.
B) But 13...Nxd5 should be considered, although after 14.cxd5 Bc8 15.b3, White definitely looks
better.
14.cxd5
14.exd5 leads to completely different patterns. White gets some pressure on e7, but Black gets more
control of the important outpost on c5. The text move really seems to give White good chances.
14...Rfc8 15.Be2 a6
16.b4
With centralised pieces, a completed development and an activated king, White immediately launches
his pawn attack on the queenside. In positions with the bishop pair advantage, one very logical
approach is to gain space.
219
Position after: 18.a5!
An excellent move that advanced players would execute without calculating a thing. There is nothing to
calculate. Having the bishop pair advantage, it is useful to put your pawns on the opponent’s bishop
colour. This way, the pawns successfully restrict the activity of the opponent’s minor pieces.
Furthermore, the opponent’s pawns are fixed on our bishop’s colour, which will make them harder to
protect. Hence, the a6- and b7-pawns are fixed and will later be weak.
18...Bb2 19.Rc2!
Gaining a tempo.
220
Position after: 21...Rc8
22.Bd2!
22.Rc1 is also good, but still the text move is much better. The point is to stop Black’s counterplay,
while the rooks can be exchanged at any time. It is natural, by the way, to keep as many pieces as
possible in positions where one has a space advantage.
22...Bd4
Knowing the rest of the game, Black should have tried 22...e6, attempting to change the character of
game. Of course, opening the position is in White’s favour, but a waiting strategy is not a good option.
23.g4!
221
Position after: 23.g4!
According to the notes after White’s 18th move, this pawn should be placed on g5! Black’s knight feels
less and less comfortable with every passing move.
The point of White’s pawn setup is evident. Black’s pieces are cramped and it is no wonder that White
wins the game convincingly.
27...Ke8 28.Rf1!
This rook eyes the f7-pawn. In case of advancing either the e- or f-pawn, that could be useful.
222
Position after: 28.Rf1!
28...Bd4 29.h4
But, while f7 is still protected, White improves his chances on the kingside – even the h-pawn joins the
assault.
31...Bg7 32.Rh3
223
Position after: 32.Rh3
White tenaciously improves his position. It is instructive to see how Polugaevsky creates threats on
various files and forces Black to play accurately.
32...Kf8
224
Position after: 38.e5
with the idea of 39.e6! also wins. The white bishop arriving on g8 and/or the f4-f5 break is too much to
handle.
225
37.e5! Bh2
Finally, at the end of the game, the reader can observe one more very important feature of the bishop
pair advantage – the possibility to exchange one of the bishops in order to simplify and convert.
41.Bxd7! 1-0
Black resigned. The rook inevitably penetrates, with devastating effect. A very important and
instructive game, which explores very typical pawn structures which can arise from many different
openings. The game perfectly illustrates the convenience of the pair of bishops.
Game 21
Gufeld – Kolarov
Odessa 1968
Eduard Gufeld was perhaps the greatest ever fan of the fianchettoed king’s bishop. He contributed a lot
to understanding various concepts in the King’s Indian and similar openings. In this game, he simply
follows his own path and builds a reversed King’s Indian setup, with an extra tempo.
4...Bg7 5.Bg2
226
Position after: 5.Bg2
In such positions, White usually tries to launch a kingside attack (actually, White’s setup is called the
King’s Indian Attack). Black doesn’t want to counter by launching a queenside attack because he has
already advanced his c-pawn – ...c5 would be played with a loss of tempo. That is the reason he wants
to simplify the position in the centre.
A common approach.
227
Position after: 11...e5
White has a long-lasting advantage of the bishop pair. Having said that, Black’s position is without
weak points. White’s task is clear: he must activate the bishops, possibly by opening the position.
Opening the position is connected with advancing the pawns – this must be done accurately, without
creating good squares for the opponent’s knights. Naturally, advancing pawns should start from the
edge – these will not create holes.
12.a4!
Simple and strong. This move also secures a perfect position for the knight on c4, from where it may
control the vulnerable d6-square. For now, it looks well protected by the black pieces, but in the future
it may be a real weakness.
228
Position after: 14.b4
White is consistent, he grabs space on the queenside, foreshadowing active play there.
14...Bf8 15.c3
Look at the c3- and b4-pawns, they perfectly restrict the black knight and bishop – place pawns on the
opponent’s bishop colour when you have the bishop pair.
15...Nb6
Black counters well. The bishop pair is usually even stronger when both sides have an added knight.
White has achieved a lot. His pieces are developed harmoniously and the space advantage on the
queenside is evident. The e3-bishop targets the a7-pawn and, sooner or later, weaknesses will appear
229
Position after: 19...Rad8
in Black’s queenside structure. The other white bishop has good prospects but is temporarily on the
wrong diagonal.
20.h4! Rxd1+
Black wants to exchange material. Alas, the endgame without rooks is also bad for him.
21.Rxd1 Rd8
230
Position after: 21...Rd8
22.a5!
The knight is driven back and forced to protect the pawn on a7.
22...Nc8 23.Bh3
Threatening ...Qd3.
25.c4
By far the best way to control the d3-square – other moves would be passive.
White is not afraid of weakening the d4-square because both the black bishop and knight are unable to
get there.
25...Ne7
If the knight must be placed there in this pawn setup, Black is in big trouble. With fixed pawns on e4
and e5 and an open d-file, the e7-square is the worst square for the knight to be placed. Actually, the
game is strategically lost for Black. White’s bishops dominate while the black knight wanders
aimlessly. No active plans for Black, paralysed pieces and no prospects for pawn play. It is only a
231
matter of time before White will orchestrate a breakthrough on either the kingside or queenside.
26.Kf1!
The king gets closer to the centre and to guarding the d-file.
There was no need for this move. Black should find other waiting moves.
28.Qc3 Qd6
232
Position after: 28...Qd6
A must. Exchanging queens would lead to the loss of queenside pawns after 32.Qxe5, 33.Be7 and
34.c5!. (31...Qxe5 32.Qxe5 fxe5 33.Bxe7 Bxe7 34.c5)
32.Qf3
233
Position after: 32.Qf3
The diagram is needed to present the triumph of a simple, but logical and strong strategy. Black’s
pieces are locked down, while the bishop pair could not be doing any better. Comments are not needed
for the next moves.
234
Position after: 38...Bh6
Black resigned. Being a great fan of this game and the classy strategy demonstrated by Gufeld, I
decided to present the game without sublines. Adding any line can spoil this masterpiece. The reader
can try and improve on Black’s play, but actually, especially in the middlegame, there are many similar
possibilities that probably led to a simple transposition of move order. The game was conducted
smoothly by White and it is really a great pleasure to watch it over and over again. The pressure on
Black’s position was building with every move and the defeat should not be a shock to anyone. White
perfectly exploited many of the advantages he accumulated in the game, especially the bishop pair.
235
Game 22
Timman – Andersson
London 1984
1.e4 c5 2.Nf3 e6 3.d4 cxd4 4.Nxd4 Nc6 5.Nc3 a6 6.Be3 Nf6 7.Bd3 d5
White’s setup allows Black to play this advance, freeing his position.
Black has an isolated pawn, but it’s a good version for him. White’s pieces are on the wrong squares.
The knight on d4 is unstable. With his next move, White tries to regroup and establish harmony.
10.Be2
236
Position after: 10.Be2
12...Ne5 was natural, with the idea to eliminate the light-squared bishop. Although, after a potential
exchange of dark-squared bishops, Black risks being stuck with a bad light-squared one.
13.h3 Bc7
237
Position after: 13...Bc7
Both sides spent some time regrouping, with the idea to get better control over the centre.
14.Nde2
This is a fine move. The pawn on d5 is now under direct attack. Also, White plans to play 15.Bf4,
intending to exchange bishops or 15.Nf4, putting more pressure on the d5-pawn.
14...Be6 15.Nf4
15...Bxf4!?
Black directly eliminates the threat, but gives away his good bishop.
Perhaps more logical and more flexible was 15...Ba5!?.
16.Bxf4 Qb6
That was the point of the previous move. Black instantly finishes development, bringing the rook into
play. White has no comfortable way of protecting b2.
17.Qd2
238
17...Rad8 18.Na4
Black has some initiative and White hopes to kick back the black queen.
18...Qd4
19.Nc3
19...Qxd2?!
Without the queens on the board, Black’s initiative would not be dangerous. White’s bishop pair would
be able to obtain activity.
19...Qb6!? should have been preferred, knowing what happened in the game.
239
Position after: 22...Rxe8
This position was Black’s goal. White’s pieces are passive. The pawn on c2 is under attack. Protecting
it with 23.Bd1 cannot be to anyone’s liking... However, White’s reaction is just brilliant...
24...Rd8 25.g4!
240
Position after: 25.g4!
Forcing the bishop to retreat to the kingside and taking control of the f5-square. The bishop is unable to
reach the queenside, where it is actually needed.
Preventing 29.Rc7.
29.f3 Bg6
How does one assess this endgame? White is a pawn down, isn’t he? Only formally, yes. However...
Firstly, the white rook dominates on the open file, paralysing the black pieces on the 8th rank – they
must control the c7- and c8-squares, preventing infiltration. Secondly, the bishop on g6 can’t be used
on the queenside – the battlefield is restricted there. Moreover, there are no good prospects for Black’s
pawn play. Next, the d5-pawn is not dangerous – White’s bishop is stable on d4 and has influence on
both flanks. In fact, the powerful bishop pair is the most important positional factor. Actually, here,
White is playing for a win, although it is difficult to evaluate the position as better for White... Let’s say
that there is more than enough compensation, with a strong initiative. Even more important is the
psychological component: it is extremely uncomfortable to see that you cannot do anything with an
extra pawn. Black must take care of defence...
30.Kf2
241
30...f6
31.a4
As previously mentioned, White will attack on the queenside. All the white pieces target the queenside,
while Black cannot bring over the bishop and king to defend.
33.f4!?
White firstly wants to gain more space and invites the bishop to e4, where he predicts it will be useless.
33.b5 was also a good move.
33...Be4 34.b5?!
34...axb5 35.f5+
242
Position after: 35.f5+
35...Ke7
35...Bxf5 would not be enough. After 36.gxf5+ Kxf5 37.Bxb5, White is winning.
37...Ra8 38.Bd7
38...g6 39.a5
243
Position after: 39.a5
39...Kg8?
Black resigned. Beware in your own games – in some positions, the bishop pair is worth more than a
pawn. Do not fall victim to an illusion. An extra pawn is not always a reason to play for a win.
42.Bxc8 Nd6
244
Position after: 42...Nd6
245
Position after: 3...g6
This was the first time Spassky played the Pirc Defence against Karpov. Karpov answered with a
classical system, his favourite. There are few surprises in the classical system.
A logical move with two ideas behind it. One is to put pressure on the d4-pawn with ...Nc6 and ...e5
with a possible exchange on f3. The second is to exchange the bishop for the f3-knight and set the
pawns in a Caro-Kann formation: c6, d5, e6.
7.Be3 Nc6
8.Qd2
8.d5 Bxf3 9.Bxf3 Ne5 10.Be2 c5 Seems to offer more to White, but Black’s position is actually
without weaknesses and White cannot easily organise the advance of his e-pawn.
8...Re8 9.Rfe1 a6
10.Rad1
246
White has refrained from attacking the black bishop on g4, intending to save time – perhaps Black will
capture the knight even unprovoked. Indeed, Black could not find any other useful moves and so
decided to capture the knight – a small victory for White.
10...Bxf3 11.Bxf3 e5
12.dxe5
Opening the position for the bishop pair. 12.d5 is wrong. Black answers 12...Nd4! and gets comfortable
play.
12...dxe5
12...Nxe5 gives a small, but stable advantage to White due to the bishop pair and extra space.
13.Na4!?
247
Position after: 13.Na4!?
A very interesting move. The knight goes to the rim with two ideas in mind. One is to transfer it to c5
or c4 (or d3) via b2. The second idea is to play c3, restricting the c6-knight – a very important
strategical resource in positions with this pawn structure.
13...Qe7 14.c3 b6
Taking away the c5-square, but weakening the a6-pawn. White reacts logically.
15.Qe2
Removing the queen from the open d-file and targeting the pawn on a6.
15...Nd8!
248
Position after: 15...Nd8!
A very solid move. Black removes the knight form a bad position on c6 and is ready to use two routes
to reactivate it: d8-b7-d6 and d8-e6-f4.
Of course, White places his pawns mostly on dark squares, making his light-squared bishop the
dominant piece and restricting the opponent’s knight.
17...h5
Once again, a good move. Black intends to play ...Ng4 at the right time. Also, there is the reasonable
plan to exchange dark-squared bishops after the moves ...Kh7 and ...Bh6.
18.Nb2
249
Position after: 18.Nb2
18...b5?!
This pawn move eliminates the threat to the a6-pawn and takes away the c4-square from the knight.
However, the c5-square is weakened now.
A) 18...Nc5 was better. If 19.b4, then 19...Nb7.
B) 18...Kh7 is not very good. After 19.Nd3 Nf8 [or 19...Nd7 20.Nb4] 20.Nb4 White is better.
19.Nd3 Nd8
250
Position after: 19...Nd8
20.Bg2!
20...c6
20...Ng4 21.Bc5±
Now both bishops are on their ideal squares. White also intends 23.Nb4!.
22...a5 23.a4!
251
Position after: 23.a4!
23...bxa4
This helps White, who will dominate on the weakened c4- and c5-squares, but what else to do?!
Securing control over the c5-square and supporting the bishop’s domination.
25...Red8 26.Bb6!
26...Rd6
252
Position after: 26...Rd6
Black wants to control the d-file, but this rook will soon face problems.
27.Nc5?
27...Ng5 28.Bg2
253
Position after: 28.Bg2
28...Bf8?
29.Rb1!
After this, the game is almost over. Black cannot prevent the aforementioned move f4.
254
Position after: 30...Rf6
Black wants to complicate things. Alas, Karpov’s realisation was superb. The rook on f6 is trapped.
Game over.
34...Ng7 35.Bc5
255
Exchanging pieces and opening the file for the b1-rook.
38...Rxf4
No, Karpov did not overlook this. He calculated perfectly. His rook will dominate the 7th rank.
256
Position after: 43.Rb6
The simplest.
46...f5 47.exf6+ Kxf6 48.Ra7 Rc8 49.Ra8 Rc7 50.R5a7 Rxa7 51.Rxa7 g5 52.Bd5 Ke5 53.Bxe6 Nxe6
54.a5 Kd5 55.Re7 Nf4 56.a6
Black resigned.
1-0
Game 24
Pflichthofer – Riefner
Germany 1990
1.e4 e6 2.d4 d5 3.Nc3 Bb4 4.e5 c5 5.a3 Bxc3+ 6.bxc3 Ne7 7.Nf3 Bd7
257
Position after: 7...Bd7
This is a well-known, complex Winawer variation. White usually goes for kingside play, but the next
move is a serious mistake. Good options included 7.a4, 7.Be2 and 7.h4.
8.Bd3?
258
Position after: 9.dxc5!
After which White can go for the manoeuvre h4-h5 and Rh4, with a tempo. Black needs to manage to
play both ...c4 and ...Ba4.
A typical manoeuvre in this variation. The knight opens the path for the f-pawn and is ready to be
transferred to h5.
259
From h5, the knight attacks the pawn on g7 (the weakest point on Black’s kingside) and is ready to
jump to f6 if attacked.
The fastest way to finish development and castle long, but the queen is not ideally placed here – there is
no pressure on the white pawn chain because the black pawn advanced to c4.
11...Nbc6 12.0-0 Kd7!?
A very interesting plan invented by Jusupov in the 1970’s and revitalised by Vitiugov 30 years later.
The king is perfectly safe in the centre and the black queen is headed for h7! From there, it will support
the kingside expansion and attack the vulnerable c2-pawn, forcing some of the white troops to defend
it. Yours truly has also tested this manoeuvre successfully many times throughout his career – players
who play this line regularly with the white pieces are almost certainly not familiar with Jusupov’s idea.
12.Bd2
260
Position after: 12.Bd2
12...Nd7!?
12...Nbc6 is more common, but less flexible. In some positions, it is important to control the b4-square,
preventing doubling or tripling. On the other hand, Black thinks he doesn’t need both knights to cover
the f5-square (of course, sooner or later, White will advance his f-pawn, attacking the base of the black
pawn chain on e6).
13.0-0 0-0-0
261
Position after: 13...0-0-0
This is perhaps the key moment in the game. White must choose between two possible and natural
plans: advancing the f-pawn immediately or after transferring the knight to h5. White chooses the
wrong one.
14.f4?
14.Nf4! was better. 14...g6 looks like the best move. 15.Rb1 and the position is unclear.
Black has problems with organising a kingside attack – the very important resource of recapturing
...gxf6 is no longer available. Advancing both the g-pawn and h-pawn will only create holes. On the
other hand, White might have a hard time finding a promising plan...
14...f5!
262
Position after: 14...f5!
15.exf6?!
Of course, it is difficult to opt for something else and be stuck with a paralysed bishop pair, allowing
Black to patiently carry out a kingside attack. The text move does allow Black to establish strong
control over the e4-square.
15...gxf6!
Now it is clear that Black’s 12th move was very flexible. It looks like Black perfectly predicted that he
would have the chance to place knights on e4 and f6 (or d6), while also including ...f5. Putting the
knight on c6 instead of d7, Black would have needed an extra tempo to establish this setup.
16.Qb1 Nf5!
263
Position after: 16...Nf5!
17.Qb4?! Qxb4!
An excellent and simple decision. White’s bishop pair is absolutely useless. Black’s minor pieces will
soon dominate, so there is no particular reason to keep the queens on the board – exchanging them will
simplify Black’s task.
18.axb4
264
Position after: 18.axb4
18...Bxc2!
Another excellent decision – not so obvious this time. Black willingly gives away his potential passed
a-pawn, understanding that it would be impossible to use directly. White would be able to establish an
unbreakable blockade on the a3-square. In return, even the black bishop will control the essential e4-
square. Now, Black is clearly better.
18...Nb6 with the idea to keep a7 alive is too slow. Black simply needs too much time to launch his a-
pawn, and probably won’t succeed at all.
19.Rxa7 Nd6!
265
Position after: 19...Nd6!
Giving White a chance to make a mistake by exchanging rooks. With the rooks on the board, White has
some hope to find counterplay. Without them, even the black king can take part in the attack via the a4-
square! However, the position is almost hopeless for White due to many weaknesses and a very bad
bishop pair. Black, on the other hand, has powerful knights that have access to many good squares,
especially e4 and b5.
20.Bg4?
White plays without a plan. Black, step-by-step, convincingly increases his undisputed advantage.
266
Position after: 22...Be4
Playing against the bishop pair, it is often good to exchange our “theoretically” bad bishop against their
good one, leaving the opponent with a bad bishop. This game is a perfect example.
As previously mentioned, this exchange is clearly in Black’s favour. White’s position is hopeless.
24...Rxd8 25.Ra1
267
Position after: 25.Ra1
25...Rg8!
25...Bxf3? 26.gxf3 and evidently Black cannot make progress – the e4-square has been taken away.
26.Bxe4?
The game is over now. Black simply attacks the c3-pawn with both knights and White must leave the a-
file.
26.Kf2! Ng4+!
268
Position after: 26...Ng4+!
A) 27.Bxg4? fxg4! far better than the other capture. After 28.Ng1 Bd3!, Black will eventually
exchange his bishop for the knight and then dominate. The winning plan would be simple: exchange
the rooks and penetrate with the king either via a4 or f5! That is the point of capturing on g4 with the f-
pawn – both routes would be available to the black king. The white knight would also be paralysed and
then exchanged.
B) 27.Kg1! Black can penetrate now with 27...Bxf3 28.gxf3 Ne5+
269
29.Kf2 Nd3+ 30.Kf1 but nothing concrete is apparent. Black would be forced to find some other way
to crash White’s defences.
30.Nxe4 dxe4
The final regrouping! The knight will attack both the c3- and f4-pawns and control the blockading
square on e3. Black’s king is headed to a4.
270
Position after: 36.Kf2
36...e3+
271
41.Kh4 Kb3 42.Kxh5 Kc2 43.Ba3 Nxf4+ 44.Kg5 Nxg2
White resigned. Though White played the final stage of the game badly, it is very instructive to follow
Black’s flexible play in the opening and middlegame, along with the simple and convincing logic in the
endgame. Black setup his pawn structure advantageously – his knights clearly dominated. It does not
matter that the players are not very well known – I would remind the reader of Bobby Fischer’s advice
that old and less popular players’ games should also be analysed. Not many people do, and some
amazing ideas remain hidden for a long time. This kind of game is definitely what Fischer had in mind!
0-1
Game 25
Andersson – Kavalek
Bugojno 1980
Black chooses to place the bishop on the long diagonal. Of course, e7 is also a good square.
An interesting move, preparing to expand on the queenside. Perhaps other developing moves are more
common. But, actually, it is a matter of style.
9...a6?!
272
Position after: 9...a6?!
From a certain point of view, this move is logical, because it prepares ...b5, which can be a counter to
White’s move b4. From another point of view, it weakens the b6-square. Thus, White’s next move is
natural – it opens the diagonal for the bishop to be placed on e3.
10.dxe5 Nxe5?!
10...dxe5 should be preferred. Black needs the knight on d7 to cover the very important c5-square and
to protect the pawn on e5. The other knight on f6 is ready to disturb the bishop on e3 by jumping to g4.
Thus, White must waste time with h3. After the text move, Black is the one who must waste time by
moving the knight back to d7 (before or after activating the c8-bishop).
273
Position after: 12.Be3
12...Be6
12...Qxd1 13.Rexd1 Be6 14.f3 Rfd8 [14...Nd7? 15.Nd5! cxd5 16.cxd5±] 15.Na4 is still unpleasant for
Black.
13.Qc2
13...Ng4?
274
Position after: 13...Ng4?
A terrible mistake. White will voluntarily give Black the bishop pair. Actually, White’s minor pieces
will dominate the board, controlling the weak b6- and c5-squares. Black’s bishop on e6 is desperately
bad, attacking a well-protected pawn and is restricted because of it. The bishop on g7 can only be used
to control weaknesses on the queenside and can also easily be exchanged. It looks like Black’s position
is almost hopeless – White smoothly carries out the game, despite Black not making any more
mistakes.
Simply restricting the bishop and making the d1-square available for the white rooks.
275
Position after: 17...Qe7
18.Bb6!
The knight goes to c5 and the black rooks cannot use the d8-square. White has enough time to prepare
various ventures – Black lacks even one real plan.
18...h5?!
What for?
19.Nc5 Bh6
The bishop desperately needs a better diagonal. Alas, a new diagonal will not bring much either.
276
Position after: 21...Bg5
22.Qf2!
Excellent prophylaxis.
It is very useful to establish “overcontrol” of blockading squares – this time, the queen on f2 will
control the entire weak dark-squared complex, both c5 and b6. White will be able to regroup later,
while staying in control.
22...Qf8 23.b3
Don’t rush.
23...Be7 24.Nd7!
Now the idea behind Qf2 is visible. The c5-square is controlled even after exchanging the knight for
the bishop on c8.
277
Position after: 24.Nd7!
Black cannot capture this knight – the white rooks would penetrate. This knight is a real thorn in
Black’s side, paralysing the entire black army. The game is practically over.
24...Qg7 25.a4
Before trying to find a possibility to realise the advantage, White prematurely fixes the black queenside
pawns.
25...Bb4 26.Bc5!
278
Position after: 26.Bc5!
White has full control over the d-file and the bishop is no longer needed. It is important to exchange it
for Black’s, which controls the infiltration squares.
28...Bb8 29.Nc5
279
followed by Rd8 would lead to a funny end to the game. Look at the black pieces!
29.Qxb6
Mission accomplished.
29...f5
30.h3
Everything wins. After exchanging pawns on e4 and removing the knight from d7, the “active” move
...Bg4 is prevented. Maybe White also wanted to make space for the king. The move is actually a
demonstration of power.
280
Position after: 32.Rd6
Black resigned. A tremendous defeat. Black lost so smoothly after his awful 13th move. He fell victim
to an illusion – the bishop pair was actually a handicap for Black in this relatively open position. It is
strange that an experienced grandmaster made such a mistake. Anyway, it was once again a great
pleasure to watch a confident and superb Andersson realisation.
1-0
Game 26
Wolf – Rubinstein
Teplitz Schoenau 1922
1.e4 e5 2.Nf3 Nc6 3.Nc3 Nf6 4.Bb5 Bb4 5.0-0 0-0 6.d3 d6 7.Bg5 Bxc3 8.bxc3 Qe7 9.Re1 Nd8
281
Position after: 9...Nd8
Rubinstein was recognised as a great expert of the Four Knights’ opening, especially the Metger
variation, played in this game. His last moves are about eliminating the unpleasant pin.
10.d4 Bg4
11.h3 Bh5
282
Position after: 13...h6
14.Nxg6?
This is the first mistake. White must not open the f-file for Black – his f2-pawn is backward! Instead,
the knight should be placed on f5, aiming to open the e-file for the rook on e1.
283
Closing the kingside forever.
Black’s knights must be better than the white bishops. The light-squared bishop targets nothing, while
the dark-squared one targets very well protected pawns.
17.Bg3 Nf7
18.Qf3 Rae8
19.Qe3 b6
284
Position after: 22.a5
It is natural that White wants to somehow open the position for his bishops and accelerate upcoming
events – slow play would suit Black.
The problem is that White cannot successfully open the position in the centre – opening the a-file is
only a superficial achievement. Black’s knights will still dominate. In fact, Black will use the a-file to
his advantage.
Of course, Black should insist on keeping a piece on f4, but it is not obvious how else to proceed.
Rubinstein decided to offer this knight up for exchange. After the exchange on f4, the f3-pawn would
no longer be weak, but White loses his main defender – the g3-bishop.
24.Bf1 Kh8
285
Position after: 24...Kh8
25.Bxf4
White eliminates the dangerous knight. Yes, it is dangerous to only play with the light-squared bishop
on the board, with such a great number of weak and potentially weak dark squares, but it is very
difficult to suggest another plan.
25...gxf4 26.Qf2 g5
286
Position after: 26...g5
The situation has transformed into a position where Black’s knight dominates over White’s bishop.
Seeing as he cannot use the d8-h4 diagonal for infiltration, Rubinstein decided to fix the kingside,
hoping to organise play down the h-file on the queenside.
27.d5?!
White must keep the tension for as long as possible. He hopes that blocking the queenside will help
him, but the rest of the game seems to prove him wrong. The so-called Wyvill formation arose on the
queenside, and White cannot stop Black’s knight dominating from the c5-square.
27...h5 28.Bg2
28.Bb5 stopping the knight manoeuvre was more logical, although Black is definitely better.
30.Kf2 Ra8
287
Position after: 33...Nc5
Simultaneously attacking on both sides, Black achieved a lot. White must diminish Black’s initiative
and carefully exchange pieces – perhaps the minor piece endgame is desperately lost.
34.Rh1 Rh4
288
Position after: 36.Bh3
36...bxa5!
Rubinstein wants to create a passed a-pawn. He will practically be a pawn up due to the doubled c-
pawns. It is useful to remark that White should not capture on b6 – this would give Black a passed a-
pawn and pressure down the c-file.
Black patiently improves his position on the queenside. The bishop must block the h-pawn, the threat of
advancing it followed by infiltrating the queen is very dangerous.
Of course, the king is a much better blockading piece than the bishop. It can even infiltrate after the
advance of the h-pawn.
289
Position after: 44.Rh1
44...a5
That push decides the game. The pawn bravely heads for promotion.
45.Bg2
45.Qxa5 Rb2 with the threats of ...Nb3 and ...Qb6 with further infiltration is decisive.
290
Position after: 48...Ra8
The queen and rook are in corners – long live the active king! Just for a brief moment, the black major
pieces are passive.
291
Position after: 53...Nc5
54.Qc1 Rb8!
Finally finding the plan. 55...Rb2 is a dangerous threat. Eliminating this threat, the queen will be
deflected from the h-file.
The black queen joins the party and the game is over.
White resigned. A very instructive game. The pair of bishops was inferior to the pair of knights due to a
fixed structure, not allowing the position to be opened. Later, it was transformed into a position with
clear domination of the knight over the bishop. Sometimes, visually big advantages cannot be
converted that easily. Actually, the advantage was not huge, and Black needed to open lines on both
sides to finally break through.
292
Chapter 4
Open Files
By default, rooks should be placed on open (or semi-open) files. But, what to do if there are several of
them? How to react when the opponent controls the open file? When should you exchange rooks?
The answers, of course, depend on the properties of the position. They also depend on a player’s
intentions. The reader will find many answers in this chapter (and book) regarding open files and the
principles surrounding them. The reader will learn to base the importance of a file on targets and
infiltration squares. There will be many helpful positions to show when to exchange or not. Using a file
as a trampoline will also be shown. The principle of temporarily closing a file (and opening it after
doubling or tripling) will also be demonstrated, along with, finally, material about reducing the
opponent’s domination on a file by using another. I am sure you will be able to recognise the utility of
these examples and implement the various principles in your future games.
Game 27
Botvinnik – Alekhine
Netherlands 1938
6.e3
6.e4 Nxc3 7.bxc3 cxd4 8.cxd4 Bb4+ was tested in the rematch Alekhine – Euwe, Alekhine was
recognised as an expert on this line. So, Botvinnik deviates.
293
6...Nc6 7.Bc4 cxd4 8.exd4 Be7 9.0-0 0-0 10.Re1
Both sides logically spent the previous moves finishing development and castling. On the board is a
classical position with an isolated central pawn on the d-file. White has more space and slightly more
active pieces. On the other hand, the black knight on c6 controls the e5-outpost.
Black installed a knight on d5, but it is not supported by another one. White can capture on d5 and
force Black to recapture with a pawn. Positions with isolated pawns were always to Botvinnik’s liking.
He always treated them logically and superbly (especially when he had the isolated pawn). His games
are very instructive for understanding various positions with isolated pawns.
10...b6?!
294
Position after: 12.Bb5
Black is now forced to use passive defence. His main problem is the lack of harmony in his army.
White will occupy the c-file and finish development first. The weakened squares a6 and especially c6
may also play an important role.
12...Bd7?
This move is not precise. Soon the light-squared bishops will be exchanged. However, this will be,
maybe paradoxically, in White’s favour.
12...Bb7 13.Qa4 Rc8 14.Bf4 a6 looks like a more solid defence.
13.Qa4 Nb8
Controlling the very important c6- and d7-squares and targeting the pawn on a6.
295
Position after: 16.Qa4
16...Bd6
Black naturally wants to reduce the pressure by exchanging one of his passive pieces for an active one.
White dominates on both open files. Black’s pieces are passive. Strategically, the game is almost over.
Unfortunately for Alekhine, Botvinnik, even in the 1930s, was certainly strong enough to convert this.
18...Ra7
296
Position after: 18...Ra7
19.Qc2!
Preventing the move ...Rc7, exchanging material. It is very instructive to see the simple but strong
strategy chosen by White in the rest of the game.
19...Re7
Black, understandably, goes for simplifications, but White has two major pieces on the c-file ready to
infiltrate. 19...Nd7 after 20.Qc6 Qxc6 21.Rxc6 leads to penetration of the white pieces and a probably
hopeless position for Black.
21...Qxc7 22.Rxc7
297
Position after: 22.Rxc7
White has an undisputed advantage. The rook dominates in the black camp, paralysing Black’s knight
(and even the king in the future). Alekhine’s next move may look ugly because it opens up the 7th rank,
but it actually reduces the influence of the white rook! Black’s rook will oppose it using the f7- and f8-
squares. Also, the move played in the game restricts the white knights.
22...f6! 23.Kf1
23.Rb7? Rc8! 24.Kf1 b5 looks like a big achievement for Black. White cannot win without using the
king and knight. It is time to activate them.
298
Position after: 25.Rc3!
The rook temporarily takes up a “passive” position. Of course, even on the 3rd rank it can be active,
attacking the black queenside pawns, creating some weaknesses! Actually, the rook will soon return to
the 7th rank – immediately so if Black moves the knight or king. Black is in some kind of zugzwang
and he decides to lessen the importance of the 7th rank by removing targets from it.
25...g5!
A) 25...Nd7 26.Rc7±
B) 25...Kf7 26.Rc7+±
26.Ne1!
An excellent move. The knight is on its way to f5 via c2 and e3. Another possibility is to place it on b4.
26...h5
299
Position after: 26...h5
27.h4!!
After this deep strategical move, new weaknesses will inevitably arise in Black’s camp. After
eliminating the g5-pawn, the f4-square will become accessible for the white knight. If Black waits, the
exchange on g5 will give White control over the e5-square. Indeed, this powerful pawn thrust is
connected to the activation of the knight!
27...Nd7
300
Position after: 29.Nf3!
A typical manoeuvre for Botvinnik. Such moves became his trademark! He is ready to lose a tempo, or
even two, in order to provoke the advance of the g-pawn – which will create weaknesses.
Black prevented the installation of the knight on f4, but his pawns are so advanced and lack piece
support. The entire black army is over-stretched and without harmony.
32.f3
Fixing the target on f4. Please, take a look at the black knight and how restricted it is. Black is hopeless.
32.Nb4 wins material. But after 32...Nf6 33.Nxa6 f3 there are some chances for Black. White keeps
both pieces on the board and plays without hurrying.
32...gxf3 33.gxf3 a5
301
Position after: 33...a5
34.a4
Black’s pieces are paralysed. Both the knight and rook must protect the exposed pawns.
36.Kf2 Rf5
302
Position after: 38.Ke2
The idea is to move the king to c4 and advance the b-pawn, destroying the black queenside pawn
structure.
38...Nb8
Setting a trap.
39.Rg6!
39...Kc7
The realisation method is a matter of style. 41.Rg5 looks like a faster win. 41...Rxg5? 42.hxg5 Kd6
43.g6 Ke7 44.g7
303
Position after: 44.Nxd5
Just note the difference in the knights’ activity in this game. The black one achieved nothing, while the
white one danced around and wreaked havoc.
The knights have disappeared now, but White has both a material and positional advantage. The game
is over.
47.Rxh5 Rc6
Black resigned. Alekhine’s words perfectly explain the struggle: “Of the 14 games I played in this
tournament, only once did I feel that my opponent outplayed me – it was the game with Botvinnik in
round seven”.
1-0
Game 28
Andersson – Limp
Rio de Janeiro 1985
1.Nf3 Nf6 2.c4 c5 3.Nc3 Nc6 4.g3 g6 5.Bg2 Bg7 6.0-0 0-0 7.d4 d6 8.dxc5 dxc5 9.Bf4
304
Position after: 9.Bf4
Due to the symmetry in this open position, Black must play precisely.
Apparently, this is a mistake. Black spent two moves to... open the diagonal for the g2-bishop!
10...Nc6! was correct. After 11.Bf4 Nd4, White has to find another plan...
Black’s experiment failed. White has better development. It is very difficult for Black to develop his
queenside pieces.
305
Position after: 12...Kxg7
Tarrasch said once that a knight is always badly placed on b6. Of course, that was self-criticism and a
joke, but there is also some truth in that statement. This game supports Tarrasch’s claim.
Black tries, step-by-step, to get rid of White’s pressure on the long diagonal. Meanwhile, White will
secure domination on the d-file.
306
Position after: 17...Nc7
18.f4!?
18...Be6 19.Ne4
Forcing ...b6, after which c6 will be weak. Another idea is Ng5, eliminating the piece controlling d7.
19...b6 20.Ng5 a5
21.Kf2
21...Bc8
307
Position after: 21...Bc8
22.Bc6
A typical Andersson move. No actual threats. Black can no longer fight for the d-file and Andersson
just wants to underline White’s domination. The move has great psychological effect.
22...f6?!
After 22...Ne6 23.Nxe6+ Bxe6 24.Bd7 we see the clear point of Bc6. White eliminates the e6-bishop
and prepares infiltration with Rd7.
308
Position after: 25.g4
White even gains space on the kingside. Andersson’s style is perfect. After some “slow” moves, he
makes active ones. Such a playing rhythm is very dangerous for the opponent.
25...Bb7?
And Black’s defences collapse. Now White’s rooks invade the 7th rank.
The position is hopeless for Black. White’s rook and knight dominate.
309
Position after: 28...Rb8
Black is lacking any counterplay. So many squares are available to White’s knight, and none for
Black’s. Even White’s king can take part in the attack.
33.Ke2
310
Black is fully paralysed and there is no reason to rush. By choosing a slow rhythm, the opponent has
the chance to make a mistake – helping us to realise our advantage. Also, at any moment, the rhythm
may be changed. The most important is to patiently activate all pieces, so... let’s activate the king! And
so, the king embarks on the long journey, the target is the c6-square!
33...Kc8?
Black resigned. White’s king comes to d5 and the pawn endgame is easily winning. One of many
Andersson games that reflects his patient playing style at its best... After taking control of the d-file,
White was able to patiently increase the pressure, without real counterplay for the opponent.
Game 29
Alapin – Rubinstein
Prague 1908
Alapin was a great attacking player and he always tried to set fire to the position. On the other hand,
Rubinstein was a great strategist and decided to play carefully and patiently to tame White’s
aggression.
311
It is evident that the idea of White’s attack is gone, and so he switches to a strategical treatment. The
game is quite balanced.
9.f5??
9...Nd4! 10.Qg3?!
A desperate bluff.
10.Qd1 Nxb5 11.Nxb5 c6 12.Nc3 Nxf5 is winning easily.
312
Position after: 10.Qg3?!
10...Nxb5?
Rubinstein was not a player who liked to take risks. He was always more dedicated to strategy than
tactics. Still, it was not very difficult to calculate that Black should take a risk, with an easy win.
10...Nxc2+! 11.Ke2 [11.Kd1 Nxa1 12.Bh6 Nxf5 13.exf5 Qf6–+] 11...Nxa1 12.Bh6
313
12...Ng6!–+
11.Nxb5 f6
Eliminating both Bh6 and f6 threats and preparing to play in the centre.
After some mistakes from both sides, the situation has stabilised. The game shall continue in a
positional manner. Black already has some initiative and it is not difficult to guess who won. From now
on, all of Rubinstein’s moves are full of logic and it is highly recommended to analyse them carefully.
In the diagram position, Black is slightly better. He is already putting pressure on the white pawn chain,
while White cannot easily do the same. If White manages to secure his pawn chain, he would have a
good chance to launch his g-pawn. Then, attacking f6 (the pawn chain) would be connected with
mating motifs. Thus, Black decided to exchange queens – without queens on the board, White’s actions
on the kingside would no longer be dangerous for Black. After exchanging queens, as in the game,
Black will even have a semi-open a-file. A potentially crucial factor.
314
Position after: 18.Rf2
18...Rd7
Black doubles on the d-file first, before capturing. Remember this technique. Placing the rooks first,
Black will wait for the right moment to capture on e4. Very often, the threat is more dangerous than the
execution!
A) 18...dxe4 19.dxe4 Rd3 20.Nc2 doesn’t give much to Black.
315
Position after: 20.Nc2
B) 18...b5 was also very good. In such positions, it is important and useful to advance doubled pawns in
order to keep flexibility of the pawn structure. The opponent, normally, should try and prevent their
advance, fixing both pawns!
21...Nc8?!
21...b5 was more precise, before White plays a4. This pawn must be advanced.
22.Rfe2
22...b5!
23.Na1
23...Nb6 24.Nb3
316
Position after: 24.Nb3
24...Na4!
A much better option for the knight. Not only does it control the c5-square, but it also targets both the
white pawns and cannot be attacked because the c3-pawn would fall. Also, the c6-pawn may now
advance.
25.Kf2 c5!
Kicking the white knight away, its black counterpart will then be transferred to c5, attacking the pawn
on e4 and threatening to jump to d3.
26.Rc2
317
Position after: 26.Rc2
White’s pieces are cramped and focused on defence. Black strongly holds the d-file, the knight is on a
great square, but there is still nothing concrete. The great Nimzowitsch, a couple of decades later in his
capital opus My System, explained the “principle of two weaknesses”. The point is that the side with
more space and more active pieces should have better “communication lines”. If the opponent has one
weakness, it is important to create another weakness on the opposite part of the board. Then,
simultaneously attacking both of them, one would eventually fall – the opponent would not be able to
transfer his defences fast enough. In our game, White takes care of the d-file – his pieces cover the
infiltration squares. Therefore, Rubinstein felt he must create another front!
318
Position after: 29...Kf7
A very fine move. Not only is it a good centralising move, it also has a great psychological effect.
White cannot find a reasonable plan and it is extremely uncomfortable to idly watch the opponent
improve his position move by move.
30.Rf1 Rd1
Keeping the rook on the 1st rank was also good, but Black would rather control the d-file. White cannot
oppose this.
319
Position after: 35...bxc4
Black is perfectly centralised. The king is able to protect the knight, so the rook can infiltrate on d1,
once again.
36.Rb2 Rd1
The game is over. White will soon face a zugzwang. He cannot protect all his weak pawns.
320
Position after: 38...Kc7!
39.Rb4
Black’s knight gallops around, gobbling up white pawns along the way. Ultimately, the centralised
black troops didn’t give a chance to White’s resistance.
42.Ra4 Kc6
321
Position after: 45.Rf8
45...Ne3
Once again, small and useful tactics. White’s knight looks like a policeman on a crossroads, with
significant traffic around it.
46.Rg8
46...Nxg2+ 47.Kf2 Nxh4 48.Rd8+ Ke4 49.Ng3+ Kf4 50.Ne2+ Kg4 51.Rc8 Rf3+
White resigned. This game has a serious opening flaw. Still, followers should thank Rubinstein for his
decision on move 10. If Rubinstein had captured the a1-rook, he would have deprived us of such a
beautiful and instructive endgame.
0-1
Game 30
Rubinstein – Takacs
Budapest 1926
1.c4 Nf6 2.d4 e6 3.Nc3 d5 4.Bg5 Nbd7 5.e3 Be7 6.Nf3 0-0 7.Rc1 c6 8.Qc2 a6
322
Position after: 8...a6
9.cxd5
9...exd5
323
Position after: 11...Nf8
In this position, White has three solid plans. One is related to queenside play, using a minority attack,
but it requires long preparation. Another is kingside play with Ne5, f4, etc... However, Rubinstein
always chose plans connected with playing in the centre – his next move prepares the e4-advance.
The knight also supports the e4-advance, with or without the move f3. It can also be transferred to the
promising c5- and a5-squares. Multi-purpose moves were Rubinstein’s trademark and the reader
should, as often as possible, try to find them over the board.
13...N6d7
324
Position after: 13...N6d7
Black offers the exchange of dark-squared bishops, which is generally in White’s favour, but...
14.Bf4!
It was logical to exchange bishops, but Rubinstein was right to refuse. White’s bishop on f4 will control
the very important diagonal, preventing, for instance, such moves as ...Bd6, ...Qc7 and ...Rb8. At the
same time, Black’s e7-bishop attacks well protected white pawns, making it restricted. The bishop on
f4 is definitely more active than its counterpart on e7.
14...Bg5
15.h3!
15...Bh5
17...Nxg6 keeps the pawn structure more flexible and solid, but the g6-knight is out of play – Black
planned to place it on e6.
325
18.Qb3
Now, the domination of the h2-bishop is evident – Black has problems in protecting the b7-pawn.
18...Qb6
18...Qc8? 19.Nxd5
19.Na4!
Another option is 20...Bd8, preventing White’s next move. White can go for 21.Nbc5 Nxc5 22.Nxc5,
forcing Black to put the rook on a passive square: a7.
21.Na5!
326
Position after: 21.Na5!
Excellent. The knight attacks both the b7- and c6-pawns, making the move ...b6 impossible. Placing the
knight on c5 instead, ...b6 would have been possible at some point. Some would say that a5 is not an
“outpost” (according to great Aron Nimzowitsch). That is correct, but a5 is a much better square in this
position. Furthermore, the other knight can jump to c5.
21...Ra7 22.Kf1
A very nice prophylactic move. The king approaches the centre and protects the rook, eliminating ideas
of ...Nxd4 (for instance after Rc2, to double up).
22...Bd8 23.b4!±
Black hoped to benefit from attacking the a5-knight, but it is clear now that he should have prevented
Na5 in the first place. Of course, taking the knight leads to a disaster – White will double the rooks on
the b-file and inevitably collect the b7-pawn.
23...f5
Trying to find some play on the opposite side, but weakening the e5-square.
24.Nb2
From d3, the knight will keep an eye on the squares c5 and e5, and stop the move ...f4.
327
Position after: 26.Rc2
26...Bb6
26...Bc7 27.Bxc7 Nxc7 28.Nc5 Nxc5 29.bxc5 Ne6 30.Rb2 Re7 31.Reb1 Nd8 leads to such a passive
position for Black – probably undefendable. White can organise long-term, patient play on the
kingside, using the fact that the black pieces are paralysed due to the weakness of the b7-pawn.
27.Bd6!
Patient and strong. White progressively improves his position. The bishop is ready to come to c5 and
feels very comfortable so deep in the opponent’s ranks.
27...Nd8 28.Nc5!
328
Position after: 28.Nc5!
Correct!
28...Nxc5
28...Bxc5 is worse. After 29.bxc5, Black is hopeless against the attack on the b7-pawn.
329
We are already familiar with this pawn structure. Black’s b7-pawn is desperately weak. Three pieces
must be used to protect it. Thus, the a7-rook will be out of play for a while. After doubling the rooks on
the b-file, White must switch focus to the kingside. Pressure on the b-file is the most important
positional factor.
34.Kd3 is also normal, but the text move is better. White wants to use the king on the kingside.
34...Re4
In order to make progress, White must open the position on the kingside. Then, he will be able to
exploit the paralysis of the a7-rook. White’s next move is logical and a direct approach – it leads to
opening new files.
35.g4 g6
330
Position after: 37.h4
37...gxh4
37...Nh6!? was better. But still, after 38.hxg5 [38.gxf5 g4+] 38...fxg4+ [38...Nxg4 39.Rh1+–] 39.Kg2!
Nf5 40.Rh1, Black’s position looks hopeless.
White finally penetrates after opening a file on the kingside. The game is over – the rest is a matter of
technique.
39...Nd8 40.Rg8
331
Position after: 40.Rg8
40...f4?
41.Rh8?
Alas, Rubinstein misses an immediate win. I think that such masters are so dedicated and focused on
strategy that they do not expect such gifts from their opponents.
41.Nc4!+–
332
Position after: 42...Kd7
43.Rg2?
Missing the immediate transfer of the knight towards the centre twice, White finally goes for it.
333
Position after: 48...Ra8
Overprotecting the d8-knight because the other rook will soon leave the d7-square.
49.Nd3 b5
52...Rc8
334
Position after: 52...Rc8
53.Kg4!
55.Rh7+
335
Position after: 55.Rh7+
1.e4 e5 2.Nf3 Nc6 3.Bb5 a6 4.Ba4 Nf6 5.0-0 Be7 6.Re1 b5 7.Bb3 d6 8.c3 0-0 9.h3 Na5 10.Bc2 c5
11.d4 Qc7 12.Nbd2 Nc6
336
Position after: 12...Nc6
Normal moves for the Ruy Lopez. Anatoly Karpov was recognised as an expert on this opening. This
game is one of his numerous masterpieces.
13.d5
White wants to close the centre and launch kingside play according to the usual scheme of Nd2-f1-g3
(with or without g2-g4) and to prepare f2-f4 in favourable conditions. He is ready to keep the position
stable or blocked on the queenside, but if needed, that side can be opened with a2-a4. 13.Nf1 is also
playable, keeping various possibilities in the centre.
13...Nd8
Knowing the rest of the game, Black should have tried something else.
13...Nb8, with the idea to place the knight on d7, was solid. The knight looks more flexible there than
on b7.
14.a4!
337
Position after: 14.a4!
Black cannot connect rooks after his next move, so the move chosen by Karpov is very logical.
14...Rb8
14...Bb7 15.axb5 axb5 16.Rxa8 Bxa8 17.b3 looks better for White. He is ready to switch activities to
the kingside and to block the position on the queenside whatever Black chooses (...b4 or ...c4).
16.b3, with the same idea as in the previous line, was also a natural decision. The text move is more
aggressive, though. Karpov immediately blocks the position on the queenside and paralyses the black
rook, bishop and knight.
16...Nb7
338
Position after: 19.Re3!
the queen must retreat: 19...Qc8 [19...Qxb4?? 20.Ba3+–] 20.Rea3 with a significant advantage for
White.
White patiently finishes development, while the black pieces struggle to find comfortable positions.
339
18...Ra8 19.Qd2 Rfc8 20.Bd3 g6 21.Ng3
White has more options and can go for multi-functional moves. After placing all his pieces on optimal
squares, he goes for infiltration down the a-file.
21...Bf8 22.Ra2!
22...c4?
Positional capitulation. Black hoped that blocking the position would reduce White’s growing initiative
on the queenside. Actually, White has control over the a-file and the a7-g1 diagonal, which is enough.
On the kingside, long-term possibilities are still available.
22...Rxa2 23.Qxa2 cxb4 24.cxb4 Qc3 25.Qb1 is undoubtedly better for White. Black temporarily
prevents infiltration, but there will soon be problems with the b5-pawn, which can also be attacked by
the white queen and knight...
23.Bb1
The bishop looks passive here, but it can easily be transferred to e2, for instance, and prevents Black’s
possible ...f7-f5 thrust.
23...Qd8
340
Position after: 23...Qd8
24.Ba7!!
A key move, and a famous one! One of Karpov’s trademarks. White temporarily closes the a-file,
making time to double or even triple. Then, the bishop will be removed and the rooks will infiltrate!
Yes, chess is actually a rather simple game! Black cannot prevent White’s plan – the bishop on a7 is
untouchable!
Consistent.
341
Position after: 29...Bg7
Black’s pieces wander aimlessly. Karpov felt that this was the best moment to switch sides.
30.f4 f6
30...exf4 31.Nxf4 is much better for White. There are new possibilities on the kingside, related to the
potential use of the weak f6- and h6-squares after playing Bd4 and Ng4, for instance... The point is that
Black cannot transfer a knight to the perfect outpost on e5, while many white pieces have access to the
important d4-square. The backward pawn on e4 is not a weakness, of course, as the black rooks cannot
use the e-file.
31.f5!
Another great decision. Black’s lack of space is being felt more and more. Of course, he should
somehow open the position to get fresh air, but it is very difficult to find a way.
342
Position after: 31.f5!
31...g5
31...gxf5 32.exf5 will give White both the perfect blockading square on e4 for his knight and a very
dangerous majority on the kingside.
32.Bc2
32...Bf7
32...h5 33.Bd1 followed by Ng3 will finally force Black to advance the h-pawn once again. Then,
White will open the position on the kingside with g2-g3. Black would be hopeless.
Black is forced to wait for an execution. Admire Karpov’s patient regrouping and brutal realisation.
343
Position after: 35...Qe8
37...Kf8 38.R1a2
344
Position after: 40...Kg8
After putting all his pieces on optimal squares, Karpov goes for the kill.
41.Bxf7+ Nxf7
345
Position after: 43.Qg6!
Nice point.
43...Kf8
43...Qxg6 44.fxg6 would be a more beautiful position for the end of the game – the knights will
inevitably invade f5 and h5.
44.Nh5 1-0
Black resigned. What a strategical triumph! After White placed the bishop on a7, Black was forced for
a long time to take care of the incoming infiltration along the a-file. This caused some paralysis and
White effectively crushed Black’s defences on the opposite side of the board. Please, feel free to watch
this beautiful game over and over again. There are so many instructive moments, and a picturesque
final position.
346
Game 32
Nimzowitsch – Capablanca
New York 1927
Nimzowitsch was always preoccupied with theory, but this move is definitely not dangerous for Black.
Actually, even at the height of his powers, he could not outplay the great Cuban genius. Capablanca’s
simple and natural playing style usually easily prevailed over Nimzowitsch’s ingenuity.
4...Bxd3 5.Qxd3 e6
Some sort of Advanced French has appeared. Black has achieved his main goal – the light-squared
bishops are no longer.
6.Nc3 Qb6
347
Position after: 6...Qb6
7.Nge2
7.Nce2 deserved attention. White should play on the kingside and strengthen d4 with a pawn on c3.
But, Nimzowitsch preferred to piece play, not fearing the exchange of his centre.
348
9...Ne7
9...Nc6 was a more precise move, eliminating the possibility that White missed on the next move.
10.Na4
10.b4!? was a very interesting option. After 10...Qxb4 11.Nb5 Qa5 12.Be3, interesting complications
arise.
In this position, where White played more originally than inventively, Black is problem free and
probably even slightly better. With his next move, White follows his strategy based on installing a
piece on d4 and attacking on the kingside.
Three pieces protect this pawn – all of them are hence restricted. White will not be able to advance f5,
so this move cannot be very good. Although, for now, everything looks OK for White.
13...Nf5
349
Position after: 13...Nf5
14.c3?!
14...Nc6
Capablanca later noted that it is important that Black can still choose where to castle. So, now we know
why he delayed castling. He was trying to find the best place for the king, predicting that a major piece
endgame would soon arise.
15.Rad1?!
Alekhine criticised this move because the rook does nothing on the d-file and suggested the preparation
of the move c4 instead. However, in the same year, Nimzowitsch formulated his theory about the
blockade – one important postulate was that as many pieces as possible should control the blockading
square (d4 in this case).
15.Bf2 looks better, with the idea of preparing c4 or g4.
350
Position after: 15.Rad1?!
15...g6?!
It is strange that Capablanca chooses such a move, doing nothing but setting a great positional trap.
But, it worked...
A) 15...0-0
B) or 15...h5
were more natural moves.
16.g4?
Natural looking, but actually a very bad move. This move forcingly leads to the blocking of the
kingside, leaving the queenside as the only open front.
(15...g6?!) 16.Bf2, later suggested by Alekhine (Nimzowitsch agreed), was a normal move. After
16...h5 17.c4 the position is balanced, with chances for both sides.
351
Position after: 17...h5!
18.g5
All the files on the kingside are definitively closed. Black will patiently organise play on the semi-open
c-file.
18.h3? hxg4 19.hxg4 0-0-0! gives Black a dangerous attack on the h-file
18...0-0
The situation has stabilised. Black’s king is safe and White’s expansion on the kingside failed
miserably, leaving his king desperately weak. However, it is very difficult for Black to convert his
evident advantage due to White’s control over the d4-outpost. Black’s hunt for the white king must
commence on the queenside. Once the d4-outpost is conquered, Black will have the chance to catch
White’s king. The next stage is clear. Black tries to put pressure on d4 and the c3-pawn.
352
Position after: 20...Rfc8
21.a3?!
White wants to protect all his pawns. This move was, perhaps, also psychological, showing Black that
the b4-square is fully controlled. Alas, Black must go for the ...b5-b4 break, or the game would be
drawn.
A waste of time, but still not a bad move. The opponent doesn’t have an active plan, so various
attempts are allowed in order to crush the opponent’s defences.
23.Re2
353
Position after: 23.Re2
White must be patient, trying to be ready to counter Black’s activities on the queenside.
23...Re8
In order to prevent the potential blow f4-f5. No reason to be impatient. Don’t rush! 23...Nc4 24.Qc1
doesn’t give much to Black. The d4-knight is a key defensive piece and it must be exchanged, at the
right time.
24.Kg2 Nc6!
354
Position after: 24...Nc6!
Great masters are not conceited – they know when to own up to their mistakes...
25.Red2
In case of 25.Nxc6, suggested by Alekhine, Black has two promising plans: 25...Qxc6 [25...bxc6
26.Qxb6 axb6 27.Kf3 Ra8] 26.Rd4 [26.Qxa7?? b6 27.Qa6 Ra8–+] 26...Qb6. Both moves give a small
but lasting edge.
25...Rec8
26.Re2
26.Nxc6!? was possible again, with continuations resembling those in the previous note.
355
Position after: 27...Rc4
The black rook is ready to be transferred to e4, if the d4-knight were to move. A typical use of a semi-
open file – an outpost can be utilised for transferring a rook to another file. As Capablanca stated
afterwards, this position is White’s maximum, it’s all he can hope to achieve.
28.Qh3?!
Nimzowitsch dreams about advancing f5. It was better to make a neutral waiting move, keeping the
queen in the centre.
28.Qf2!?
28...Kg7 29.Rf2
29.f5? Nxf5 30.Nxf5+ gxf5 31.Rd4 [31.Qxh5? Rg4+ 32.Rg3 Rh8–+] 31...Kg6µ
29...a5
Black has secured the kingside and is ready to launch his queenside pawns.
30.Re2 Nf5!
356
Position after: 30...Nf5!
Right on time! The d4-knight is not supported well enough. Also, the h5-pawn is not in danger.
31.Nxf5+
31.Red2 Nxd4
32.Qe3!? [32.Rxd4 Rxd4 33.cxd4 Qb5µ with an almost winning position.] 32...Qb5 33.Rxd4 Rxd4
357
34.Qxd4 Rc4 35.Qf2 Re4 is much better for Black – White has lost control of the all important d4-
outpost.
31...gxf5 32.Qf3
34.Qf2 [34.Rf2 Rcxf4 35.Qxf4 Rxf4 36.Rxf4 Qxb2+–+; 34.Rd4 Rg4+ 35.Kf1 Rxd4 36.cxd4 Qxd4–+]
34...Rg4+ 35.Rg3 Qxf2+ 36.Rxf2 Rgxf4 is almost lost for White.
32...Kg6
358
Position after: 32...Kg6
Black has achieved a lot. His king is safe, the kingside blockade is stable and White has lost control of
the d4-outpost.
33.Red2 Re4!
Very simple, but very strong. Black can benefit from the c-file later, now it is important to control the
d4-square.
34.Rd4 Rc4
Capablanca stated that White should exchange rooks, despite the queen endgame being winning for
Black, due to the exposed white king and weak f4-pawn.
35.Qf2
35.Rxc4!? Rxc4 36.Qf2 Qb3 is much better for Black, ...b5-b4 may be on the cards.
35...Qb5 36.Kg3
359
Position after: 36.Kg3
Again, the white pieces are on the best defensive squares. On the other hand, Black’s pieces are on the
ultimate attacking ones. Thus, pawn action is needed. However, perhaps prematurely, Black creates one
more weakness in White’s camp – the d4-pawn!
36...Rcxd4 37.cxd4
37.Rxd4? Re2–+
37...Qc4
White is paralysed. Knowing that Capablanca is conducting the black pieces, the rest is matter of
technique. There was no player of the past with better conversion technique than the Cuban legend.
360
Position after: 40...axb4!
Of course, taking with the queen would be nonsensical. Black wants to weaken the b2-pawn, not
exchange it. If needed, the black pawn can be moved to b3, securing the important c2-square.
41.Kg2 Qc1
42.Kg3 Qh1!
361
Position after: 42...Qh1!
43.Rd3
A) 43.Re2? h4+!–+
B) 43.Qf3? h4+!–+
C) 43.Qg2 Re3+ 44.Kh4 Qxg2 45.Rxg2 Rf3–+ is a funny line.
43...Re1 44.Rf3
Now, and on the next moves, I suggest the reader tries to find a win after other white moves.
44...Rd1 45.b3
45...Rc1!
46.Re3 Rf1!
White resigned. It was a real pleasure to see the perfect exploitation of the c-file and the beautiful way
in which Jose Raul Capablanca employed his major pieces.
0-1
362
Game 33
Nimzowitsch – Tarrasch
Breslau 1925
5.d4
5.e4
A) 5...Nxc3 is not very good. After the surprising 6.dxc3 Qxd1+ 7.Kxd1, White has a stable advantage
due to the advanced black c-pawn. The b5- and c4-squares will be perfect spots for the white pieces: the
knight and bishop, and even the king in the endgame.
B) 5...Nb4 6.Bc4 is another very interesting line, not once tested by Aron Nimzowitsch.
5...cxd4
5...Nxc3 6.bxc3 cxd4 7.cxd4 e6 8.e4 Bb4+ 9.Bd2 also gives a stable advantage to White.
6.Qxd4 e6
363
Position after: 6...e6
7.e3
7...Nc6 8.Bb5
After missing the principal continuation on the 7th move, White is forced to primitively finish
development without real chances to get an advantage.
8...Bd7 9.Bxc6 Bxc6 10.Ne5 Nxc3 11.Nxc6 Qxd4 12.Nxd4 Nd5 13.Bd2
364
Position after: 13.Bd2
In a symmetrical pawn structure like this, it is very important to support the pieces’ harmony and go for
active play. Black’s next move requires precise follow-up play.
13...Bc5?!
Another option was 13...Be7 14.e4 Nb6 15.Rc1 0-0 16.Ke2 Bf6 with solid play for Black.
14.Nb3 Bb4?!
This is imprecise and allows White to get a small initiative after his next move. 14...Bb6!, neutralising
the white knight, was better. 15.e4 Ne7 16.Bc3 Nc6 is equal. All minor pieces restrict each other – a
very interesting setup.
15.Rc1! Rd8
15...Bxd2+ 16.Kxd2 Rd8 17.Ke2 is slightly better for White because the c-file is slightly more
dangerous than the d-file.
365
Position after: 17.Ke2
Suddenly, Black is in an uncomfortable situation. White threatens to penetrate on the 7th rank.
Meanwhile, Black obtains nothing on the d-file. Black must play very precisely.
17...Ke7
17...Nxa2? is evidently a mistake. After 18.Rc7!, another rook intends to capture the a7-pawn. White is
clearly better.
18.Rc4!
From here, the reader can enjoy Nimzowitsch’s patient and brilliant realisation of a small advantage.
18...Na6?!
19.Rhc1
The c7-square is now covered, but the black knight will be out of play for a long time.
19...Rd7
366
Position after: 19...Rd7
Black is also ready to double. However, in this position, the c-file is much more promising than the d-
file. This is because the white king is controlling the infiltration squares and the white knight is more
stable, and can even close the d-file. The a6-knight is very passive and it is only a matter of time before
it is attacked by the b-pawn.
20.f4!
Impressive play by the great Aron. This move secures the knight’s future on d4. Also, the white king
gets a perfect safe and active position on f3. Another possible plan can be to expand on the kingside.
20...Rhd8 21.Nd4 f6
367
Position after: 21...f6
Black wants to attack the white knight and penetrate on the 2nd rank, if possible. Of course, White can
prevent it by moving the knight to f3 immediately, or after being attacked. Before any action in the
centre or kingside, White wants to lock out the black knight using his queenside pawns. The next move
patiently works to that effect.
22.a4!
It looks impossible for Black to stop the b4-b5 advance, having great impact.
Nimzowitsch avoided the move 22.b4, after which 22...b5!? may lead to some complications. Although
they must be in White’s favour, there is no reason to complicate matters. In positions where you
dominate and the opponent lacks any real counterplay, it is always good advice to play patiently and
only take action after eliminating possibilities of counterplay.
368
Position after: 24...Ke6
It looks like Black has consolidated. This is only an illusion. His rooks are toothless on the d-file. His
king may meet danger, even in the centre. The main problem is the knight, which has been misplaced
for a long time now.
Conversely, the white knight is perfect. It controls the d2-sqaure, attacks the isolated pawn on e5 and is
ready to jump to g5 at any moment.
25.b4 b6 26.R1c2!
26...h6
369
Position after: 26...h6
27.h4!
Before any direct action, White wants to collect as many advantages as possible. The last move fixes
Black’s pawn structure on the kingside. Thus, more pawns will be available to attack there. Also,
moving the pawns to h5 and g4, and maybe even use f5 for the knight, may be a useful plan.
370
Position after: 29.Rg4
There we are! White’s rook uses the g-file with great impact. It is formally “closed” but, placing the
rook in front of the g2-pawn, it is possible to benefit from the weak g6-square and exposed g7-pawn.
Strange but true, the closed g-file brings more to White than the open d-file (controlled by doubled
rooks!) does to Black. Black’s position suddenly collapses. White’s rooks will simultaneously disturb
the black king and pawns using both the c-file and g-file.
29...R5d7 30.Rc6+
30...Rd6
31.Rg6+
31...Ke7
371
Position after: 35.Nxe5+–
The situation has stabilised. White has a completely winning position. Not only because of the two
extra pawns, but the white pieces also still dominate. White’s realisation is impressive.
White has consolidated the kingside position with a wonderful knight manoeuvre. Now, it protects the
372
e3-pawn and attacks the weak pawn on h6. The game is over.
43...Kf8 44.Nxh6+–
White’s pawns are much faster. The rest of the game doesn’t require any commentary.
47.h6 Kg8 48.g5 Kh7 49.Kg4 Nc5 50.Kh5 Ne6 51.g6+ Kg8 52.h7+ Kh8 53.Kh6 1-0
Black resigned. The game was won in fine fashion and illustrates relativity in chess – not all open files
are equal! I can only presume that Aron Nimzowitsch must have enjoyed this game very much. He won
convincingly and in style against his eternal opponent, Dr. Siegbert Tarrasch.
Game 34
Petrosian – Unzicker
Hamburg 1960
1.d4 Nf6 2.Nf3 e6 3.Bg5 d5 4.c4 c6 5.Qc2 Be7 6.e3 0-0 7.Nc3 h6 8.Bf4 Nbd7
373
Position after: 8...Nbd7
9.cxd5
9...cxd5
9...Nxd5 is probably better. Black should try to exchange material due to White’s superior activity.
Also, in positions where knights protect each other, it is generally a good idea to exchange one of them.
After 10.Bg3 [10.Nxd5 exd5 is solid for Black.] 10...Qa5 Black is OK.
10.Bd3 a6 11.0-0 b5
374
Position after: 11...b5
12.a4!
An excellent decision. After Black’s next move, which is forced, some weak squares appear on the
queenside.
375
The point of the fine 12th move is evident. That move brought a lot to White: control over the c-file,
access to the b5- and c6-squares, permanent pressure on the exposed a5-pawn... It is no wonder such a
fine strategician as Petrosian had little trouble converting his long-lasting advantage.
15...Ba6
With the idea to exchange material and then control the c6-square.
18...Nd6
18...Bd6 19.Rc6!
19.Bxd6!
Very simple and very strong. Black’s bishop cannot attack anything. It is also useless against White’s
occupation on the light squares.
376
Position after: 21...Nd7
377
White’s advantage is tremendous. Domination on the c-file completely paralyses the black army. All of
the white pieces are amazingly placed and Black’s army is forced to wait for an execution. Still,
nothing direct is apparent. In positions where all pieces are on their best squares, pawn play should be
on the agenda! Petrosian was a real master of preparation, and perfectly understood the previous
statement. So, how to organise pawn play? It must take place on the kingside, of course. It is time for
one of Petrosian’s all-time favourite approaches – evacuating the king before launching a pawn attack!
29.Kf1!
The king voluntarily heads to a2 – safety! Note that Black is unable to do anything. This is the
consequence of White’s unchallenged reign on the c-file!
29...Kg8
30.h4 h5 31.R1c2
Don’t rush! The king goes to a2 via c1 without breaking the connection between the rooks.
31...Kh7 32.Ke1 Kg8 33.Kd1 Kh7 34.Kc1 Kg8 35.Kb1 Kh7 36.Qe2 Qb7 37.Rc1 Kg7 38.Qb5!
378
Position after: 38.Qb5!
38...Qa8
38...Qxb5 would be fatal after 39.axb5 a4 40.b6 Rad7 [40...Raa8 41.b7 Rab8 42.Na5+–] 41.Na5 Ra8
42.Rxd6! Rxd6 43.b7 Rf8 [43...Rb8 44.Rc8 Rd8 45.Rxd8 Rxd8 46.Nc6+–] 44.b3 a3 45.Nc6 Rxc6
379
46.Rxc6 Rb8 47.Rb6+–
39.f4 Kh7
40.Qe2 Qb7
41.g4!
44.Ka2
46...Rh8 47.Qf2 and the rook goes to g1, with fatal effect.
47.Qf2 Kf8
380
Position after: 47...Kf8
48.Nd2
48.Qh2! was stronger – but White just repeated the position once before playing it.
With the idea to penetrate via h8 or advance the f-pawn, with penetration along the diagonal.
50...Bf6
50...Bd6
381
Position after: 50...Bd6
51.Rc8!
51...Rad7
382
51...Rxc8 52.Rxc8+ Ke7 53.f5 Qxf5 54.Qb8 Rd7 55.Re8#
52.Nc5! b3+
53.Kxb3 Rd6
1-0
Black resigned. A terrific defeat. After losing control of the c-file, Black lost without being able to fire
a single bullet.
Game 35
Sveshnikov – Balashov
Moscow 1976
383
Position after: 4.e5
Now the game transposes to the advance variation of the French Defence. Grandmaster Sveshnikov was
recognised as an expert on this line in the ‘70s and ‘80s. Although, this game shows a dark side to his
contribution...
That is one possibility. Usually, on moves 4 and 5, Black chooses two out of the three following
moves: ...Qb6, ...Nc6 and ...Bd7. Of course, transpositions are possible but, generally, each setup has
various ideas... Black chose a flexible setup. He can go for ...Qb6, with the transfer of the kingside
knight to f5, or he can go for ...f6 at the right time (probably after the moves ...Ne7-g6, ...Be7 and ...0-
0).
384
Position after: 5...Bd7
6.dxc5?!
If the white pawn is already on c3, this move doesn’t make sense. The point is that c3 was played with
the idea of strengthening the centre. White voluntarily destroys his pawn chain by taking on c5, thus
making the move c3 a waste of time.
385
Position after: 7...Nge7
8.0-0?!
10.Bxg6?
A huge mistake. It is very strange that a great expert like Evgeny Sveshnikov would choose such a
move... Firstly, White voluntarily gives away his most valuable piece. Secondly, Black can now seize
the initiative on the kingside. Furthermore, White will soon face problems with regards to finding a
promising plan. Finally, Black’s pieces will become extraordinarily active on the kingside.
10...fxg6!!
386
Position after: 10...fxg6!!
A key move. After this, Black seizes the initiative and everything goes smoothly. Advanced players
would probably choose it, and real masters would certainly play it. However, beginners would probably
not even consider it, automatically taking with the h-pawn. Why? Let’s see... The decision should be
based on the resulting open files. Of course, the f-file gives Black more than the h-file. After taking
with the h-pawn, it would be very difficult to prove that the rook is useful on h8. White can keep the
strong e5-pawn, so Black is unable to build pressure on the h2-pawn. Furthermore, it would be risky for
Black to choose to castle kingside. White can potentially organise an attack with the knight on g5 and
the queen on h3 or h4. Most people would argue that “pawns should go towards the centre”. Yes, in the
early stages of the game... Actually, by taking with the f-pawn, Black takes care of the centre! The rook
on the f-file will attack the knight on f3, making some sacrifices possible. The knight on f3 is such an
important piece, controlling the d4-outpost and protecting the key pawn on e5. After the move ...fxg6,
Black can also go for a kingside attack, supported by his pawns: ...h6 and then ...g5! It is clear that the
f3-knight will soon face problems! Hence, White will have problems in the centre. Last but not least,
taking with the f-pawn gives opportunities to the light-squared bishop – it may be placed on g6 or h5.
387
Position after: 12...Ne7!
The knight goes to the nice f5-square. From there, it can both control the d5-outpost and attack the
bishop on g3.
13.Nbd2
If 13.Nd4 Nf5 14.Nxf5 Rxf5, Black will double on the f-file, with a clear advantage.
388
Position after: 14...Ba4!
15.Kh1?
Another mistake. Moving the queen was a must. 15.Qe2 Bxb3 Was a good option – the b3-knight is
ready to jump to d4. 16.axb3 g5!µ
15...Qb6!
New problems for White! Both the queen and b3-knight are now paralysed!
Look at the white pieces – only the rooks can make reasonable moves. White can only dream of putting
a reasonable plan together – his position is hopeless. Black has a pleasant choice. There are many
promising plans: playing on the kingside with ...h6 and ...g5, doubling on the f-file, doubling on the c-
file, opening the position with ...d4, and so on. First of all, Black chooses to improve his position on the
kingside.
17...h6 18.h3 g5
18...Nxg3+ doesn’t make sense – there is no reason to trade this beautiful knight for the bishop.
19.Bh2 Rc7
389
Position after: 19...Rc7
20.Ne1 Be7
20...d4! was also a good option – the knight is removed from f3!
21.Qd1 Rc4
Now, Black changes plan. Instead of doubling, he prefers to control the 4th rank.
22.Rd2
390
Position after: 22.Rd2
22...g4!
22...Ne3 looks nice. But, after 23.Qe2, the knight has to retreat [23.fxe3? Rf1+ 24.Bg1 Qxe3–+].
25.Bg1 Rf5!–+
25...Nxh2
391
Position after: 25...Nxh2
26.Nd4
An interesting solution, which only delays resignation. 26.Kxh2 Rh4+ 27.Kg3 Qg1–+
26...Bc5?!
26...Bb5 was better. Avoiding the fork on b3 and threatening to take the knight on d4 – Black is
392
winning. 27.Nd3 [27.Qf2 Ng4] 27...Rxd4 28.cxd4
28...Qxd4! 29.Kxh2 Qh4+ 30.Kg1 Bc5+ would have been a beautiful finale. It is quite apparent how
the black bishops have dominated over the white minor pieces throughout the entire game.
393
29.Rc1?
29.Qf2 is more resistant. Although, after 29...Rxd2 30.Qxd2 Rc8, Black should be winning – the knight
cannot reach the blockading d4-square. If 31.b3 Be8 32.Nc2 then 32...Qc7.
White resigned before getting mated on the next move with ...Qe3. An amazing game! It is hard to
believe that Sveshnikov played the opening in such a primitive manner. Balashov impeccably punished
White’s indolent play. I hope the reader will fully appreciate all the benefits of ...fxg6, a very
instructive move.
0-1
394
Chapter 5
Pawn Structures
In order to explore pawn structures, many games are definitely required. There are various types of
structures, each having their own properties. I will try to explain and present the essence of all of them.
This should allow the reader to understand the concepts surrounding pawn structures, and how to treat
them in practical games.
The focus will mostly be on various weaknesses – the reader will learn about creating and exploiting
them. This is a very sensible strategy and can be found in other aspects of chess too. The concept of
pawn structures is intrinsically connected to understanding the bishop vs. knight combat, for instance.
There are also links with the concepts of gaining space, king safety, initiative, transferring into an
endgame, etc.
Do not worry, important moments in this book are highlighted and explained in detail. I am sure your
understanding of the importance of weaknesses and defects of pawn structures will grow significantly.
Pawn Majorities
Game 36
Marshall – Capablanca
New York 1909
395
Marshall chooses the line later named after Rubinstein, now known as the best option for White against
the Tarrasch Defence.
9.dxc5 was another option: 9...Bxc5 10.Na4 [10.Ng5 is also possible.] 10...Be7 11.Be3 0-0 12.Nd4
White keeps a small edge, but Black can be satisfied with the opening.
9...Ne4
One of several typical approaches. Black wants to simplify the position by exchanging material.
10.Bxe7 Qxe7
11.Ne5?!
396
Position after: 13...0-0
11...Nxd4
14.Bxd5 Rad8 15.e4 Bxd5 [15...Bh3 16.Re1 Qxe5 17.Qb3 b6 18.f4 Qe7 19.a4 is slightly better for
397
White.] 16.exd5 Qxe5 17.c4 b5 18.Re1 is unclear.
12.Nxe4 dxe4
13.e3
13.Bxe4? Bh3–+
13...Nf3+
14.Nxf3
398
Position after: 15...0-0
This position is already slightly better for Black. Other things being equal, Black has a better pawn
majority, which can be more easily launched than the opponent’s. White’s majority would have to be
advanced at the price of weakening some squares. Hence, White must play accurately in order to avoid
serious problems.
16.Rfc1?
A passive move that cannot be recommended. It will soon become clear that White cannot stop Black’s
majority. It was better to try and launch the kingside majority instead.
A) 16.Qxb7? Qxb7 17.Bxb7 Rab8 with a much better position for Black.
B) 16.e4 is the most consistent continuation. The idea is to take risks by advancing the e- and f-pawns.
16...Rab8 17.Qe4
This move was played with the primitive idea of 18.Bh3. Never go for “one move threats” if they are
not part of a larger, good plan.
17.e4 was again a better option.
17...Qc7
399
Position after: 17...Qc7
18.Rc3?
This move does nothing to stop Black’s majority. 18.f4, seizing the last chance to launch the kingside
majority, was better.
18...b5! 19.a3 c4
20.Bf3
Without good moves available, you go for bad ones – an infamous truth.
20.Rd1 Trying to find some counterplay on the open file was logical.
400
Position after: 22...Rd8
Black is much better. His control over the open file is a new addition to the list of advantages.
Of course, Black centralises the queen, keeping the b5-pawn protected. Meanwhile, there are threats to
the c3-rook and b2-pawn.
25.Qe4 Qxe4
Now Black allows the exchange – the b5-pawn is not under attack.
26.Bxe4
401
Position after: 26.Bxe4
26...Rd1+?
Perhaps this move was made automatically in order to prevent Kf1, with centralisation.
26...Bh3 was a much better choice. 27.Rc1 [27.f4 Rd1+ 28.Kf2 Rd2+–+; 27.Bf3 Rd2–+] 27...Rd2
402
27.Kg2 a5 28.Rc2 b4 29.axb4 axb4
32.Rd2
32...Rc1 33.Bd1 c3
Creating a passed pawn. Game over. Only a few technical issues remain in order to convert the
endgame with an extra bishop.
403
Position after: 35...Rxd1–+
39.f3 Rc2+–+
39...Rc2 40.f4 h5
404
Position after: 43...f5+
44.Kg3
44...Re2 45.Rc4 Rxe3+ 46.Kh4 Kg7 47.Rc7+ Kf6 48.Rd7 Bg2 49.Rd6+ Kg7
White resigned without waiting to get mated. He lost the game without firing a single bullet. The
reason is evident – he neglected Black’s majority and did nothing to launch his own. From the early
middlegame right up to the end of the game, White played aimlessly, creating primitive threats and
simply responding to the opponent’s plans. The punishment was ruthless.
0-1
Game 37
Erenburg – Murariu
Las Palmas 2003
405
Position after: 6.Be3
6...Nbd7
Black protects the pawn, but finishes development in unnatural fashion – the knight belongs on c6.
6...cxd4 is more common. White can choose to play with an isolated pawn after 7.cxd4, which is the
best option. [Or to recapture with the queen and give some tempi to Black after 7.Qxd4 Nc6 8.Qxd5
Nxd5.]
7.c4
7...Qd6 8.Nc3
406
Position after: 8.Nc3
8...a6
9.dxc5!
This move gains some tempi and gives White good chances to fight for the initiative.
9...Qxd1+
9...Nxc5 10.Qxd6 Bxd6 11.0-0-0 must be better for White. [11.Rd1 is also promising.]
The first important moment in the game. White has many advantages: better development, more space,
and a better majority.
407
Position after: 11...Nxc5
Still, the advantage is not significant. Black hasn’t made a single bad move yet. He is ready to place his
king on e7 and finish development soon. In such situations, active play is extremely important.
12.b4!
White tries to prevent Black’s natural development and to cause disharmony in Black’s camp.
12...Nfe4 13.Nb1
Very interesting and actually a logical continuation. Black is lacking space and hence White should
avoid exchanges. Also, a tempo may soon be gained after attacking the e4-knight.
Far better than castling short. The king should be placed in the centre as the pawn majority may need
support. The kingside rook is headed to d1.
408
Position after: 16.Kd2
16...a5
17.a3 axb4 18.axb4 Rd8 19.Rxd8 Kxd8 20.Kc2 Nb6 21.Nc3 Ke7 22.Rd1
After a series of natural moves, it becomes clear that White is much better due to the presence of a
409
better majority and better development. Black loses his way with his very strange next move – the f2-
pawn is actually untouchable.
22...Ng4
23.h3! Nf6
23...Nxf2? 24.Rf1+–
24.Kb3
24...h6
It is obvious that Black feels that he lacks good moves. Still, some are available.
Why not 24...Bd7 ?
25.Ne5
White gradually improves all of his pieces: the rook, then king and now time for the knight.
Meanwhile, Black wastes time.
25...Nbd7
410
Following the good strategy of exchanging material in restricted positions.
26.Nxd7 Bxd7
27.b5
White’s advantage is now concrete: activity, space and, of course, the better majority. Also, the black
king is cut off from the queenside where a dangerous passed pawn will soon appear. White’s next move
goes against Capablanca’s famous postulate about advancing a majority. However, this move restricts
the black minor pieces (advancing the c-pawn would liberate the c6- and d5-squares). The point is that
Black cannot prevent the creation of a passed pawn.
27.Bf3 Bc6 28.Bxc6 bxc6 29.b5 also looks good, but the text move is definitely more dangerous.
27...b6?
28.Bf3 Rb8
28...Ra7 29.Na4+–
29.Ra1
411
Position after: 29.Ra1
Taking control of the a-file, White plans a complete invasion. This is the result of Black’s bad 27th
move – his rook was forced to leave the a-file.
Paralysing Black’s pieces, White goes for the b6-pawn. The rest is a matter of technique.
31...f5
31...Kd8 32.Ne4+–
32.Na4 Kd6
412
Position after: 32...Kd6
33.Bxd7
33...Bxd7 34.Kb4
34...Ke7
35.Ra6 e5 36.Rxb6
413
Position after: 36.Rxb6
White is a pawn up. He has two connected and advanced passed pawns, so the rest is easy.
Black resigned. A very instructive game on the topic of seizing the initiative and converting
accumulated advantages without allowing the opponent to solve his problems.
Game 38
Radulov – Pinter
Pernik 1978
414
Position after: 5...Bb4
The game has transposed into the Scottish Defence. Black’s last move is one of the tested and main
lines.
We have instantly landed in an endgame. It looks like Black has done a good job – he has improved his
415
pawn structure, placed the king in the centre... White’s position may look primitive, but he actually
stands slightly better. Black’s king can be harassed by the white pieces, and the pawn structure is in
White’s favour. White rapidly finishes development.
11.Bd2!
11.0-0 is too slow. Black is not obliged to capture on c3, which would be in White’s favour. The point
is that the white king is far from the centre and one extra move would be needed to place both rooks on
open files.
12...Re8 looks normal. After 13.Rhe1+ Kf8 14.Rxe8+ Kxe8 15.Na4 White looks good, but his
advantage is not significant.
13.Na4
White’s knight targets the c5-square. Also, if Black captures on d2, White improves the position of his
rook – doubling will be faster.
13...Bd6 14.Be3
416
14...Kf8 15.h3
15...h6 16.Rhe1
16...Nd7
White could not benefit form occupying the c5-square, but his position is still preferable. Black spent
time on prophylaxis and did not finish development. White, fully developed, goes for action.
17.c4!
A very good solution. White destroys Black’s central pawn structure. Black is stuck between a rock and
a hard place: play with an isolated c6-pawn or an isolated d5-pawn.
17...Bb4
417
Position after: 19.Bc5
is evidently better for White, but Black’s weaknesses are still inaccessible.
20.Bf5
418
A) 20.Rde2 allows 20...Ba6!.
B) 20.b3 dxc4 21.Bxc4 Nb6 22.Nc5 Nxc4 23.bxc4 Rxd2 24.Kxd2 Rd8+ 25.Kc3 Bc8 26.Rb1 is
another good option for White.
20...Nb6
Black has got rid of his bad bishop, but White still has a better structure.
23.cxd5 cxd5
Black goes for tactics, but there is nothing there. The d5-pawn is now more exposed. Also, it is very
important that White’s majority on the queenside will lead to the creation of an outside passed pawn.
Every simplification now would clearly be in White’s favour – his goal is a pawn endgame, which
would be easily winning.
23...Nxd5!? deserved attention. This is strategically a better option.
24.Rc2
419
Position after: 24.Rc2
24...Re8
24...Nc4 25.Nd3²
25.Rxe8+ Kxe8
25...Rxe8 26.b3! taking control of c4, making space for the king, and intending a4-a5.
420
Position after: 27.a4
White launches his majority. He allows Black to “gain” a tempo by attacking the knight.
The point. Now the white king is closer to the centre while the black knight is under attack.
The endgame is in White’s favour. The opportunity to create an outside passed pawn is the most
important positional factor.
421
Position after: 30...Nc8
31.Kd3 f5
Black goes for direct counterplay on the kingside, but this plan cannot be good. White is simply faster
on the queenside.
31...d4, with the idea to place the king on d5, was more logical. Perhaps Black was afraid of 32.Kc4.
This position must be analysed carefully, as both sides have many tempi to spare.
32.b4
422
Position after: 32.b4
Of course.
32...g5?
33.b5 h5
Black carelessly plays on the kingside. He thinks the white majority is stopped. However, White has an
interesting possibility that Black missed...
34.Nd8!
The knight creates threats in two directions: against the a7- and g5-pawns, both with checks.
34...g4
423
Position after: 34...g4
35.hxg4?
35.h4 was better 35...f4 36.a6 Kd6 [36...d4 37.Nc6+ Kd5 38.Nxa7 Nxa7 39.b6 wins.] 37.Kd4 and
White wins after activating the king.
35...hxg4?
Black returns the favour. He probably wanted to be able to protect both pawns with the king.
35...fxg4 was correct. After 36.g3 d4 37.Nc6+ Kd5 38.Nxd4 Kc5 the game would probably have been
drawn. White is unable to make progress.
36.g3
424
Position after: 36.g3
36...Kd6
36...d4 is useless now. 37.Nc6+ Kd5 38.Nxd4 Kc5 39.b6 axb6 40.axb6 Nxb6 41.Nxf5 wins easily.
The last precise manoeuvre. The knight is used to deflect the king!
38...Ke6
38...Kc7 39.Ke5+–
39.Kc5!
425
Position after: 39.Kc5!
39...d4
40.Ng5+!
The most precise. Before taking the d4-pawn, White deflects the black king further.
426
Position after: 41...Kg7
Game over.
Black resigned. A very important game to explore the benefits of a majority. Even without being that
distant, the majority was a decisive positional factor in the endgame.
Game 39
Ivkov – Taimanov
Belgrade 1956
1.e4 c5 2.Nf3 Nc6 3.d4 cxd4 4.Nxd4 Nf6 5.Nc3 d6 6.Bg5 e6 7.Qd2 Be7 8.0-0-0 0-0
427
Position after: 8...0-0
Rauzer’s Attack was one of the most popular openings in the middle of the 20th century.
Black has the idea to play 12...e5, this move will free his position.
White’s reaction is logical.
12.e5
428
Position after: 12.e5
A very popular move, which had already been well studied in those years.
12...dxe5 13.Qxe5
White transfers into an endgame, which must be more or less in his favour.
13.fxe5 is bad in view of 13...Rd8 14.Qe3 Rxd1+ 15.Nxd1 Ng4.
Some of the greatest players of that period had differing opinions about this position. Bronstein stated
that the last move is not precise because it allows 16...Bd7 – the pawn has already advanced to h6, so
17.Bh7 will not lead to the loss of a pawn.
16...Bd7?!
429
Position after: 18...Bb7
19.Rd7 Bxe4 20.Nxe4 [20.Rxe4 Nc6] 20...Nc6 with an OK position for Black.
17.Bh7+!
In this interesting theoretical clash, Ivkov will convincingly prove that Boleslavsky was right.
Nonetheless, very precise play was needed to prove it. White swaps his weak e5-pawn for the b7-pawn
in return for dominating on the 7th rank.
430
Position after: 19...Nxe5
20.Re1
This move was Ivkov’s improvement. The rook is transferred to the queenside with tempo.
20.Nb5 was played previously, but after 20...Rab8, Black usually proved that White has nothing.
20...f6
20...Ng4 21.Ne4!? underlines the problems with the g4-knight. There is the threat of the simple 22.h3.
After 21...Nxh2 22.Nf2 f5 [22...h5? 23.Rh1+–] 23.Rxe6 is bad for Black.
21.Re3
431
Position after: 22...Rc8
23.Nb5
23...Rab8?!
24.Ra3
24...a5 25.Rxc8
25.Rxa5? Rxb5–+
25...Rxc8
432
Position after: 25...Rxc8
26.Nd4
26.Rxa5 Nd3+ 27.Kb1 [27.Kd2 Nxb2] 27...Ne1 leads to unclear play. Three connected pawns are not
as dangerous as two – usually there is not enough time to advance all of them!
26...Nc4
Black saves one pawn with tempo. On his next move, he saves another one.
27.Rc3 e5
433
Position after: 27...e5
It looks like White has achieved nothing and that his initiative is gone. However, Ivkov spotted a very
fine tactic in this position...
28.b3!
An excellent and very practical decision. White offers Black three (!) different types of endgames to
choose from: rook, knight or pawn endgame. All of them are clearly in White’s favour. Black goes for
knights.
28.Nb3 a4 29.Nd2 Nb6 leads to a double-edged endgame.
28...Nd6
A) The pawn endgame after 28...exd4 29.Rxc4 Rxc4 30.bxc4 is lost for Black. The game could
continue: 30...Kg6 31.Kb2! Kf5 32.Ka3 Ke6 33.Ka4 Kd6 34.Kb5 with an obvious win.
B) The rook endgame after 28...exd4 29.Rxc4
434
Position after: 29.Rxc4
29...Rd8 [29...Re8 30.Rxd4 Re2 31.Rd2 is also winning for White.] 30.Rc5 is hopeless for Black.
White is almost winning due to the distance of his pawns and better majority. White’s king and knight
are also better placed.
435
30...a4
31.bxa4!
White is not afraid of disconnecting his pawns. Black has problems stopping this a-pawn.
38.Kd2
436
Position after: 38.Kd2
was perhaps more precise, but this move could easily be missed. Black is unable to play 38...Kb6.
38...Kxc4 39.Ne3+ Kc5 40.Nf5 Kb6 41.Nxg7 Kxa7 42.Nf5 h5 43.h4 would give White two outside
passed pawns on both flanks.
437
This move fixes a target on h6.
46...Kd5
46...Kd4 47.Nf5++–
47.Nf5! Nf3+
47...Nxg4 48.Ne3+!+–
Black resigned.
An interesting theoretical debate. Ivkov realised his advantage in a very interesting and educational
manner.
1-0
438
Isolated Pawns
Game 40
Botvinnik – Zagoriansky
Sverdlovsk 1943
1.Nf3 d5 2.c4 e6 3.b3 Nf6 4.Bb2 Be7 5.e3 0-0 6.Nc3 c5 7.cxd5 Nxd5 8.Nxd5 exd5 9.d4
9...cxd4
Black reached a crossroads – he had to decide whether to play with an isolated pawn, or a pair of
hanging pawns. Zagoriansky opted for the former. Another possibility is 9...b6!?.
10.Qxd4
Even if not forced to recapture with the queen, it’s a good decision. In a position with an isolated black
pawn on d5, his dark-squared bishop is usually his most valuable piece. The text move practically
forces its exchange.
A) 10.Nxd4? Bb4+µ
B) 10.Bxd4? Bb4+µ
10...Bf6 11.Qd2
439
Position after: 11.Qd2
11...Nc6
11...Be7 keeps the bishops on the board but loses time. Furthermore, the bishop on b2 would be a much
better piece than its counterpart.
A typical position where the side with the isolated pawn has no compensation for the defect in their
pawn structure. There is neither a knight installed on e4, nor an attack on the kingside.
440
Position after: 14...Qa5
Black can only watch White gradually improve his position. Black can do nothing against White’s
occupation of the d4-square and the permanent pressure on the weak d5-pawn.
Key to White’s strategy – eliminating the black pieces that control the important d4-square. After the
exchange, White will fully control d4.
Don’t rush. Black is lacking counterplay and White can attempt various plans in order to convert.
23...Rcd8 24.Rd4 a5
441
Position after: 24...a5
Everything is clear – White has a significant, long-lasting advantage. On the other hand, Black has only
one weakness – the d5-pawn. One typical plan in such positions is to exploit the pin. This is very
difficult to achieve, because the d7-rook is well protected. Even if achieved, after the moves e4 and
exd5, the pawn would be firmly blocked by a rook on d6 and the white pieces would be passive and
restricted because they protect the d5-pawn. Botvinnik goes for another approach. Instead of trying to
collect the weak d5-pawn, he decides to use the fact that the opponent’s pieces are so passive. Hence,
he decides to attack the opponent’s king.
There is a clear positional basis to this solution: he who dominates in the centre can organise an attack
on a flank.
Of course, White could bring another pawn to the attack (h-pawn) but he felt that the g-file should be
opened for his major pieces.
26...hxg5 27.Qxg5 f6
What else? Black opens the 7th rank for the rook to protect the endangered king.
442
Position after: 29.Qg3
29...f5?
Black even wants to use the 6th rank, bringing the queen to the defence. However, the e5- and g5-
squares will be desperately weak.
443
Position after: 33.Qh6
36...d4 would not give counterplay. After 37.Rg5 Rf7 38.Bh5 White wins.
37.Rg5 Rf7
444
38.Qh5
Black resigned. He lost the game without being able to fire a single bullet. This was a consequence of
not having counterplay in a position with an isolated pawn. White achieved a nice position against an
isolated pawn by exchanging some very important pieces – the f6-knight and the dark-squared bishop.
As a result of having a safe kingside, White patiently built pressure on the weak d5-pawn while firmly
controlling the most important square: d4. When the time was right, he launched a direct attack against
the black king.
Game 41
Karpov – Sokolov
Brussels 1988
1.c4 Nf6 2.Nc3 e6 3.Nf3 d5 4.d4 Be7 5.g3 0-0 6.Bg2 Nbd7 7.Qd3
The game started with a Catalan. With his next move, Black changes the situation in the centre in an
uncommon way.
445
Position after: 7.Qd3
8...exd5 9.0-0 c4 [9...h6 10.Bf4] 10.Qc2 and all lines give a small but stable advantage to White due to
the weakness of the d5-pawn.
Of course, the queen can retreat to d1. However, this spot is for the rook. The text move should be more
precise.
446
Position after: 11...Bxc5
White is obviously slightly better because of better piece coordination and his ultra-powerful “Catalan”
g2-bishop. Moreover, White will soon gain some tempi by attacking the opponent’s exposed pieces
(queen, knight, bishop...). With his next move, White goes for the initiative. The idea is to ruin Black’s
pawn structure.
12.Bg5 Nbd5
Black allows the ruining of his pawn structure. He is ready to play with an isolated pawn.
12...h6 13.Bxf6 Qxf6 14.Ne4 Qe7 15.Nxc5 Qxc5
447
Position after: 15...Qxc5
would have kept the pawn structure intact, but other problems would have formed. Black will be behind
in development and White can still gain some tempi. It will be very difficult for Black to activate his
queenside pieces in a promising way.
448
15.Rad1?!
A fine move. White is ready to establish a strong blockade on d4 with the bishop. Or, even better, to
exchange the powerful b6-bishop. 17.Nd4 is not good enough because after 17...Bg4 18.h3 Rc8 Black
gets active play.
19...Bxf3!?
This is a questionable decision, but other options are hardly better. Black leads the game into a knight
vs. bishop endgame where he is playing only for a draw – the bishop is a much better piece and
pressure on the weak d5-pawn will be constant. Otherwise, White can install a knight on d4 after
exchanging the dark-squared bishops, which would also be very unpleasant for Black.
449
Position after: 22...Rc2
Black has got some counterplay and has achieved a lot. His defensive plan is actually to transfer the
game into a rook endgame after losing the d5-pawn. He hopes that, even with a pawn down, he will be
able to hold due to an active rook on the 2nd rank. Karpov’s next plan looks natural and convincing –
he neutralises Black’s activity on the 2nd rank.
23.e3! a6
23...Rec8 was definitely better. The rook is doing nothing on the e-file, and there was probably no need
to advance the a-pawn at all.
450
Position after: 26...Rxc2
27.b4!
Advancing the b-pawn, White allows Black to capture the a-pawn. As a result of this operation, the b7-
pawn will be left unprotected. The alternative 27.e4 only leads to equality.
27...Ra2 28.Bxd5 Nxd5 29.Qxd5 Qxd5 30.Rxd5 Rxa3 31.Rd8+ Kh7 32.Rd7
451
Black loses a pawn. Of course, he protects the f-pawn – Black must not allow White to create two
connected passed pawns.
32...f5
32...Kg6 should be preferred, activating the king and not compromising the kingside pawn structure.
33.Rxb7 h5?!
It is understandable that Black wants to advance the pawns with the idea of exchanging as many of
them as possible. But still, this move creates holes.
34.Kg2
36.Rb6!
Preventing 36...a5!.
452
38...fxe4+ 39.Kxe4
39...a5?
39...Rxf2 was the best try. After 40.Rxa6 Rb2 41.Rb6 White still has some work to do.
40.b5 a4 41.Ra6
453
Position after: 41.Ra6
White’s king is close to the passed pawn. Black’s king is out of play. The game is decided.
41...Rxf2
42.b6 h4
454
Position after: 44.Kd5
44...Rf5+
44...Kh5 45.Rxa4+–
45.Kc6 Rf6+ 46.Kb5 Rf5+ 47.Kxa4 Rf4+ 48.Kb5 Rf5+ 49.Kc6 Rf6+ 50.Kc7 Rf7+ 51.Kb8 1-0
Game 42
Andersson – Tal
Malmo 1983
455
Position after: 5...h6
6.Bxf6
Ulf Andersson was a great expert in closed positions, so it is no wonder he chose this peaceful line,
bringing him a small but stable advantage.
It seems like a dynamic player such as Tal should opt for something more suited to his style. Andersson
must have been happy with the opening.
456
Position after: 10.0-0
10...dxc4
Black logically prepares the opening of the position for his bishop pair.
11.Bxc4 e5 12.Bb3
A) Exchanging with 12.dxe5 gives White nothing. After 12...Nxe5 13.Nxe5 Bxe5 Black is already
slightly better.
B) 12.d5 is also not good 12...Nb6 13.Bb3 e4! and Black achieves good play.
12...exd4
13.exd4
This is good. White cannot organise a kingside attack like in typical isolated pawn positions. Also,
White cannot organise a stable outpost for his pieces on c5 or e5. An important fact, however, is that
Black cannot create a firm blockade on the d5-square. The knight is forced to go to b6, which is
unnatural in this setup. Perhaps most importantly, the b3-bishop cannot be neutralised – the pressure it
puts on the f7-pawn is very dangerous and Black needs to tread carefully.
Avoiding the isolation of the d-pawn is not good. 13.Nxd4 Nc5 14.Bc2 Qb6 and Black has solid play
on the dark squares while White’s minor pieces are restricted.
13...Re8 14.Qd2!
457
Position after: 14.Qd2!
Andersson always had a great sense of harmony. He predicts that the ideal square for his queen will be
f4 – from there it will create threats on both flanks.
458
Position after: 18.Rxe5
After some exchanges, Black no longer has the bishop pair advantage and still the strength of the b3-
bishop is more important than the presence of an isolated pawn. White’s pieces are active and perfectly
centralised, while Black has not finished development. The d4-pawn, although isolated, is not weak – it
cannot be properly attacked. Furthermore, the white queen will go to f4 and the knight to e4 and later
c5 or d6, putting more pressure on Black’s position. Black decides to transfer the knight to f6, to
protect the f7-pawn – it is clear that Black lost time in the early middlegame.
After exchanging knights, White steers the game towards various types of endgames, with a dominating
bishop in all of them. He is not afraid of exchanging material. Black will have problems with the f7-
pawn and weak dark squares on the queenside.
459
Position after: 23...Re8
Black consistently continues to exchange passive pieces for active ones. Generally, that is a good
strategy. The resulting endgame should be theoretically holdable for Black. However, in practical
chess, it is very unpleasant indeed. The isolated pawn is not weak, while Black’s queenside pawns can
be targeted. White has the possibility to play without risk, patiently improving, while Black must play
accurately and keep an eye on White’s numerous threats.
460
Position after: 25.Kh2!
A very good move and a very useful approach. Moving the king “in advance”, White eliminates
counterplay related to a check on e1. White also gives more choice to Black, which is a kind of
psychological pressure.
25...a5?
26.Qc7!
26...Qe4!
26...Be6 is not helpful: 27.Qxb7 Bxb3 28.Qxb3 and Black’s position is bad. He must suffer for a long
time in the endgame, and that without any counterplay.
29.Kg3
461
Position after: 29.Kg3
Black’s queenside pawns are in danger, while White has secured his king’s position.
31...b5
462
White should try and collect Black’s pawns on the queenside or to create a passed pawn in some other
way. He must also constantly be wary of perpetuals. The first task is centralisation. White makes a few
checks to get closer to the time control on move 40.
32.Qe6+ Kh8 33.Qe8+ Kh7 34.Qe4+ Kh8 35.Qe8+ Kh7 36.Qe4+ Kh8
37.a4
A fine move.
37.Qxc6 Qg5+ [37...Qxa2 38.Qxb5; 37...Qxd4 38.Qxb5] 38.Kh2 Qf4+ 39.Kh1 Qxd4 40.Qa8+ Kh7
41.Qe4+ was another plan to win the game.
37...Qc3
37...Qg5+ was better, but the endgame is still winning for White: 38.Kh2 Qf6 39.h4 with patient
progress on the kingside looks very bad for Black.
38.Qe8+ Kh7 39.Qe4+ Kh8 40.axb5 cxb5 41.Qe8+ Kh7 42.Qxb5 Qxd4 43.Qxa5
463
Position after: 43.Qxa5
Black resigned. This game introduced some uncommon properties and demonstrated ways in which the
side having the isolated pawn can seize the initiative. Black lacked harmony and could not easily
neutralise White’s forces. Many pieces were exchanged, but the last remaining minor piece, the light-
squared bishop, was the most powerful piece of them all. Making only one visible mistake on move 25
(which was not even that big a mistake), Black was shown no mercy.
1-0
464
Backward Pawns
Game 43
Polgar – Anand
Wijk aan Zee 1998
1.e4 c5 2.Nf3 d6 3.d4 cxd4 4.Nxd4 Nf6 5.Nc3 a6 6.Be3 e5 7.Nf3 Be7
10.Qe2
This was later evaluated as a bad move, helping White occupy d5... However, it is not clear whether
Black has a better option.
A) 11...Nbd7? 12.Bxe6 fxe6 13.Ng5+–
B) 11...Nc6 12.Rfd1²
465
12.axb3
Doubling the pawns is not a bad thing for White at all. The opened a-file can be an important factor.
13...h6 would prevent White’s next move but 14.Nh4! would be very unpleasant for Black.
14.Bg5
White simply follows the same strategy: fight for the outpost on d5. White’s dream is to reach an
endgame with a knight against Black’s dark-squared bishop.
14...Rfc8
466
Position after: 14...Rfc8
15.Ne1!
Excellent move. This knight was without prospects on f3. After the retreat to e1, the knight protects the
c2-pawn, making ...b4 less dangerous.
White also has some strategically dangerous manoeuvres in mind, such as Ne1-d3-b4-d5 and Ne1-
c2(g2)-e3-d5!
Consistent, Polgar eliminates the black pieces that were controlling the d5-square.
467
Position after: 20.Rxd5
20...Rc8
Black could try 20...b4, although after 21.g3 with the idea of transferring the knight to c4, Black will be
in trouble.
21.c3
This move prepares the activation of the e1-knight. Also, White gets ready to block the position on the
queenside.
21...b4
Black hoped this blockade would be in his favour, but White actually has another resource.
468
Position after: 23...Rc5
24.Rd1
Of course, White doesn’t allow an exchange on d5. That square is for a piece, not a pawn!
24.Rxc5 was not as good, because White will lose the chance to make a breakthrough on the queenside.
24...a5 25.Nc2
The knight comes to d5 and Black cannot prevent it. Smooth sailing for White.
25...Kg7 26.Qd3 Rc6 27.Ne3 Qc8 28.Kg2 Qe6 29.Qe2 Bd8 30.Nd5
469
Position after: 30.Nd5
The first phase of Polgar’s plan is over – her knight has reached d5. Black’s a5- and d6-pawns are well
protected. Hence, White must play on the kingside. Meanwhile, Black must keep an eye on c4-c5.
30...Rc5 31.Qe3 Be7 32.Rd3 Bd8 33.Qd2 Rc6 34.Qd1 Kg8 35.h4
Finally, after some preparation, Judit goes for active kingside play.
470
35...Kg7
Black should have stopped the advance of White’s h-pawn by playing 35...h5 himself. Serious efforts
would be required in order to make progress on the kingside – opening the position could lead to
problems to do with the white king’s safety.
36.h5 Bg5 37.Qf3 Rc8 38.Rd1 Rc6 39.Qe2 Rc8 40.Rh1 Kg8
41.f3!
White vacates the second rank for the queen. It can be placed either on h2 with mating ideas, or on f2
from where it would prepare the advances c5 and f4.
43...fxg6
A) 43...hxg6 is bad. After 44.Qg1 f5 [If 44...Bf6 45.Qh2 Bg7 46.Qh4 with a win.] 45.Qh2 Bf6 46.Qh6
Bg7 47.Qg5 Black’s position must be lost.
B) 43...Qxg6 even makes the f5-square weak. 44.Ra1! Bd8 45.Ne3 Bb6 46.Qe1 and Black’s position is
in ruins.
471
Position after: 46.Qe1
44.c5!
The black king’s shelter is damaged after the disappearance of the f-pawn. Hence, White wants to
attack it from the centre.
472
Strategically, White has convincingly outplayed Black.
46...Kf7 47.Qe3!
Very nice. White doubles on the c-file with the rook in front of the queen.
52...Kh6 53.Rb8
53...Bf6
53...g5 aiming for some play on the kingside was more resistant. Still, 54.Rb7 is very unpleasant.
473
Position after: 55.f4!
55...exf4 56.Rh8+
Black resigned.
The variation is beautiful: 56.Rh8+ Kg7 57.Qd4+ Bf6 58.Qxf6+ Rxf6 59.Rh7+ Kxh7 60.Nxf6+ Kg7
61.Nxd7+–
1-0
Game 44
Geller – Bolbochan
Stockholm 1962
474
Position after: 6...e5
Boleslavsky’s line. With this move, Black eliminates the threat of White’s kingside attack – he is ready
to capture on f4 if necessary. The game will continue in a rather positional manner – Black has
weakened the d5-square but wants to use the c-file for active play.
475
10...b6
This line was very popular in the early ‘60s. Thanks to Geller’s efforts, White’s next move became the
most dangerous reply during those years.
10...b5 was also possible.
A good move, preventing ...b5. White’s knight on b3 is not needed. Hence, Black does not capture the
knight as the e6-bishop is an important piece.
14.Nc1!
15...a5 16.Nd5!
476
Position after: 16.Nd5!
16...Nxd5 [16...Bxd5 is worse as 17.exd5 e4 18.f4 gives a clear edge to White due to the weaknesses
on b5 and c6.] 17.exd5 Bf5 18.Bb5 leads to trouble for Black.
16.Nb4
16...a5?
477
That was unnecessary. The knight will jump to d5, even without being attacked. Black probably wanted
to secure his own knight on c5. However, that is only an illusion – White will eventually be able to
advance c3 and b4.
The situation has stabilised. Black has dimmed White’s initiative in the centre by exchanging material.
He hopes that his knight can compensate for the positional defects. White has established firm control
over d5 and has the bishop pair advantage. The light-squared bishop is the most powerful. So, White
wants to advance some pawns onto dark squares in order to support it. Placing pawns on c3 and g3,
White patiently prepares the opening of the position with the moves b4 and f4.
White has fully activated his pieces. It is now time for the king.
478
Position after: 26...Nc5
27.Ra1
27...Bf8 28.Bd3
479
Position after: 30...Ra7
The point is that White can patiently play on both flanks. He first attempted to make a breakthrough on
the queenside. Black defended well, and so White switches to the kingside.
The f4-advance is on the agenda. In positions where the opponent has no active play, always try and
breakthrough with piece play first, and then switch to pawn play if needed. In essence, you have two
bullets. If you start with pawn play, it is impossible to switch back to option one.
480
Position after: 34...Be7
Comparing this position to the previous diagram, it looks like White has achieved nothing. Formally
speaking, this is correct. However, White tried piece play on the queenside and now he knows what to
do: progress must be made on the kingside. Searching for the correct plan when your opponent has no
counterplay is not a waste of time. White predicts that Black will take on f4 so White retreats the king
to the g-file – after the exchanges on f4, he wants to be ready to play e5.
Patient play will lead to success. Black has had enough of waiting for White to act and tries active play
for himself...
39...f5?
...which is suicide. There was no reason to help White open the position.
481
Position after: 41.f4!
That is the point. White fixes the f5-pawn. Black’s next move is forced as the e-file must stay closed.
However, the e4-pawn will be in danger because White will prepare the g4-advance.
41...e4 42.h3
Straightforward attacking...
482
Position after: 44.g4
44...Rf8
44...hxg4 45.hxg4 Rf8 46.Rh1 is even worse. Now 46...fxg4? 47.f5+ Rxf5 48.Be8+ Kf6 49.Rh6+ would
be a disaster.
45.gxh5+?
White returns the favour, missing a much better option. The surprising 45.Be8+!
45...Rxe8 46.gxf5+ Kf6 47.fxe6 Kxe6 48.Rxh5 is winning. Black’s mini f5-e4 pawn chain is destroyed
and all of his pawns are now weak. With an extra pawn and more active pieces, White has a winning
position.
45...Kxh5
White obviously lost a significant part of his advantage. More efforts are required.
483
Position after: 49.Bc4!
There will be threats on the g-file and the positional threat of infiltrating the light-squared bishop.
Being almost paralysed, Black goes for active play by sacrificing a pawn and transferring into a clear
rook endgame.
484
Position after: 55.Rg3
White’s rooks are very active and prevent the activation of the opponent’s rooks. The king goes to
block the e-pawn.
57...Re4 58.Rdxf5!
485
58...Rfe6 [58...Rxf5 59.Kxe4 e2 60.Rg1; 58...e2 59.Rxf6+ Kh7 60.Rf7+ Kh8 61.Kxe4 e1=Q+
62.Kf5+–] 59.Ke2 Rxa4 [59...Rxf4 60.Rxf4 Kxg5 61.Rf3+–] 60.Rh5+ Kg7 61.Rfg5+ Kf7 62.Rh7+
should lead to a win.
59...Rc4?
486
Position after: 61.Rg4
60.Re5!
White eliminates Black’s last hope. After losing the e3-pawn, Black will be without counterplay.
60...Rf6
487
Position after: 64...a4
65.Reg2
65...a3!
Good try. Exchanging pawns is a good idea. Black targets an endgame with R+f+h against R, which is
known to be drawish with precise play.
488
Position after: 67.Ke4!
68...b5 69.Rg8+–
489
Now it is definitely winning for White.
70...Ra4+ 71.Ke5 Rh4 72.f6 Rxh3 73.Rg7+ Rxg7 74.Rxg7+ Kh6 75.Rg8 Rf3 76.c4 Kh7 77.Rg7+ Kh6
78.Rg4 b5
79.c5!
79...Re3+ 80.Kf5
Black resigned. A very tense game. White’s patient realisation should be carefully studied, despite the
few mistakes he made due to miscalculation.
1-0
490
Pawn Weaknesses
Game 45
Marshall – Capablanca
New York 1927
Marshall was recognised as one of the most dangerous attackers of the first quarter of the 20th century,
while Capablanca was recognised as the greatest expert of the Caro-Kann. So, their clash was predicted
to be a very interesting and tense game. Marshall’s next move was a first step in that direction...
6.f4?!
The idea is to establish a so-called “Morphy’s knight” (a knight on e5 supported by pawns on d4 and
f4) and to trap the g6-bishop.
491
Position after: 8.Bd3
Imprecise. Advancing the f-pawn should be connected with chasing the g6-bishop. Instead, White
exchanges it. Without the light-squared bishop, Black may exploit the light-squared weaknesses.
8...Ne7
This move may look strange to a beginner, but the f5-square is very important and Capablanca is
fighting for it. In fact, the other knight can come to f6, if needed.
492
Position after: 11...Rd8
White has definitely done a bad job. He spent so much time to install a knight on e5. He was forced to
advance the f-pawn to manage this too, weakening some squares and forcing the king to move to the
corner. Meanwhile, Black harmoniously finished his development and is ready to castle. The king will
be safe on the kingside. Black is ready to undermine White’s centre with the move ...c5, along with the
e5-knight.
12.Qe2 Bxd3!
After the queen moves, it is logical to take the d3-bishop as recapturing with the queen would be a
waste of time.
493
Position after: 14.Bd2
Black is already better. He has finished development, and it is now time to open the position. The
opening of the position will highlight the weaknesses caused by White’s advanced f-pawn.
Black doesn’t actually need the bishop. The knight is a more valuable piece – it may use the e4-square,
for instance.
494
Position after: 18.Bc3
Black is clearly better. He has achieved a lot: he has more active pieces and control over the open file.
By advancing his f-pawn without attacking afterwards, White only created weaknesses. The squares e3,
e4 and g4 can be occupied by black pieces. But how to proceed? Black rightly felt that he should
exchange bishops. With his next move, he eliminates the protector of the d2-square and puts pressure
on the c-file. He also takes control of the d4-square.
18...Bd4! 19.Rad1
19.Bb4 Rfe8 would not be better. Pressure on b2 will cause new weaknesses after 20.c3 Bb6. Black is
ready to double on the d-file or use the e3-square.
19...Bxc3 20.Nxc3
495
Position after: 20.Nxc3
20...Rxd1! 21.Nxd1
A) 21.Qxd1? Ne3–+
B) 21.Rxd1? Qxf4µ
Excellent move! Black targets the b2-pawn and e3-square at the same time.
24...Qb4
25.Qf2
496
Position after: 25.Qf2
Black is much better, but it is not easy to make progress. White will probably try to make space for his
king to free the queen from protecting the 1st rank. So, Black’s next move is very logical. Black
secures the f5-knight and is ready to create new weaknesses, depending on whether White advances his
g- or h-pawn. Black also makes space for his king and creates the possibility of activating it via the h7-
and g6-squares.
497
Position after: 27...Qd4!
This move leads to either material gain or infiltration. White prefers to lose a pawn and activate his
pieces.
At this moment, accuracy is required. Capablanca was, in my opinion, the player with the best
realisation skills ever – and this game supports that statement. His next move is the only move to keep
an edge.
30...Ne3! 31.a4
31.Nxb7 Nc4µ
498
Position after: 31...Nc4µ
31...Nd5 32.Nxb7
White hopes that his outside passed pawn can compensate for material loss, but that is just wishful
thinking.
499
35.Na5
35.Nc5 does nothing. Black just activates his king and wins easily after 35...Kf8.
500
Position after: 43...Nc3
After some precise moves, White’s last hope is gone. The rest does not require comments.
44.Kf3 Nxb5 45.Ke4 Nd6+ 46.Kd5 Kd7 47.Nc6 Nc8 48.Nb8+ Ke7 49.Nc6+ Kf7 50.Nd8+ Ke8
White resigned. A very instructive game. Once you decide to advance your pawns in order to attack, try
to actually attack. Otherwise, as demonstrated in this game, advancing your pawns will just produce
weaknesses for your opponent to exploit. Marshall was an attacking player and his defensive skills
were simply not as good. Hence, Capablanca’s strong play led to a logical result.
0-1
Game 46
Lasker – Capablanca
Belgrade 1921
1.d4 d5 2.c4 e6 3.Nc3 Nf6 4.Bg5 Be7 5.e3 0-0 6.Nf3 Nbd7 7.Qc2 c5 8.Rd1 Qa5 9.Bd3 h6 10.Bh4
cxd4 11.exd4 dxc4 12.Bxc4 Nb6
501
Position after: 12...Nb6
This line was not very fashionable and, as a result, the position is very comfortable for Black. White no
longer has the chance to secure a serious advantage in the middlegame. Black will harmoniously finish
his development and soon build pressure against the isolated d4-pawn.
It is natural to use the perfect e5-outpost for the knight in such positions. Here, however, it doesn’t
bring much to White.
15...Bb5 16.Rfe1
502
Position after: 16.Rfe1
16...Nfd5?
This move allows a nice tactical shot, which Lasker missed... 16...Nbd5 was natural, putting pressure
on the c3-knight.
17.Bxd5?
17.Bxe7! Nxe7 18.Nxf7! Rxf7 19.Bxe6 was clearly better for White. Missing this chance, Lasker
gradually starts getting an uncomfortable position...
503
Position after: 20...bxc6
The situation has stabilised. After his mistake on move 17, White has a slightly worse position. Why?
Black has an isolated pawn, doesn’t he? Indeed, but the point is that the d4-pawn is more exposed than
the c6-pawn, and especially the a7-pawn. The rest of the game will confirm this.
21.Re5
White intends to play actively, although it was already time to find a good setup to protect the
weakness on d4.
21.Qc4 looks natural.
21...Qb6 22.Qc2
22.Qxb6 axb6 is bad for White – it will help Black eliminate his pawn islands.
504
Position after: 23...Rd5!
Very nice play by the Cuban genius. Capablanca was always, and in 1921 especially, recognised as the
greatest master in finding the most harmonious setups. Black simply intends to double the rooks on the
d-file, giving White a chance to exchange a pair of rooks. Lasker goes for it, but this just improves
Black’s pawn structure.
24.Rxd5?!
A) 24.Re3? c5µ
B) ¹ 24.b3
24...cxd5
It is true that the d4-pawn is safer now; there is no more frontal attack on the d-file. However, more
important is the fact that Black controls the only open file and has got rid of his weak c6-pawn. Black’s
active pieces start to prevail in the next stage of the game.
25.Qd2 Nf5
505
Position after: 25...Nf5
The knight is on its ultimate square. It is safe, protected and attacks the d4-pawn. If needed, it can
easily be transferred to c4 or e4 via d6. In fact, it will perform a magical dance later on!
26.b3 h5!
Before going for any direct action on the queenside, Capablanca secures the excellent f5-square for his
knight.
27.h3 h4!
28.Qd3 Rc6
506
Position after: 28...Rc6
Capablanca doesn’t hurry. The rook can be used to attack the a2-pawn and Black is ready to double on
the c-file with the queen behind the rook.
29.Kf1 g6
Once again, played without haste! Capablanca doesn’t forget about his king. The point is that White is
lacking any useful moves, and Black has a lot of them! So, why not play them? Black goes for patient
play, putting more psychological pressure on White.
507
Position after: 31.Kg1
31...a5!
Black uses a powerful and typical weapon in such positions – a minority attack! He also plans to get rid
of his isolated a-pawn while creating an isolated pawn for White! This will lead to another weakness in
White’s camp. Two weaknesses on b3 and d4 would be very close, so Black would still have some
work to do to convert his advantage. It is certainly a step in the right direction though.
32.Qb2 a4 33.Qd2
508
Position after: 33.Qd2
White hopes that exchanging material will help him survive. Black accepts the queen trade – without
queens on the board, his rook will more easily dominate over White’s.
The rook is ready to attack the weak pawns from behind. It will be ideally placed on the 2nd or 1st
rank.
37.g4?!
It is understandable that the ultra-powerful position of the f5-knight was unnerving White, but the text
move leads to new weaknesses in his camp.
The white pieces are desperately passive. Black is winning, though accuracy is still required.
The knight is now on an even better square – it attacks both the d4-pawn and controls the important b4-
509
square.
43.Nd1 Rb1
44.Ke2?
In a hopeless position, tired of a long and patient resistance, White allows a primitive tactical shot.
There is no need to exchange rooks. Actually, Black can enforce it at any time – his rook is more
active.
46.Nc3 Ne7
The knight has done a lot. The b4-square is no longer important, so it goes back to its beloved position
on f5.
510
Position after: 48...g5
Black fixes the white kingside pawns and makes space for the king.
49.g4 Nd6 50.Ng1 Ne4+ 51.Kf1 Rb1+ 52.Kg2 Rb2+ 53.Kf1 Rf2+ 54.Ke1 Ra2 55.Kf1 Kg7
511
Black keeps both options open (advancing the e- or f-pawn). He will decide after improving his king’s
position.
Don’t rush!
65.Rd3
65.dxe5+ fxe5 wins even more easily – Black practically has two extra pawns.
White resigned. I hope that all the problems that can arise with an isolated d4-pawn in the endgame
were made clear. Of course, this pawn was more exposed than the a7- or c6-pawns. Capablanca
demonstrated why Black is clearly better after his 24th move. The d4-pawn remained weak, despite the
d-file being closed. Domination on the c-file and the possibility of a minority attack ensured Black’s
success in the endgame.
0-1
Game 47
Flohr – Vidmar
Nottingham 1936
512
1.c4 e6 2.Nc3 d5 3.d4 Nf6 4.Bg5 Be7 5.e3 0-0 6.Nf3 Nbd7 7.Qc2 c5 8.cxd5 Nxd5 9.Bxe7 Qxe7
10.Nxd5 exd5
In this position, White has a small but lasting advantage due to the weak pawn on d5, especially when it
becomes isolated. On the other hand, Black has free play and will comfortably finish development.
11.Bd3 g6
14...Rac8 15.Qd2 a6
513
Position after: 15...a6
16.Bc2?!
I would not have recommended this move. Black should not exchange the knight for the bishop, so this
is a waste of time. The bishop heads to b3 in order to put pressure on d5. However, a better choice was
to double on the c-file, as the pressure on d5 is not that significant. This would also lead to
simplifications, which are in favour of the side playing against an isolated pawn.
16...Qg5
514
Position after: 16...Qg5
Black wants to organise something on the kingside (of course, he can’t do much...). White’s next move
is evident, eliminating all threats on the kingside and taking away the e4-square from the black knight.
The e3-pawn will need some protecting afterwards, which shouldn’t be much of an issue.
It looks like White has placed his rooks on the wrong files and Black is out of trouble.
19...Qf6 20.Bb3
20...Ba4
A good move. Black exchanges his traditionally bad bishop for a good one. On the other hand, this
simplifies the position, which generally should be in White’s favour. Still, in this case, it’s a good trade.
515
Position after: 24.Ne2!
A very fine move. The d4-square is vacated for the white queen or rook. White’s knight goes to c3 or f4
to attack the d5-pawn. Let’s remind ourselves of Nimzowitsch’ advice: an isolated pawn should first be
blocked to limit the opponent’s active play, and then the blockade should be transformed into an attack.
24...Nd7?!
Black intends to transfer the knight to c4, but the knight should actually control the blockading d4-
square.
Perhaps 24...Rc6 was simpler, and better. Black would prepare to double on any file. 25.Nc3 would
give nothing due to 25...d4! 26.exd4 Ne6=.
25.Qd4
Simple and strong. Without the queens on the board, the d5-pawn becomes weaker. Also, the queen
paralyses the d7-knight.
516
Position after: 27.b3
The endgame is clearly in White’s favour because of the weak d5-pawn and strong outpost on d4.
Having said that, Black can still be satisfied – it will be extremely difficult for White to realise his
advantage by creating another weakness in Black’s camp. The next stage for both sides should be the
centralisation of their kings.
27...Kf8 28.Kf1
517
28...Rxc1?
Black was simply not forced to go for any tactics, taking concrete measures. I suggest readers play the
position for both sides, without going for Black’s last move – this would be good practice. The rest of
the game is a convincing realisation, worth analysing carefully. 28...Ke7 was a normal move which
should have been made automatically.
29.Rxc1 Nc6 30.Nxc6 Rc8 31.Rc5! bxc6 32.Ke2 Ke7 33.Kd3 Kd6 34.Ra5 Ra8 35.Kd4
The position has radically changed. The isolated d5-pawn now has support, but the a6-pawn is isolated.
Also, the c6- pawn can become a target. The c5- and d4-squares, under White’s control, are very
important positional factors. In the next stage, White must create another weakness on the kingside.
The aforementioned weaknesses on the queenside should be counted as one weakness – they are very
close to each other. A pawn attack on the queenside does not look promising, by the way.
35...f5?!
This helps White open the position and create some routes for the king. However, it is reasonable for
Black to wish to exchange material – the e4-advance will be on White’s agenda sooner or later.
518
Position after: 38.e4
With his previous moves, White fixed the black queenside weaknesses and is now opening the 5th rank
for rook manoeuvres.
41.Kf4 h6
Preventing the infiltration of White’s king. Nonetheless, White intends to create another route with his
next move.
519
Position after: 41...h6
45.g3!
520
Position after: 49...Ke6
50.Re5+
50...Kd6 51.Re8 c5
521
Position after: 54...Rh7
The black rook cannot activate – after capturing the h6-pawn, the h5-pawn will be too fast.
Black resigned. It is really difficult to find Black’s “fatal” mistake. In fact, a few imprecise moves were
enough for the fine strategician to win the game convincingly. Black fell victim to an illusion on his
28th move. Making his rook passive, he was not able to prevent the creation of new kingside
weaknesses. A very instructive endgame, which is a perfect example to understand this common pawn
structure.
Game 48
Botvinnik – Szilagyi
Amsterdam 1966
Botvinnik chooses the reversed King’s Indian. He wants to bring his weaker opponent out of theory...
522
Position after: 6...e5
White has the bishop pair, but Black has the centre and easy play in return.
Blocking the position with 8...d4 is not recommended. A natural expansion on the queenside would
create new light-squared weaknesses. In the future, White’s light-squared bishop could perhaps use the
a2-g8 and c8-h3 diagonals. The text move fixes the centre and is a good option.
9.dxe4
9.Nxe4 would be worse. There is no reason to exchange knights – Black’s knights are hindering each
other.
523
Position after: 10...Qe7
White has a small and long-lasting advantage. Not only has he got the bishop pair, but he also has
better prospects for pawn play. White’s queenside expansion is to be expected. Meanwhile, nothing is
obvious for Black. Hence, Black will wait and have to respond to White’s plans, which is very
unpleasant.
11.c3
Preparing to expand. White logically places his pawns on dark squares beforehand.
Premature.
524
Position after: 13.a4?!
13...Rfd8?
13...a5 was a must. After 14.Ba3 axb4 15.Bxb4 [15.cxb4? Bd4µ] 15...Bc5 16.Qb3 Rfd8 Black’s
position is very good.
14.Qc2?!
14.a5!
14...Rac8
14...a5!
15.Be2
525
Position after: 15.Be2
Black missed so many chances to undermine White’s pawn structure on the queenside. And now, dear
readers, I ask for your undivided attention – Black’s next move is probably the worst positional move
you will ever see!
15...c5??
A terrible positional blunder. There was absolutely no reason for Black to weaken the light squares and
block his entire army. Look at the pawn on c5 – it restricts four black pieces! Be careful in your games,
avoid blocking your pieces like this with your own pawns.
16.b5!
16...Ne8?
Black missed the unique chance to remove his pawn from c5 and he will now suffer until the end of the
game.
16...c4™ sacrificing the pawn straight away would reactivate Black’s pieces. That was the last chance
to resist.
17.Nc4!
Simply keeping a piece on c4, White paralyses the entire black army. Now, Black’s position is lost.
526
Position after: 17.Nc4!
He cannot do anything against White’s occupation of light squares and combined play on both flanks.
From a strategical point of view, the game is over. Botvinnik’s realisation is instructive as always.
17...Nd6 18.Bg5!
One of Botvinnik’s trademarks: attacking, provoking, weakening and retreating. Tactics come in handy
when you outplay your opponent strategically. White doesn’t need this bishop – it attacks well
protected pawns. The light-squared bishop is the star of the show. Black must not accept the exchange
as he will be unable to prevent White’s occupation of light squares. His next move creates further
weaknesses.
18...f6
527
Position after: 20...Kh8
21.a5!
21...Bc7 22.Rfd1 Nf8 23.Qa2 Rxd1+ 24.Rxd1 Rd8 25.Rxd8 Bxd8 26.a6!
Excellent.
528
Black must close the position, making his own bishop more passive. Sacrificing motifs arise on the
queenside, with the idea of promoting the a-pawn. White’s queen is free to manoeuvre and setup a
battery on the a2-g8 diagonal.
26...b6 27.Kg2
Don’t rush!
Infiltration is inevitable.
Once again, Botvinnik demonstrates his class. The b5-pawn should be protected. Black cannot do
anything, so why be impatient?
32...Qd6 33.h4
529
Position after: 33.h4
With the idea to gain control over g6 or to destroy the black king’s shield after g4-g5.
33...Qd1
34.Qe8
34...f5
And Black resigned. You can see that one mistake was enough to be strategically lost. Be very careful
when advancing pawns – they cannot be moved back again! Always think twice, every advance
potentially weakens surrounding squares!
1-0
Game 49
Petrosian – Bannik
Riga 1958
530
Position after: 5.d4
5...g6?
Black intends to switch to some kind of Indian Defence, but the move is evidently a mistake. With
knights on f6, and especially c6, it is bad to allow the exchange of queens.
A) ¹ 5...exd4
B) ¹ 5...Be7
6.dxe5!
531
Position after: 6.dxe5!
6...Nxe5
6...dxe5?! 7.Qxd8+ Kxd8 8.Bg5 Be7 9.0-0-0+ Nd7 [9...Bd7 10.Bh3+–; 9...Ke8 10.Nb5+–] 10.Nd5!+–
9...Be7 10.0-0-0+
532
Position after: 10.0-0-0+
10...Nd7
A) 10...Bd7? 11.Bh3+–
B) 10...Ke8? 11.Nb5!+–
11.h4!
An amazing move. White uses the fact that the black pawn is already on g6. This will fuel White’s
attack down the h-file. Black must not capture on g5 because White will also dominate on the h-file and
gain control of the solid outposts on e4, f6 and h6.
11.Bxe7+ gives nothing. Black must play very precisely, but after 11...Kxe7 12.Nd5+ Kd8 13.Bh3 f5
14.e4 c6 15.Ne3 f4 16.Bxd7 Bxd7 17.Ng4 Re8 18.Nf6 Re7 it looks like he is out of trouble.
533
Position after: 11.h4!
11...f6
11...c6 12.Ne4 h6 13.Nd6 Rh7 14.Bxe7+ Kxe7 15.Bh3 f5 16.e4 is winning for White.
12.Be3
The perfect place for this bishop. Also, White doesn’t plan to advance the e-pawn – the f1-bishop will
be activated on g2 or h3.
12...c6 13.h5
534
Position after: 13.h5
White’s pieces are perfectly placed. After the exchange of light-squared bishops, the e4- and f5-squares
will be fully under White’s control, giving him excellent winning chances.
535
Position after: 17.b3
17...Rcd8?!
A) 17...g4 was suggested as better, although after Petrosian’s planned 18.h6 with the idea of 19.Rh5,
White maintains an edge.
B) 17...Nd7 was perhaps the best alternative, although after 18.g4 White’s advantage is undisputed.
Black’s last move is natural – by exchanging material he wants to reduce White’s pressure. Indeed, it
was very difficult to predict White’s next brilliant move.
18.Bc5!
What a surprise! Why exchange a good bishop for a bad one? The point is that the black bishop
protects the f6-pawn and controls the weak d6-square. The rest of the game will confirm that Iron
Tigran’s idea was just brilliant.
18.Bxb6+ axb6 19.g4
This really looks good for White. Actually, it is. However, in his long analyses Petrosian showed that
the domination on the e4- and f5-squares and pressure on the weak f6-pawn in the ensuing minor pieces
endgame would not be a guaranteed win. In fact, all three points should be counted as only one
weakness due to their proximity. Petrosian explained that he would not be able to create another
weakness in the black camp on the queenside – and we should believe him! By choosing the
paradoxical text move, he convincingly proved to be right.
536
Position after: 18.Bc5!
18...Rxd1+
18...Bxc5 loses a pawn after 19.Nxc5 Rhe8 20.Rxd8 Kxd8 [20...Rxd8? 21.Ne6++–] 21.Nxb7+±.
Things have become clear: White uses the weak squares on c5, d6, e4 and f5 to create various threats.
537
Black must play very carefully to avoid immediate collapse.
21...Re6
21...Rf8 22.g4 Rf7 [22...Nc8 23.Nc5 Rf7 24.Ne6++–] 23.Rd6 Nd7 24.Re6 and Black is paralysed.
22.g4 a5
Played with the idea to exchange some pawns in case White wants to launch a queenside expansion.
23.Rd3!
It is time to remember the words of the great genius Jose Raul Capablanca: the third rank should be
open to allow for rook manoeuvres.
26...c5
538
Position after: 26...c5
Black is forced to advance the c-pawn first. If he allowed White to advance his pawns to b4 and c5, all
the black pieces would be fully paralysed. Black also cannot play this move after White plays b3-b4
because White would then advance his b-pawn to b5 and the result is the same – Black would be
paralysed.
Not a very dangerous move. It is more of a demonstration of power, following the important principle
“Don’t rush!”.
539
Position after: 32.e3
A sad destiny for the black knight – as soon as it tries to activate, it is restricted again.
32...Nc7
32...Nd8 with the idea to place the knight on f7 in order to control White’s occupation, and perhaps
even to exchange it, was correctly suggested as a better option. Even then, it is not obvious how Black
can solve all his problems.
540
Position after: 35...Rc6
36.Nd6+?!
541
Position after: 39...Ke8
40.a4?
The question mark is for a pedagogical reason. Such a move, definitively blocking one side of the
board, is not a good waiting move. Who knows, perhaps White will need to open the queenside in order
to win the game?
40.Rd2 was a good, neutral waiting move.
40...Nd8 41.Nh6
542
Position after: 41.Nh6
41...Ne6™
42.Ng8!
Having missed the win several times, White must find unique moves to bring down Black’s defences...
or to get the same chance he had on move 36.
42...Nf8
43.Rd2!
43...Kf7™
543
Position after: 46...Kd8
A nice picture! White has trapped his own king on f5! But now 47.Rxd7+! Kxd7 48.Nxf6++– is
another interesting way to win the game.
45...Ne6
544
45...Nd7 46.Kd5 Nb8 [46...Rc7 47.Ke6] 47.Rd1 Kd7 48.Ke4+ Ke8 49.Rd6 also leads to an easy win.
46.Rd6!
48...Ng7
545
Position after: 53.f3!
Zugzwang, and a very beautiful win. Now it is clear why it can be very important to have some spare
tempi in blocked positions. We have a mutual zugzwang!
Once again: zugzwang! White did not win this game accidentally. No, the many zugzwang positions in
546
this endgame occur as a result of White’s complete domination over the many weak squares in the
black camp (b5, d5, d6, e4, f5...).
50...f5
A desperate bluff. White easily combines realisation and beauty during the rest of the game.
51.Kxe5 fxg4 52.Nc3 Ke7 53.Ne4 Kf7 54.Kf5 g3 55.fxg3 g4 56.Ng5+ Kg8 57.Ke6 Nc7+ 58.Kd7
Na6
A very typical game for Petrosian. In this remarkable game, he convincingly exploited Black’s many
weaknesses. Thanks to the mistake on the 36th move, we were able to see this beautiful endgame. As if
in a study, we were faced with marvellous zugzwangs.
1-0
547
Game 50
Geller – Bertok
Belgrade 1961
1.e4 c5 2.Nf3 d6 3.d4 cxd4 4.Nxd4 Nf6 5.Nc3 a6 6.Be2 e5 7.Nb3 Be7
This variation, named after Boleslavsky, was very popular in those days. Thanks to Geller’s efforts,
many resources were found for White.
9...b5 is premature. White answers with 10.a4 and after 10...b4 11.Nd5 White’s position looks better
due to the control of the weak d5-square and possession of the c4-square.
10.Qd2
10...Nbd7
11.a4 b6 12.Rfd1
548
Position after: 12.Rfd1
A year later, the great Bobby Fischer played 13...Bc6. But, after 14.Qe1 h6 15.Qf1 Qb7 16.Bc4 Rfc8
17.Rd2 Nf8
549
he faced Geller’s great invention: 18.Nc1!. The idea is to transfer the knight to d5 via a2 and b4. Even a
genius like Fischer was unable to react to it and reached a bad position, and somehow survived after a
sharp struggle in time trouble. Indeed, it was a very complicated task to play the Sicilian as Black
against Efim Geller.
14.Bf1
14...Nc5?
A typical “active queenside move” in the Sicilian... and also a big mistake. Why? After White’s next
simple move, the c-file will be closed. Though the backwards d6-pawn will disappear, the d5-square
remains weak. In fact, White will combine play on the two light-squared a2-g8 and a6-f1 diagonals.
Both the white bishops will be better than their counterparts. Black’s main problem will be the lack of
queenside play, while White can play against the a6-pawn and occupy the d5-square. White will even
have some chances on the kingside because he is dominating the centre...
14...Bc6 was better, with the idea to prepare the move ...b5.
15.Nxc5! dxc5
16.Qf2!
550
Position after: 16.Qf2!
That is the point. This move secures the c4-square for the bishop... Black cannot advance his pawn
there – the b6-pawn is hanging.
Everything is clear. White has a stable and considerable advantage. It might not be obvious, but the
551
domination on the light squares is the most important positional factor. A deep understanding of chess
is required to convert this advantage here. In fact, the engine evaluates this as only “slightly better” for
White, but in practice Black’s task is very difficult. Please, let this position be your exercise. Try to
play it, with both the white and black pieces, and you will have no doubt that Black is in big trouble.
Also, there is a very important psychological point – it is extremely uncomfortable to watch your
opponent improve his position move by move while you have nothing to do but wait.
20...a5 is bad. Now even the b5-square is added to the list of weaknesses.
21.Qd3 h6 22.Kf1
In case of exchanging queens, the king will be closer to the centre. Also, from e1 (or e2), the king will
control some infiltration squares on the d-file, giving freedom to the white queen. This point will be
verified later.
The idea is to target the e5-pawn. It may also be good to exchange that bishop for the f6-knight at some
point.
24...Kf8
552
Black must wait. There is simply no counterplay.
25.Bg3 Nd7
26.Bd5 is also natural, but the text move is better. White’s light-squared bishop is better than the black
one and, if needed, it can be exchanged at any moment.
Targeting the b6- and c5-pawns and preparing some potential tactical shots.
27.Nxb6 Nxb6 28.Qd6+ Kg8 29.Qxb6 Qd7 30.Bd3 c4 31.Bxc4 Qd2+ 32.Kf1 is actually winning for
White, but why complicate your task if the opponent is lacking any form of active play?
27...Bd8 28.Ne3
553
Position after: 28.Ne3
28...Bc7 29.Nf5
Take a look at the sad black pieces. They are all significantly restricted, mostly by black pawns.
554
32.Bxf7!
A perfectly led game, White deserves to finish it in style. Tactics inevitably take over at some point...
32...g5
33.Qc4 Nf6
Finally, Black’s position collapses after White exploited all of his weaknesses.
1.e4 e6 2.d3 c5 3.Nf3 Nc6 4.g3 g6 5.Bg2 Bg7 6.0-0 Nge7 7.c3
555
Fischer starts the game in a peaceful manner...
7...0-0
8.d4
There is a very logical reason behind this move. Fischer decided to advance this pawn, even though he
loses a tempo. The point is that the d6-square is potentially weak and White’s last move opens a path
directly to it.
8...d6?
This is a very important moment – this move is a serious positional mistake. With a pawn already
advanced to c5, it is usually bad to allow the opening of the d-file. The simple reason is that the d6-
square becomes weak, and can be accessed by the white pieces. The c4-square will now also play an
important role. 8...cxd4! 9.cxd4 d5 10.e5 b6
556
Position after: 10...b6
The potentially weak d3-square is covered. The queen also takes control of the very important a6-f1
diagonal.
557
10...b6 11.e5!?
It is clear that Fischer wants to immediately control d6, but he neglects his development. 11.a4
followed by Na3 was a good option.
11...a5!
That is the point! Black achieves counterplay by taking back control of the a6-f1 diagonal, while
creating many threats.
12.Re1
Black doubles on the d-file, with the rook leading the way.
14.Nbd2
14.a4, with the idea to activate the knight via a3, was also interesting.
14...Bd3 15.Qh4
558
Position after: 15.Qh4
By far the best square for the queen. It controls the important f6- and h6-squares.
15...Nd5
15...a4?! would be a solid move with the idea to prevent the fixing of the pawn structure, but White has
the strong reply 16.Ne4!.
559
Position after: 17.a4!
Fixing the black queenside pawns, White gets ready to fight for control over the very important squares
that are b5 and especially c4 – after exchanging the light-squared bishops. Black’s initiative has
evaporated. From now on, White will dictate the play.
The king gets closer to the centre. Despite the fact that Black’s position looks very solid, it is actually
hanging by a thread. The rooks cannot infiltrate and White can easily retake control of the d-file if
needed. White’s minor pieces will soon dominate the entire board.
19...Nde7
19...h6 was much better in order to prevent the white bishop from reaching g5.
560
Position after: 21.Bg5
21...N6e7?
This move is positional capitulation. With precise play by White, we could even say that it is winning.
Black’s bishop is useless and White will easily exploit the many weak squares on the queenside.
21...Re8! was a must. The g5-bishop would be attacked, so Black could then move the rook back to d8.
561
Position after: 23...Rxe7
24.Ra3!
Fischer, once again, demonstrates his class. This move would be chosen by top players and endgame
masters. Many players, including masters, would automatically retake the d-file. Even though the minor
piece endgame looks dreamy for White, it would remain difficult to convert – Black would put his king
on c6 and White would have a lot of work to do. Black’s rooks cannot use the d-file; the knight is
eternal on c4. Thus, White’s rooks have the freedom to occupy themselves in a different way...
Bit by bit, White increases the pressure. Black can only sit and wait.
28.f4!
White has better placed pieces and more space. Hence, he may even play on the kingside. This is a
result of having better communication lines.
28...Kf8
28...h5 was perhaps a better reaction, with the idea to exchange some pawns on the kingside after
White’s expansion.
562
29.g4! Ke8 30.Rf1
The last two moves were made with the idea to attack the h6-pawn!
30...Rd5
An incomprehensible move. With no good moves available, naturally, bad moves are played.
563
Position after: 33.Nxa5!
33...Rc7
is a very pretty mate. Enjoy this beautiful picture. The pieces are symmetrically placed in a rectangle –
564
c6-c8-f8-f6.
34.Nc4
34...Ra7 35.Nxb6 Nxb6 36.Rxb6 Rda8 37.Nf6+ Kd8 38.Rc6! Rc7 39.Rd3+ Kc8 40.Rxc7+ Kxc7
41.Rd7+ Kc6 42.Rxf7 c4 43.Nd7 Bc5 44.Nxc5 Kxc5 45.Rc7+ Kd5
565
Position after: 45...Kd5
46.b4!
Once again, setting the scene for a mate. 46.b4! cxb3 47.Kd3 followed by 48.c4+ wins, so Black
resigned. It looks like Black’s initiative was only temporary. Long-term positional factors (weak
squares on c4, b5 and d6, the weak b6-pawn, the bad g7-bishop, the lack of space and coordination in
Black’s camp...) simply took their toll. These were consequences of Black’s bad 8th move. Advancing
the pawn to c5 in positions with an open d-file can lead to many problems for Black. Black even had
centralised pieces, the initiative and much better development at some point. However, the pawn
structure was a more important factor. Another proof that chess is a very interesting game, where
dogmatism has no place. No principle is 100% valid.
1-0
Game 52
Larsen – Nielsen
Esbjerg 1953
1.Nf3 Nf6 2.c4 c5 3.d4 cxd4 4.Nxd4 Nc6 5.Nc3 d6 6.g3 g6 7.Bg2 Bd7 8.Nc2
Having a space advantage, White avoids exchanges. Also, this move prevents the well-known
manoeuvre ...Nxd4 followed by ...Bc6.
566
Played with the idea to advance 12...b5 and to remove the rook from the dangerous diagonal.
12.Rc1
12.Nd5 was possible, of course, but White wanted to provoke the advance of the b-pawn; this will
create a weakness on c6.
12...b5 13.Nd5
Following the famous principle: attacks on the flank should be countered with an attack in the centre.
However, there is no pawn action available and both kings are safe. The text move is very logical. In
order to avoid doubling his f-pawns, Black allows the opening of the c-file for White’s rook, and access
to the weak c6-square.
13...Nxd5
A) 13...bxc4 14.Nxf6+ Bxf6 15.Bxf6 exf6 16.Qxd6 cxb3 17.axb3 is in White’s favour.
B) 13...Ne8 14.Bxg7 Nxg7 15.cxb5 axb5 16.Nd4 is also better for White. His pieces are dominating in
the centre and a potential passed pawn on the a-file will be a dangerous asset.
567
Position after: 16.h3
16...Qb6
17.Qd4!
Excellent. This forces the exchange of queens because the e5-knight is pinned. The c2-knight goes to
d4 and the c-file is open. Black is forced to spend one more move in order to secure the knight and
White infiltrates. White is much better and, with precise play, should win the game.
17...f6
Black decided not to invite the white knight to d4, but the rook on b6 is now badly placed.
568
Position after: 19.Nd4
19...g5?
21...h6 22.Be4
569
Position after: 23...Nf7
24.Bf3
A) 24.Ne6+? would be premature as Larsen showed afterwards. Black gets counterplay after 24...Bxe6
25.dxe6 d5!. In positions where the opponent doesn’t have a promising plan, the primary task is to
prevent his potential counterplay.
B) 24.Bf5 with the idea of eliminating Black’s main defender, the d7-bishop, was also a natural way to
proceed.
570
Position after: 27.f5
Locking out the knight, White easily wins the game on the opposite flank.
It is difficult to pinpoint Black’s mistakes. He probably went for queenside activities a little too early,
allowing the opponent to open the c-file. He wasn’t ready to oppose this and was forced to spend too
much time in order to secure his knight. Beware when exposing your pieces: it may take a very long
time to regroup them.
1-0
Game 53
Steinitz – Sellman
Baltimore 1885
571
Position after: 4...Nfd7
5.f4
5.Nce2 c5 6.c3 Nc6 7.f4 was the “only” continuation before Steinitz. He was the first master to give a
detailed explanation as to why the centre should not always be protected. He listed the pros of
surrendering the centre (and the exchange of central pawns), especially if the vacated squares can be
occupied by pieces. The d4-square is exactly what Steinitz had in mind.
5...c5
572
Position after: 5...c5
6.dxc5
6...Bxc5 7.Nf3 a6
Better was 7...Nc6 8.Bd3 and now 8...f6 is an aggressive and very promising solution.
9...Nb4?
A move which is part of a bad plan. The only idea is to capture the white bishop, but this is a bad idea.
Black should focus on development.
A) ¹ 9...Qc7
B) ¹ 9...b5
10.Bd2 b5 11.Nd1
573
Position after: 11.Nd1
Naturally, Black captured the bishop. However, that knight should have retreated to c6. After all, the
white knight will need time to reactivate from d1.
11...Nxd3+? 12.cxd3!
As Kasparov commented for ChessBase: “any professional player today would make this move
automatically”. Of course, this is the best move. White gets the c-file for his rooks and can support the
occupation of the weak c5-square.
12...Qb6?
574
Position after: 12...b4!
Black’s main problem is his light-squared bishop, and now it can be placed on the beautiful a6-f1
diagonal.
With the text move, Black lost that possibility and his position becomes very bad instantly. He will not
be able to activate his c8-bishop and oppose White’s occupation of the weak squares on the queenside,
especially c5.
575
Position after: 14.a3
14...f5?
Already a decisive mistake. Black was probably afraid of White’s expansion on the kingside, but
White’s focus was elsewhere! After the text move, Black has no more chances to open the position.
Therefore his pieces, especially his bishops, become cramped and without coordination.
14...d4! was the last chance. Even if this pawn were to be lost, the active light-squared b7-bishop and
outpost on d5 would compensate for it.
Th ultra-powerful knight targets c6 and e6, and is ready to head to a5 or c5 via b3. However, by far its
most important role is blocking the d5-pawn, which paralyses the entire black army: the queen, bishop,
and even the knight.
A new dose of prophylaxis... just makes things worse. Either way, Black’s position is probably already
hopeless. The g5-square is now added to the long list of weaknesses in the black camp.
19.Nc3!
Black’s position is tragicomic. White has enough time to transfer the knight to a5 or c5.
576
Position after: 23.Na5
23...Ba8 24.Rxc8
Simple and strong. A piece of advice from basic chess lessons: exchange with a gain of tempo.
Unfortunately, this knight will be exchanged for one of the black bishops, but this will lead to the final
invasion.
577
Position after: 29...Qb8
30.Bf2!
Finally, the bishop joins the fun. It was supposed to be exchanged against Black’s good dark-squared
bishop. Instead, it will deliver the final blow to Black’s crumbling position.
578
One of the best illustrations in the topic of “domination in positions with opposite coloured bishops”. A
reminder of a basic principle... The attacking side (with the good bishop) practically has an extra piece
– the opponent’s bishop cannot oppose it!
35.Bd6
Black resigned. Everything started with a blockade on d4. Let’s remind ourselves of the famous
statement by the great Aron Nimzowitsch: “The blockade of a central pawn never only has local
character”. May this game serve as a typical example. By missing the opportunity to advance his pawn
to d4, Black’s entire army became paralysed.
1-0
Game 54
Ubilava – Timoscenko
Soviet Union 1974
4.0-0
4.Bxc6 is perhaps more logical. White wants to capture only after the bishop is attacked.
579
Position after: 7.d4
White’s idea is to occupy the dark squares by installing a bishop on d6, or to put pressure on the black
pawn were it to move there. His light-squared bishop is not a part of the plan.
7...cxd4 8.Nxd4 d6
580
Position after: 10.Qh5
Placing the queen on this very active square, White has a kingside attack on his mind. The queen can
only be attacked at the price of creating weaknesses.
10...g6?!
10...Be7 refraining from attacking the queen, was better. Black can castle calmly – White’s pieces
aren’t ready to attack.
11.Qh3 Rb8
This move looks logical, but the rook should not be placed on the dark diagonal. The point will soon
become clear.
12.Rd1 Bg7
12...Be7 was another option, but the h6-square would be uncontrolled. Generally speaking, Black
should advance either the e- or the g-pawn in the opening – not both. Doing so would create
weaknesses that cannot all be covered by the bishop.
13.Qg3!
581
Position after: 13.Qg3!
A very fine move, underlining Black’s problems on the dark squares. Black cannot advance his d-
pawn!
13...Be5?
This looks natural, but it is actually a big strategical mistake. To be fair, it was easy to overlook
White’s next shocking move.
13...e5 was the only move, but Black did not want to make the d6-pawn backward. White could
continue with 14.b3 with the dangerous positional idea of Ba3.
14.Qxe5!!
What a move. Usually, chess fans enjoy queen sacrifices as part of a mate. However, this sacrifice is
even more beautiful in my opinion. The move was played with the idea to exploit the weak dark
squares and paralyse the entire black army. The light-squared bishop will be particularly bad. The great
Aron Nimzowitsch would be very satisfied.
582
Position after: 14.Qxe5!!
The first phase of White’s plan is over. However, in order to convert, White needs more backup. The
583
next task is to activate the knight. Black wants to cover the d-file by transferring his rook to d4. White
found a beautiful plan.
22.h4?
A strange mistake which could be explained by White’s focus on maintaining the paralysis.
22.Nxa6! would win faster. Black’s king cannot escape because it is blocked in by the bishop. After
22...Bc8 23.Nc5 the a-pawn will never look back.
22...e5
584
Position after: 22...e5
Black desperately wants to reactivate his pieces. Alas, White is not interested in capturing the e5-pawn.
23.f3
23.Nxa6 was still possible. However, White was consistent. He blocks the kingside and plans to win
the game by transferring his king to the queenside without ever removing the knight from c5 – not even
for a moment.
585
Position after: 25.g4
Black is desperately lost. He cannot do anything to prevent the upcoming disaster on the queenside.
586
Position after: 33.Kc4
1.c4 e5 2.Nc3 Nf6 3.g3 d5 4.cxd5 Nxd5 5.Bg2 Nb6 6.Nf3 Nc6 7.0-0 Be7
587
Position after: 7...Be7
8.a3
True to his style, Karpov chooses the English opening. White is planning to play on the queenside
using his powerful g2-bishop and the c-file.
8.d3 with the idea of playing Be3 and Ne4 and occupying the c5-square is another option.
The game has transposed to some reversed side line of the Dragon. White has some extra tempi, but
Black’s position is central and solid.
11...Qd7
12.Ne4!
A good spot for the knight, especially after Black’s last move – White threatens 13.Nc5.
12...Nd5
13.Qc2 b6?!
Taking control of the c5-square but significantly weakening the long diagonal, especially the c6-square.
588
14.Bb2 Rac8
14...a5 is risky. After 15.b5 Na7 16.d4! the resulting complications should be in White’s favour.
15.Rbc1!
Underlining the fact that Black has weakened the c6-square. Suddenly, Black is in trouble. With his
next move, he tries to calm things down by exchanging material.
15...Nd4 16.Bxd4!
A very good decision. White’s knight on f3 is a more valuable piece – it can be transferred to c6! Here,
Karpov had already planned his magnificent 19th move.
16...exd4
589
Position after: 16...exd4
17.Qc6!
17...Qxc6 18.Rxc6
There is a lot of traffic on the long light-squared diagonal. All the white pieces occupy active positions.
With his next move, Black tries to consolidate.
18...Bd7
590
Position after: 18...Bd7
19.Nxd4!
Excellent! Karpov sacrifices the exchange in order to maintain a blockade on c6. The knight will also
capture some black pawns on its way.
19.Rc2 c5 is very good for Black.
591
Position after: 21.Rc1!
With the deadly threat of Nd2!. Black’s only centralised piece is in trouble.
Black desperately wants to get rid of his weaknesses and to open the position for his rooks. Karpov
superbly counters this, not giving chances to his opponent.
592
Position after: 29.d4!
White’s pieces are harmoniously placed and prevent the activation of the black pieces. White also has
excellent prospects in the centre – there is the potential to create two connected passed pawns there.
Black should now be lost.
29...g5
Trying to fire some bullets. With some precision, the counterplay is not effective.
30.Nxb8
Perhaps this is the most direct way to win, or perhaps it is a bad move due to exchanging a good piece
for a bad one. In fact, the truth is somewhere in between – it depends on the playing style. If Karpov
chose this move, we would probably be wise to believe him...
30...Rxb8
593
Position after: 30...Rxb8
31.Rc7
31.Bd5+ Kh8 32.Be6 Nb6 33.Nc6 was another good continuation – the d-pawn looks unstoppable.
The rest should be a matter of technique. Black’s rooks do become active, but Karpov proves that this
is only temporary.
34...Ra6
594
Position after: 34...Ra6
Don’t rush!
36...Rb2 37.e4
37...Rxb4 38.g4
In many other situations, this move would be considered as bad: it creates holes and a backward pawn.
However, here it is a good move. The f5-knight gets support, so the e4-pawn can be launched.
595
Position after: 39...hxg4
40.exf6 gxh3 41.Bxh3 Rxf6 42.Rc8+ Kh7 43.Rc7+ Kg6 44.Rg7+ Kh5 45.f3
1-0
Black resigned due to the threat of Bg4#. A very fine positional exchange sacrifice practically decided
the game – White got the initiative and Black lost all harmony. A well-deserved win.
596
Key Squares
Game 56
Van der Sterren – Ljubojevic
Amsterdam 1999
1.d4 Nf6 2.c4 e6 3.Nc3 d5 4.Bg5 Be7 5.e3 h6 6.Bh4 0-0 7.Rc1 b6
8.cxd5 exd5
8...Nxd5 9.Bxe7 Qxe7 10.Nxd5 exd5 looks more logical for Black.
597
Position after: 11...Ne4
This manoeuvre frees Black’s position and became one of the most important resources in the Queen’s
Gambit Declined.
598
Position after: 15...c5
Sooner or later, Black will face problems with his hanging pawns. At first, the c5-pawn will be White’s
main target. White must decide between either isolating Black’s pawn by eliminating the other or
provoking one of them to advance, which would create a strong outpost. Black, on the other hand,
should somehow play dynamically around the hanging pawns and try to seize the initiative by
advancing one of the pawns at the right time.
16.Qa3
A very fine move, pinning the pawn and avoiding attacks with tempi.
16.dxc5 bxc5 17.Qa3 Rfd8 18.Rfc1 was another option for White.
16...Rfe8
19.Bd3 Qe6
599
Position after: 19...Qe6
20.b4!
This simple and excellent move eliminates the dynamic energy of the hanging pawns and makes them
static and weak. Furthermore, a perfect outpost on d4 is secured for white pieces.
20...c4
21.Nd4
21...Qg6 22.Bxe4
22...Qxe4
600
Position after: 22...Qxe4
23.b5!
A very important move! White opens the diagonal for the queen, restricts the bishop and launches his
majority. It is also important that Black is unable to open files on the queenside.
25...a6? 26.a5+–
601
Position after: 27...Rad8
White is obviously better (better pawns and minor piece). It is time to remember Nimzowitsch’s
statement about blockading a weak pawn – the first task is to establish a stable blockade and the next
stage is to transform the blockade into an attack. The next simple move is a prelude to a natural
regrouping. The rooks will be doubled on the d-file and the knight will head to the c3-square. If
necessary, the e4-strike may come in very handy.
602
Position after: 31.Rd4
Once the knight is removed from d4, the rook must become the blockading piece.
32...Rg6 33.Nf4 [33.Nc3 Qf6 34.Nxd5? Qf3 35.g3 Rd6–+] 33...Rd6 34.Rxc4 dxc4 35.Qxd6 Qxd6
36.Rxd6±
34...Qc5
34...Rd6 35.e4+–
603
Position after: 38.Rc1
38...Qxa4
38...c3 39.Qd3 Qxa4 40.Rxc3 must also be winning for White – his passed pawn has better support.
White is winning. His passed pawn is stronger because the white pieces are more active.
604
40...Qb1
41.Rc8+ Kh7 42.Qxf7 Rf6 43.Qg8+ Kg6 44.Qc4 Qf5 45.f4 a4 46.e4 Qg4 47.e5
605
47...Re6
48.h3
Black resigned. An important game that demonstrates the problems that come with having a hanging
pair of pawns.
1-0
Game 57
Alatortsev – Levenfish
Tbilisi 1937
1.d4 Nf6 2.c4 e6 3.g3 Bb4+ 4.Bd2 Bxd2+ 5.Nxd2 Nc6 6.Ngf3 d6 7.Bg2
After exchanging the dark-squared bishop and developing the knight on c6, Black opens the c8-h3
diagonal for his bishop.
7...e5 8.d5
White decides to block the position, but this can lead to problems with the g2-bishop. Having said that,
other solutions such as 8.0-0 or 8.e3 would also give Black very comfortable play.
606
There was no necessity to also put that pawn on a light square, but White is consistent.
10...Nd7
Simple and good. Black prevents the move c5 and prepares an attack with ...f5. Both sides plan to
attack the base of their opponent’s pawn chain. Black is faster and has definitely won the opening
battle. The game is dynamically balanced but Black certainly has easier play.
11.Ne1 f5
607
Position after: 11...f5
When a bishop is fianchettoed on g2, White must generally prevent Black’s next move. The point will
soon be apparent.
12.Nd3?
Although this looks logical, this move must be bad. White must not allow 12...f4.
12.exf5 was a better option. White gets an outpost on e4 for the knight and the f4-advance will soon be
on the agenda.
12...f4!
608
Position after: 12...f4!
Excellent, this move is a very typical weapon for Black. White has to choose the lesser of three evils:
capturing on f4 will give Black a perfect outpost on e5 and make the g2-bishop very bad (after the
almost forced f2-f3 advance), closing the position with g4 will also make the g2-bishop bad and
weaken the dark-squared complex (note: Black can advance ...f4-f3. A positional sacrifice that creates
pressure on the f-file and an amazing outpost on f4 for his pieces), or White can wait and allow Black
to orchestrate a very dangerous and direct kingside attack by launching the g- and h-pawns. White goes
for option one.
609
Position after: 14...Ng6
Both sides try to control the e5-square. Black intends to block the e-pawn with a piece and to avoid
recapturing with the d-pawn after exchanges.
15.Rc1 Qe7
It has become clear that White cannot advance his e-pawn. So, after establishing a firm blockade on e5,
Black will be able to carry out a kingside attack. White will be almost hopeless. Exchanging material
will not help him as almost any endgame would be hopeless for him – Black has a much better bishop.
Meanwhile, White has a useless majority and a weak dark-squared complex.
610
Position after: 18.f3
Advancing the pawn to f3, White has stopped Black’s attack for a while. However, Black will
inevitably strike again. First, Black must secure his queenside. The next move prevents White’s
counterplay related to the opening of the c-file after c5.
18...b6! 19.Nxe5
19.b4 a5! and Black’s potential play on the a-file is even more dangerous.
611
Position after: 24.b3
The game has turned into an endgame. White managed to lessen Black’s initiative by exchanging
queens. However, this is not that helpful – Black only delayed his kingside attack. Due to his much
better bishop and a more mobile majority, Black is much better. Two tasks await Black: using the
kingside majority and be ready to prevent White’s queenside play with b4. The first part is natural, the
centralisation of the king. The king heads to e5, forcing White to control the d4-square in order to
prevent penetration.
612
Position after: 28.Kd3
28...h6?!
29.h3?!
This move prepares the ...g5 advance. Doubled rooks on the g-file will neutralise White’s control of the
h-file as Black will be able to cover the 7th rank with ...R8g7.
35.Rh5+ Kd4
613
Position after: 35...Kd4
Now Black’s idea has become clear. White’s defence is overstretched and the king, by covering the g-
file, allowed its black counterpart to infiltrate. The game is over and the rest is a matter of technique.
39.Rd3
614
39.Re1 R8g7 40.Rxg7 Rxg7 41.Kxf3 Kxb3 42.Kxf4 Kxa3–+
39...Bh3! 40.Rxf3
43.Rc6 Kd3 44.Rxd6 Be2+ 45.Kf2 f3 46.Rh6 Rg8 47.Rh2 Kxe4 48.Rh4+ Kd3 49.Rh2 Rg6
White resigned. Making only one mistake on move 12, White could not avoid such a bad endgame
against Black’s powerful bishop. Firmly controlling the most important square, Black organised an
unstoppable attack on the kingside. Weaknesses on the queenside helped him deflect the white troops
and the realisation was straightforward.
0-1
Game 58
Karpov – Spassky
Leningrad 1974
1.e4 c5 2.Nf3 e6 3.d4 cxd4 4.Nxd4 Nf6 5.Nc3 d6 6.Be2 Be7 7.0-0 0-0 8.f4 Nc6 9.Be3 Bd7 10.Nb3
615
Position after: 10.Nb3
At this point, Karpov was leading the match. Hence, he logically chose a more positional line. By
playing this move, White doesn’t allow Black to exchange knights and then place the bishop on c6.
10...a5
A typical and fashionable move in those days. After White’s next move, the black knight gets the b4-
square. In return, the b5-square becomes weak.
After the knight leaves c6, this is a good reaction. Black’s knight will not be on b4 forever – it can be
attacked with the c-pawn. White has a pleasant choice between placing the knight on b5, and capturing
the bishop and gaining the bishop pair advantage.
616
Position after: 13.Nd4
13...g6?!
13...Nd7 to transfer the knight to c5 was a more flexible and logical choice.
The text move has the idea to control the f5-square and prepare the move ...e5. White allows this by
playing his patient and strong next move – the point is that Black’s plan is not good.
14.Rf2 e5?!
617
Position after: 14...e5?!
15.Nxc6
Karpov stays true to his style. He prefers a simpler solution, giving him a stable long-term advantage.
15.Ndb5!? looks promising, although after 15...d5, a very complicated and double-edged position
arises.
15...bxc6
15...Nxc6 is worse. After 16.f5!, White is ready to expand on the kingside at the right moment. More
importantly, he controls all the important light squares – his light-squared bishop has no opposition.
This bishop will probably be placed on the long a2-g8 diagonal.
16.fxe5! dxe5
In this position, it may look as though everything is OK for Black. However, the experienced player,
and especially Karpov, may easily detect the disharmony in Black’s army. White’s light-squared bishop
seems neutralised and both the d- and f-files bring nothing to White... However, this is only visual.
Going a little deeper, it becomes apparent that Black is in trouble. His pieces cannot find good squares.
On the other hand, the white army will soon establish full control over the centre and the entire board.
The point is that the key c4-square will be under White’s control. Again, let’s remember: “Always
place a piece in front of the opponent’s central pawn if it cannot be attacked!”. The c4-square can be
used by the white queen, bishop and knight... and even the king in the endgame! From this square, all
the white pieces will cause Black many problems, attacking weak pawns and controlling weak squares.
618
The next stage of the game will convincingly confirm these statements. Karpov’s next move is brilliant.
17.Qf1!
After placing the queen on c4, the c6- and f7-pawns will be targeted.
17...Qc8 18.h3
18...Nd7
19.Bg4!
Karpov gives away his bishop for the knight – it is important that the c4-square remains under White’s
control. Meanwhile, Black cannot use the c5-square at all.
19.Qc4 Qa6 and Black achieves a lot. He will inevitably move his bishop to c5, happily exchanging the
bishops. Black will then have an excellent spot for the knight on c5, and a very promising position.
619
Position after: 22...Qe7
23.Rf1
23.Bc5 Qg5 24.Rad1 was also very good for White, maybe even a better option. It looks like the game
would continue: 24...Rfd8 25.Rxd8+ Rxd8 26.Rf1 Rd7 27.Bxb4 axb4 28.Qxc6, placing the knight on d5
and reaching a completely winning position. Not once did Karpov go for the simplest solution if it
made his task any more difficult.
23...Rfd8 24.Nb1!
620
Position after: 24.Nb1!
24...Qb7 25.Kh2
With the simple idea of playing g3. 25.c3 Rxd2 26.Nxd2 Nc2
looked like a complication to Karpov, so he rejected it. Although, after 27.Bh6!!, Black will be in big
trouble after the upcoming Nf3.
25...Kg7 26.c3
621
Position after: 26.c3
26...Na6
27.Re2!
White keeps the rooks on the board! After attacking the black bishop, the rook will move to f2, creating
terrible pressure on f7. Black is already hopeless. There are so many weaknesses on both flanks and
complete disharmony in the black camp. Take a look at his minor pieces...
622
Position after: 29...f6
Black has managed to defend the f-pawn, but now White strikes on the other side. The d8-square is
occupied by the black bishop and White immediately uses this to penetrate via the d-file.
30.Rd2!
623
Position after: 32.Rxd8
32...Bxd8
32...Rxd8 33.Nxe5!+–
33.Rd1 Nb8
35...Rxd8 36.Be7+–
1-0
A convincing victory.
It is a perfect example on the topic of important squares. Indeed, control over the important c4-square
gave White excellent prospects on both flanks, which were superbly utilised by Karpov.
Game 59
Guimard – Euwe
Groningen 1946
624
1.d4 Nf6 2.Nf3 g6 3.g3 b6 4.Bg2 Bb7 5.c4 Bg7 6.0-0 0-0 7.Nc3
Black decided to activate his bishops by fianchettoing them. Controlling the centre from a distance,
Black is ready to attack it later with some pawns. His next move is played with the idea to secure the
exchange of the light-squared bishops. This can make White’s king slightly more vulnerable.
7...Ne4 8.Nxe4
8...Bxe4
625
Position after: 8...Bxe4
626
The position is completely equal. Everything will depend on the players’ strategical skills, form and
creativity.
15.d5?!
This move looks strange, especially in view of the rest of the game. White allows the formation of a
pawn chain, but is nowhere near ready to attack its base. Furthermore, some poor coordination in
White’s camp will be apparent.
A) 15.f3 with the idea of e4, suggested by Kmoch, was more logical.
B) 15.Qc2 with the same idea of e4, suggested by Botvinnik, also looks better.
20.g4?
20...Kh7 21.Ne3
627
Position after: 21.Ne3
White has perfectly prevented Black’s ...f5 break, but Black hasn’t said his final words.
21...Ra8!?
This mysterious rook move is actually quite logical. Black wants to play 22...a5, hoping to eliminate
the b4-pawn and secure a perfect square for the knight on c5.
22.Rg1 a5
628
Position after: 22...a5
23.b5?
Perhaps a fatal mistake. It is hard to believe that Black wins after this move, but White is definitely left
without counterplay. Black will easily organise an attack on the kingside, which will be supported by
the perfect c5-knight.
23.a3 was a must. Black would have had the very interesting possibility 23...Ra7, doubling (or even
tripling) on the a-file with the idea to provoke the move b5. After that, the knight would jump to c5 and
the rooks would be transferred back to the kingside.
23...Qg5 24.Rg3
With the idea to be ready in case of ...f5 or ...h5. White can even prophylactically double the rooks on
the g-file.
24...Nc5 25.Re1 a4
With the idea to transfer the rook to b4 via a4, if possible. White decided to stop this.
26.a3
However, the black knight can now make use of the b3-square, which leads it to d4. By preventing one
infiltration, White allows perhaps an even more dangerous one.
629
Position after: 27...Kg7
28.Ng2
White wants to be ready to blockade the position on the kingside with h4 after any of Black’s advances.
Black grasps his last chance to avoid the closing of the position and strikes.
28.Nf5+ gives nothing because of 28...Kf8.
630
28...h5 29.h4 hxg4
30.fxg4
30.Rxg4 is not good. After 30...Qe7 31.Kg1 Rh5 Black can place both rooks on the h-file, evacuate the
king and advance ...f5. Feel free to consider the consequences and ensure that White is in big trouble.
30...Rxh4+!
631
Position after: 30...Rxh4+!
Tactics serve strategy. With an exposed, under attack king, White’s position becomes hopeless.
32...Qxh4 33.g5
632
Position after: 33.g5
33...Nb3!?
33...Nxe4 was a direct win. The knight is untouchable. After 34.Qxe4? Qh2+ 35.Kf3 Rh4 Black wins
easily.
34.Rg1?
34.Kf2 is better, although after 34...Qf4+ 35.Qf3 Rh2+ 36.Kg1 [Or 36.Rg2 Rxg2+ 37.Kxg2 Qxg5+]
36...Qh4 Black should win.
34...Nd2!
633
Position after: 34...Nd2!
35.Kf2
35.Qxd2 Qh2+–+
35...Nxe4+
White resigned.
White made a serious mistake by allowing Black to get his knight to c5. As a result, he played the rest
of the game without even a glimpse of activity. Black was able to patiently organise a kingside attack,
which finally led to a convincing win.
0-1
Game 60
Khalifman – Adams
Groningen 1990
Black chooses the Bogo-Indian. Usually, after exchanging the dark-squared bishops, Black opens the
diagonal for his light-squared one by placing his pawns on d6 and e5.
634
Position after: 5.g3
5...Nc6
5...b6 6.Bg2 Bb7, with control over the e4-square, is also well-known and fine for Black.
6.Nc3
White takes control over the e4-square, forcing Black to exchange the bishop for the knight at some
point. Black decides to do it immediately.
10.Rxc3 e5
White must make a decision. Capturing on e5 is primitive and Black is out of trouble after recapturing
with the pawn. Keeping the tension in the centre also doesn’t hinder Black’s development. So, White
chooses the most active continuation. Although, after this advance, there is a risk of making the g2-
bishop bad.
11.d5
635
Position after: 11.d5
11...Nb8!
14.c5
636
Position after: 14.c5
White found this active continuation on move 11. He wants to utilise his superior development.
Otherwise, after finishing development, Black would have excellent prospects due to his potentially
powerful bishop.
14...Na6
14...dxc5 would be risky. After 15.Ne4 Na6 16.d6 cxd6 17.Qxd6 Qxd6 18.Nxd6 White has more than
compensation.
17.a3?!
After this unnecessary prophylactic move, White loses the initiative. Black gets a chance and turns the
game around.
More aggressive was 17.Qb3 Nc5 18.Qb5 Bd7 19.Qb6 Qxb6 20.Nxb6 Ra6 21.Nc4 with annoying
pressure on the d6-pawn.
637
Position after: 18...Bd7
The bishop is much better placed there than on b7, of course. Otherwise, White would happily place his
bishop on h3.
19.Qb1 b4!
638
Position after: 21...Nc5
The situation has clarified. Black is already better. White’s pieces are kicked back and the c5-knight is
dominating the entire board. White’s next move is incorrect.
22.Ne4?
A) 22.Qc2 with the idea of transferring the rook to the a-file, was obviously a better choice.
B) 22.f4!? in order to find counterplay on the kingside also deserved attention.
22...Bf5!µ
A simple move that Khalifman incredibly allowed. Black will dominate in the endgame with a strong
knight against a bad bishop.
23.Rc4 b3
Although this pawn will be fixed on a light square, it will be safe. The bishop will soon be unable to
attack it.
The text move grants Black control over the outposts a2 and c2.
26.Bg2
639
Position after: 26.Bg2
26...Qa5
27.h4?!
It is now too late to go for kingside counterplay. The queenside should be White’s focus.
640
Position after: 28...Na4
29.Qb4?
Although it looks logical, it is not good. ¹ 29.Qc1 and Black doesn’t have a better move than 29...Nc5,
closing the c-file and preventing counterplay with Rc7 [29...Nxb2? 30.Rc7„].
29...Qxb4
29...Rfb8? 30.Rc8+!+–
641
Position after: 30.Rc8+!+–
30.Rxb4 Rfb8!
The position is technically winning for Black. White’s lone rook cannot prevent material loss.
642
Position after: 34.e4
White tries some tactics, but Black convincingly realises his huge advantage.
34...Rc2 35.Ra1
35.exf5 Rxb2–+
643
After trying all the active moves and tactics, White resigned. Unable to find an active continuation on
move 17, White switched to defence. That is one of the most important psychological aspects in the
game of chess – deciding when to seek activity, and when to switch to defence.
0-1
Game 61
Petrosian – Botvinnik
Moscow 1963
Botvinnik was a real expert in the Grunfeld Defence. On the other hand, Petrosian was known as a
master of prophylaxis, manoeuvring and defence. It is understandable that he wanted to lead the game
in a quiet manner against Botvinnik, who would always prefer dynamic play. A master of strategy
against a master of dynamics – an interesting matchup!
6...dxc4
6...c5!?
7.Bxc4 c5 8.d5
644
Position after: 8.d5
8...e6?!
This move was tested by Botvinnik a little before this match. So, Petrosian could prepare against it, and
he did.
8...a6!? was another interesting solution.
645
Position after: 11...fxe6
Here, we must stop for a while. Analysing some of his previous games, Botvinnik stated that this
endgame is very comfortable for Black. Black has solid development, and maybe even a space
advantage. The e6-pawn cannot be counted as a significant weakness.
What about Petrosian’s evaluation? Well, a journalist asked him about his preparation and the position
in general. His answer was utterly surprising: Petrosian was sure that he would win this endgame! Of
course, he did not say that the endgame was winning. He was just convinced he would win. The reason
for such a drastic statement is that there are not a lot of dynamics going on. Hence, he knew that
Botvinnik would feel uncomfortable. Black has some active play, but static elements would soon
prevail. Petrosian saw that his knight will end up dominating the entire board from the excellent and
safe e4-square. This knight will control so many important squares and allow White to play on both
sides. Indeed, Petrosian won the game without Botvinnik even making any obvious mistakes...
13...Rad8?!
The first mistake. Black is forced to lose a tempo. This probably confirmed Petrosian’s statement in his
mind – Botvinnik immediately went for an imprecise move.
13...Kf7 was correct: 14.Ng5+ Ke7 with centralisation of the king.
646
Position after: 15.Ng5!
15...Re8™
647
Position after: 19.Bd2!
19...Nd5
Compared to the previous diagram, material has reduced and the game has been simplified. The most
important factor in this position is the e4-knight. It dominates the board, covering so many important
squares. It is safe there – a consequence of isolating the e6-pawn. There are good places for our pieces
in front of our opponents’ weak pawns. Still, it is difficult for White to cause any serious damage with
this knight. White proceeds prophylactically, setting the scene for the creation of new weak points in
Black’s camp.
19...Nxa2? 20.Ra1 Nb4 21.Bxb4 cxb4 22.Rxa7 Bxb2 23.Rb7±
20.a4
With the idea to fix the black pawns on dark squares and establish control over the light squares.
22...Be7
This allows White to play his next move, seizing the initiative.
22...Rc7 was more precise.
23.b4! c4
648
A natural reaction, Black doesn’t allow the isolation of his c5-pawn.
24.b5
24...Kf7?!
Petrosian later suggested the following line as better for Black: 24...Ba3 25.Rc2 c3! 26.Bxc3 Bb4
27.Kd2 Rc4 28.Bxb4 Rxe4 29.Bd6 Rxa4.
649
Position after: 29...Rxa4
According to him, Black should go for concrete play – waiting and playing patiently is not a viable
option. Here, White’s advantage is not significant.
25.Bc3!
White blocks the c4-pawn. The idea it to attack it later after Nd2 and Be5. Black’s pawn on c3 would
also be in danger.
Black now goes for active play, but it is probably already too late. Black’s c-pawn is in danger.
650
Position after: 28.Rc2
28...Ke7
If 28...e5 then 29.Nd2 c3 30.Ne4 Ke6 31.Kd3 Rd8+ [31...Kd5 32.Nxc3+] 32.Kc4 Rd2 33.Kb3 with a
clear advantage.
29.Nd2! c3
32...Rd7 33.Kb3+–
33.Nxc3
651
Position after: 33.Nxc3
White has achieved a lot and gained a pawn. Botvinnik, probably upset by the turn the game has taken,
strangely makes another mistake.
33...Rh1?
The knight had to be captured. Black’s bishop is out of play. The difference in importance between the
minor pieces will soon be evident.
33...Bxc3 34.Kxc3 Rh1 35.h3 Kd7 gives Black some practical chances to survive.
34.Ne4!
An amazing move. White gives the pawn back “for nothing”. Actually, only a brief look at Black’s
scattered army is enough for a diagnosis – Black is hopeless.
34...Rxh2 35.Kd4
652
Position after: 35.Kd4
35...Kd7
This manoeuvre was Petrosian’s idea. The king joins the attack. Not only are Black’s kingside pawns in
danger, so is his king.
653
Position after: 39.Kg7!
What a king!
White attacks the king directly. Everything had been precisely calculated by Petrosian.
654
Position after: 44.Ke8
Consistent.
45...Rxa4 46.Nc3+–
655
Material loss is inevitable. Black resigned. It is extremely important to understand such games from a
psychological viewpoint. Both players were satisfied with the position they achieved after the opening.
From an objective point of view, we must admit that Botvinnik’s evaluation was correct. However,
psychology plays a crucial part in chess, so Petrosian was also right. It is very important to get a type of
position you are familiar with in your game, and that your opponent isn’t. In this game, Botvinnik
simply made some imprecise moves, not feeling the danger soon enough. After that, it was already very
difficult for Black to save the game.
1-0
656
Game 62
Krasenkow – Protaziuk
Suwalki 1999
5...Nxc3
6.dxc3!
657
Position after: 6.dxc3!
No, White is ready to play patiently, enjoying perhaps a small but stable advantage. The point is that
the black queenside is very weakened after the advance of the c-pawn. White can comfortably access
the c4-square (note: always place a piece in front of the opponent’s central pawn if other pawns cannot
attack it!). Also, the b5- and d5-squares can also be used by the white pieces. For instance, the white
bishop on f4 could control a very important diagonal, and after the natural setting of black pawns on f6
and e5, the entire light-squared complex would be weakened.
6.bxc3 g6 7.d4 transposes to the Grunfeld.
6...Qxd1+
White has a slight space advantage and Black logically wants to trade queens.
6...Qc7 is playable, but I feel that there is disharmony in the black army. After 7.Bc4, several games
showed that he has problems with finishing development. The light-squared bishop lacks a good
square, as moving it to g4 would probably lead to giving the advantage of the bishop pair to White.
Likewise, the dark-squared bishop would not find a comfortable spot on e7 nor g7; in both cases,
pawns would restrict it. [White also has the option to play 7.Bd3 followed by Qe2, which can give him
attacking chances on the kingside after advancing his pawn to e5.]
7.Kxd1
658
Position after: 7.Kxd1
White’s king is well-placed on d1, and it will soon go to the perfect central c2-square.
7...Nc6 8.Kc2
It looks like White is delaying the activation of the c1-bishop. The text move simply waits to see what
Black will do about his f8-bishop first.
A) 8.Be3 is quite possible.
B) 8.Bf4 is another good choice.
8...e6
(8.Kc2) 8...g6 can be met with 9.Be3 with the idea to provoke the move ...e6, which would weaken the
f6-square. 9...b6 10.Bb5 Bd7 11.a4 Bg7 12.Rhd1 with an evident advantage and the positional threat of
advancing a5.
9.Bf4!?
659
Position after: 9.Bf4!?
This move was actually Krasenkow’s improvement. The bishop targets the weakened d6-square and
Black is almost forced to advance his e-pawn again.
9...f6 10.Nd2
This is a standard and logical regrouping plan. The knight heads to the strong c4-square, while the a-
pawn will be advanced to a4, supporting the knight.
10...e5?!
Black consistently restricts White’s dark-squared bishop, but then light-squared weaknesses appear.
11.Be3 Be6
660
Position after: 11...Be6
12.Bc4
Of course, once White exchanges Black’s light-squared bishop, he can aim for a good knight vs. bad
bishop type of position.
There is no time to play 12.a4 prematurely. After 12...0-0-0 the move Bc4 is forbidden: 13.Bc4??
Rxd2+.
12...Kf7?!
Black should fight for some light squares with ¹ 12...Bxc4 13.Nxc4 b5, even though this is still
slightly better for White.
13.a4
Now it is too late, White’s knight will dominate from square c4.
661
Position after: 16...Rhd8
White has a small and stable advantage. There is the intention of getting the dream endgame with a
knight versus a bad bishop.
Even with all the minor pieces on the board, it is clear that White’s pieces are better. White exchanges a
pair of rooks and is ready to combine play on both flanks. Firstly, he will organise activities on the
kingside and, at the right moment, switch to the queenside, making use of the many weak squares there.
With the idea of playing ...f5, perhaps. Black later decided not to go for it though. This move will make
the e5-pawn vulnerable.
18...g5? may look good to the inexperienced player, because it “blocks the kingside”. Even if true, it
creates new light-squared weaknesses. Anyway, the queenside is still open for White’s activities.
19.Rg1
662
Position after: 19.Rg1
A patient move. Aron Nimzowitsch would perhaps call it a “mysterious rook move”. However, it is not
that mysterious. The idea is to advance the h-pawn to h5 and open the h-file. If Black opposes this by
playing ...h5 himself, White would control the g-file after the exchange of pawns. Of course, this move
is also a measure against ...f5.
19...Rh8
20.Kd3
663
Position after: 23.Kc2
23...Rg8
24.hxg6 hxg6
24...Rxg6 25.f3!
664
preventing the move ...h5.
25.Rh1
White finally achieves control over the h-file. He has accumulated many pluses with patient play from
the beginning.
25...Nd8 26.Na3
Vacating the c4-square for the king. The knight is ready to be used on b5.
26...Nc6 27.Rh7
Without a real plan, Black’s position gets gradually worse with every move.
27...Rc8
27...Na5 28.Nb5!+–
28.Nc4
Do not rush!
665
Position after: 29...f5?!
Hoping to exchange some pawns. Black decides not just to wait for White’s further improvements...
After a short series of forced moved, the situation has cleared. White has kept an advantage due to
better minor pieces and weaknesses in Black’s queenside structure. The g4-pawn is separated from the
rest of the army and will soon face problems. White’s next few moves are very natural.
666
Position after: 34.Ne3
34...Bg5
Black has some counterplay. He lost a pawn but has activated his king and got rid of his bad bishop.
Alas, White accurately proves that Black’s initiative is temporary and that there is not enough
compensation for the pawn.
667
Position after: 38...a6
39.Nf6 b5 40.Nd5+!
40...Kg5
Black resigned.
1-0
Game 63
Gorodetzky – Radovanovic
Veliko Gradiste 2016
668
Position after: 5...g6
The game started with a Philidor, but now Black decides to switch to a Pirc setup.
669
Position after: 10.a4
Preventing ...b5 and intending to fix the a7-pawn after advancing the pawn to a5.
10...Qe7 11.Qc1
White is already running into some problems with finding a good setup to finish development. With the
bishop on c4, e2 would have been a fine square for the queen. Generally, the Hanham pawn structure
after dxe5 is more often in Black’s favour – the c6-pawn paralyses the c3-knight.
11...Nc5
Attacking the e4-pawn and perhaps preparing to transfer this knight to d4 or f4 via e6.
12.Nd2 a5!
A very important resource for Black in this kind of structure. Fixing the a4-pawn and securing the very
important c5-square for the knight, Black has enough time to regroup and play for the initiative.
Meanwhile, White’s knights must protect the e4-pawn and are hindering other pieces. Black is already
better.
670
Position after: 14...Rfd8!
A very fine move. Precisely that rook belongs to the d-file. The f8-square is vacated for the bishop.
This is very important – it can be exchanged for White’s dark-squared bishop, weakening his dark-
squared complex on the queenside.
15.Qa3?!
A strange idea. In fact, White will admit it was a mistake on the next move.
15.f3 was perhaps a good move, with the idea to free the knights by protecting the e4-pawn. However,
Black will have an excellent opportunity to switch his activities to the kingside with 15...Nh5.
17.Bf1 Rd7
671
Position after: 17...Rd7
A lot of time has passed without White improving even a single piece. Probably fearing Black’s
growing initiative and lacking a promising plan, he decided to play...
18.g4?
This move is a big mistake. Sometimes this move can be made with a fianchettoed bishop on g2, in
order to launch a kingside attack. However, the entire white army is locked on the queenside. The idea
behind this move cannot be to attack the f6-knight either – it would jump to h5 and then f4. White’s last
move is just a horrible mistake as it simply creates weaknesses.
18...Rad8
Black’s reaction is simple. Faced with a flank attack, he counters by improving his position in the
centre.
19.Bg2 Na6!
672
Position after: 19...Na6!
Black is consistent. Simply by following his plan of exchanging the dark-squared bishops, he will reach
a superior position.
20.Nf1 Rxd1
20...Bc5, giving White the opportunity to take on the d-file first, was perhaps even better.
21.Rxd1 Bc5
21...Rxd1 may seem better as it makes the knight “passive”. Black had probably planned that initially
but switched to a better option before capturing twice. Remember, the knight is bad on c3!
22.Qc1 Rxd1
22...Bxe3 23.Nxe3 Nb4 looks like a better option – see the previous note.
23.Nxd1 Qd6
673
Position after: 23...Qd6
24.Qd2
This looks logical. White wants to get rid of Black’s superbly placed pieces, which dominate the dark
squares in the centre and on the queenside.
A very interesting solution. After White’s response, Black may be able to create an outside passed
pawn on the h-file by undermining White’s kingside pawn chain with ...f6 and ...g5.
674
Position after: 29.Ne3
It looks like White has achieved a lot. He has managed to exchange a lot of his passive pieces, and to
reduce the opponent’s pressure in the centre and on the queenside. He even managed to fix some of the
opponent’s pawns on light squares, and his king is ready for action. White would like to place a knight
on c4, attacking both black pawns. However, Black’s next simple move prevents this. It also leads to
the creation of a dangerous passed pawn on the a-file!
675
Position after: 31.Nb1
31...Nc6
This move prepares the advance of the a-pawn while the knight heads to d4. Black probably didn’t play
31...a4 immediately in view of 32.c3 Nc6 33.b4 with some counter-chances due to the weak b5-pawn.
34...f6!
Opening another front. Black wants to create a passed pawn on the h-file too. With these two powerful
and distant passed pawns, Black should be very close to the win.
676
Position after: 36.Nd5
White finally finds some activity. Alas, Black simply destroys all of his hopes.
36...Bxd5!
The only move, but a simple and strong one. Black’s knights control the entire board and with a passed
pawn on both flanks, the game seems to be decided.
677
Position after: 38...Kxf6
Take a look at the black knight on c5. It has been there for such a long time, and has been safe and very
influential. Blocking one of White’s pawns and stopping another, it even protects the a-pawn. All of
that thanks to Black’s fine 12th move. Pieces placed on secure and key squares in the centre are bound
to play an important role in the next stages of the game.
39.Bd5 Nf5
678
Position after: 47.Kh3
47...e4
679
Yet again, tactics serve strategy...
White resigned.
A great game, which perfectly depicts many important properties of the Hanham structure after dxe5 in
the Phillidor or Pirc Defence. A typical method was shown: patient and persistent occupation of dark
squares in the centre and on the queenside. The realisation was also very instructive.
0-1
Game 64
Alekhine – Chajes
Karlsbad 1923
1.d4 Nf6 2.c4 e6 3.Nf3 d5 4.Nc3 Nbd7 5.Bg5 Be7 6.e3 0-0 7.Rc1 c6 8.Qc2 a6 9.a3 Re8 10.h3 b5
This is the first important moment in the game. White decides to block the queenside and play on the
kingside.
11.c5 Nh5
12.Bf4!?
680
White has other plans. His idea is to prevent ...e5, even prepared to give away the bishop for the knight.
14...g6
After this move, White will comfortably advance his h-pawn, seizing the initiative. He will choose the
right moment to open the h-file, maybe even keeping his king in the centre.
14...h6!? was probably a better and more flexible move.
681
Position after: 17...Ra7
By preventing the ...e5 advance, White has established a strong blockade of Black’s kingside in order to
then organise an attack.
18.Nd1!
The knight heads to g4 via e3. From there, it will control some important dark squares, especially e5.
18...Bg7 19.Ne3
19...f5?!
From a certain point of view, it is natural for Black to want to forever eliminate threats on the b1-h7
diagonal. On the other hand, the position gets definitively blocked. This means that White will have the
possibility to patiently carry kingside play. On the queenside, by the way, White will make sure the
position remains closed.
20.Qe2 a4
682
Position after: 20...a4
683
Position after: 24...Qc7
White is much better. One brief look at the position is enough to be sure. The most obvious factors are
that White has a much better bishop, better squares for his knight, and a safer king. His space advantage
is also important. Hence, refusing the exchange of queens is a logical decision.
Black is consistent.
28...Qf6
29.Be2
The bishop aims for the h5-square to eliminate one of the pieces defending the black king.
684
Position after: 34.Nd3
This knight is on the right spot. It controls two key squares: b4 and e5.
34...Be8
White should definitely try to invade down the h-file. Doubling on the e-file should not bring much –
the e6-pawn would easily be defended by Black’s minor pieces. White’s king needs to be evacuated to
the queenside. Even the threat of penetrating via b4 or e5 may be on the agenda in the endgame.
This defensive manoeuvre looks pretty good. The king heads to the safety of the queenside. It would
even be ready to oppose its white counterpart in the endgame.
38.Rhe1?!
685
Position after: 38.Rhe1?!
White wastes time but, of course, Black cannot do anything about it. In closed positions where your
opponent is unable to carry out any active plans, you are allowed to waste some time, slowly trying to
find the right continuation...
38...Nf8?
39.Nb4 Kd8?
Black overlooked a nice tactical shot, which was surprisingly also missed by Alekhine. It is easy to
explain such a mistake – White was focused on strategical approaches, which is very natural in such
closed positions.
39...Kf7 was the only good move, but Black wanted to continue with the evacuation.
686
Position after: 39...Kd8?
40.Kd3
42...Rec7 43.Rh2 Bg6 44.Qe3 Kc8 45.Rch1 Kb7 46.Kd2 Re7 47.Nd3 Nd7
687
Position after: 47...Nd7
White’s pieces are all on their best squares. What to do now? Alekhine’s next move shows his other
side. He is famous for his attacking playing style, sacrifices and combinations. However, his next move
shows his impressive strategical understanding.
48.Bh5!
Perhaps a key move in the game. There can be no progress made on the h-file while the bishop is on g6.
Opening the position by preparing g4 was risky. Alekhine perfectly evaluates the position and his
diagnosis is correct: he doesn’t need his light-squared bishop – it cannot attack anything. It should
therefore be used to eliminate Black’s main defensive piece.
688
Position after: 50.Rh7
Black must not take this knight: 51...Nxe5 52.fxe5! Qf8 53.Qg5 is lost for him.
52.Rh8 Rg7
53.Nf3
Another fine manoeuvre. The knight goes to g5, vacating the e5-square for the queen.
689
Position after: 54...Re7
55.Qe5!
This move decides the game. The paralysed black troops are unable to do anything against White’s
doubling on the 8th rank.
58.Rhh8
58...Ree8
690
Position after: 58...Ree8
59.axb4
59.Nh7+–
59...Ka7 60.Kc3
Alekhine always preferred to finish a game in style. He spotted an interesting possibility... to play for a
mate!
691
Position after: 62...Rd8
63.Rh1!
63...Rd7 64.Ra1
Black resigned.
Once a position is blocked in the centre, flank activities become a must. The game was also a good
lesson on understanding the relative worth of bishops. Finally, the evacuation of the king in blocked
positions is always a manoeuvre that one should have in mind. A masterpiece with an exquisite ending
presents a less well-known side of the great champion.
1-0
Game 65
Smyslov – Letelier
Venice 1950
1.e4 e6 2.d4 d5 3.Nc3 Bb4 4.e5 c5 5.a3 Bxc3+ 6.bxc3 Ne7 7.a4 Qa5 8.Qd2 Nbc6 9.Nf3
692
Position after: 9.Nf3
9...cxd4?!
Premature. Black should not exchange the queens while the bishop is still on c1. The point is that, from
d2, the bishop prevents the useful Nc6-a5-c4 manoeuvre, which is an important resource for Black.
9...Bd7 10.Bd3 f6 11.Ba3 cxd4 12.cxd4 Qxd2+ 13.Kxd2 Na5 is a common line, and a much better
version for Black.
693
Position after: 11...Nf5
12.Bc3!
Perhaps some would say that the bishop on c3 is “just a big pawn”. This would be very far from the
truth. With his last move, White liberated a perfect spot for his king on d2. After attacking or
exchanging the f5-knight, White’s c3-bishop will once again be free and dominate on the a3-f8
diagonal.
12.c3? Na5„
14...0-0
Black would rather keep his king in the centre, but after 14...Ke7 15.g4 Nh6 16.h3 there are problems
with the h6-knight.
15.a5!
A very important move, fixing a target on b7 and preventing the move ...b6.
15...Rc7 16.Rhe1
Sooner or later, Black will move his pawn to f6 and king to f7. White’s move overprotects the e5-pawn
and indirectly attacks the e6-pawn.
694
16...f6 17.Bxf5 exf5 18.exf6 Rxf6
The position has settled. Instead of having the bishop pair and a space advantage, White enjoys better
coordination due to his better bishop and the holes in the black camp. With his next move, White puts
pressure on the b7-pawn and soon on the d5-pawn.
19.Rab1 h6 20.Rb5!
Suddenly, Black faces problems. There is no satisfactory way to protect the d5-pawn.
20...Be6
21.Reb1 Rff7
695
Position after: 21...Rff7
Excellent. Smyslov, as usual, puts emphasis on harmony between pieces. White’s rooks need support
and only the knight can help them. The knight can be placed on c5, but also on b4, e5 or f4.
22.Ne1
22.Ne5 was obvious enough, and a pretty good continuation. Still, the text move looks more dangerous.
After 22...Nxe5 23.dxe5 d4! 24.Bxd4 Rfd7 25.c3 White is probably winning but it is difficult to find a
concrete winning plan. Opposite coloured bishops give some practical chances to Black. White easily
keeps the initiative with knights on the board.
22...f4
A solid move. The bishop and rook get some space and the white king can no longer use the f4-square.
23.f3
696
Position after: 25.Re1!
Very nice. Black’s king is now far away from the centre and cannot easily cover all the infiltration
squares on the e-file.
25...Rf6 26.Rc5
26...Rc8
26...Rd7 27.a6!±
27.Nb4!
697
Position after: 27.Nb4!
Tactics serve strategy! The same story can be seen over and over again. A player leads a game in
perfect strategical style but then, at some point, strategy is no longer the way forward and tactics kick
in!
698
Position after: 33.Bb4
The previous moves were forced. Black loses the d5-pawn and the two white central passed pawns will
decide the game. Black’s counterplay on the kingside is not fast enough.
699
Position after: 40.Rc6+
40...Kh5
40...Kf7 41.Kd3 even bringing the king into the action, and then advancing the pawns.
Black resigned. By choosing his imprecise 9th move, Black ran into problems. Smyslov convincingly
led the game and completely deserved the win.
1-0
Game 66
Najdorf – Geller
Zuerich 1953
1.d4 Nf6 2.c4 g6 3.g3 Bg7 4.Bg2 0-0 5.Nf3 d6 6.0-0 Nc6 7.Nc3 Bg4
This line was very popular during the middle of the last century.
Now the point is evident: after eliminating the f3-knight, Black will put pressure on the d4-pawn. The
move ...e5 will also be on the cards.
10.Bg2?!
700
A strange move. White invites Black to capture on d4, with consequences that were not correctly
evaluated.
10.e3 e5
11.dxe5 [11.d5 Ne7 and Black is ready to provide typical play on the kingside after ...f5, with or
without placing the knight on c5 after ...a5.] 11...Ndxe5 with a balanced position where White should
be slightly better due to the bishop pair.
701
Position after: 12.Bg2
12...Rb4!
This was Geller’s idea. First of all, he keeps the c5-square for his knight. He wants to put pressure on
the b2-pawn, both on the b-file and along the diagonal in order to provoke the move b3. Then, the
knight on c5 will support the ...a5-a4 advance, crushing White’s queenside structure. It looks like a
daring plan, but White cannot actually do much against it.
42 days prior, in the same tournament, Petrosian played 12...c5? against Najdorf, which was a terrible
positional mistake. After that move, Black loses the perfect outpost for the knight and Black can no
longer prepare the strategically promising ...a5-a4 advance. 13.e3 Ne6 14.Qc2 a5 15.Bd2 Ne5 16.b3
Qd7 17.Kh2 Nc6 18.Rad1
702
Position after: 18.Rad1
and Black’s position looks really bad – there are no promising plans. There is nothing Black can do
against the patient improvement of White’s position on the kingside: Bf3, Kg2, h4, Rh1, h5... with or
without f4. Black’s play on the queenside can easily be stopped with Nb5 and a4 or after Na4.
Geller undoubtedly watched that game and found his great improvement.
13.e3
703
Position after: 14...Ne5?!
This move is a mishap in an otherwise perfectly played game. Black miscalculated that he cannot
capture on c4.
15.f4 Nd7
15...Nxc4? 16.a3+–
16.Nd5 Rb8
Black’s pieces are forced to retreat, but they will soon return to very active positions, targeting the
queenside.
704
Position after: 19.Rb1
19...a5!
Securing the c5-square for the knight and preparing the ...a4 advance.
20.Bd2 Nec5
That knight, of course! The other one can be placed on f6 or b6, or even e5 after White advances his f-
pawn.
22...Qa6 was perhaps more precise. Black can double on the b-file without losing a tempo by placing
the rook on c8.
23.Bc3
705
Position after: 23.Bc3
White wants to eliminate the sole defender of the black king, intending to launch a kingside attack.
27.Qxe4
706
Position after: 27.Qxe4
27...Re8
27...e6 was possible, of course, but it looks like Black wanted to allow White’s next move – the knight
gets an excellent outpost on e5.
28.f5?!
Looks positionally bad, but White must try something on the kingside – waiting would be a bad option
because of Black’s growing initiative on the queenside.
707
Position after: 29...Qa7
Bringing the queen to the defence and controlling the dark-squared diagonal.
30.Rbd1 Rb4
31.Qd4 c5
708
Now, even the pawn can be placed on c5. Black gains a tempo in order to crush White’s pawn structure
on the queenside.
32.Qh4 a4 33.Rxd6
A clever attempt, but Black effectively parries the attack, forcing the game into a much better endgame.
36.Qxe7?
This is suicide. Without the queens on the board, White is simply lost.
36.Rdf6 was a must. Black is clearly better, though.
36...Rxe7
This endgame is simply winning for Black. He has an extra pawn, the knight dominates over the
bishop, and his king is safer. The only target for the bishop, the f7-pawn, is effortlessly protected.
37.Bd5
709
Position after: 39...Nd3
The c5-pawn is protected and Black’s pieces are ready to attack the enemy king. The game is over.
White resigned.
A typical game on the topic of harmony and planning. By placing his pawn on c5, Petrosian lost the
option of placing his pieces harmoniously along with his chance to attack on the queenside. As a result
of this, his position collapsed due to not having a normal plan. Geller improved the line, placing his
knight on c5 instead. This helped him control the entire board and to decisively launch the a-pawn. Be
careful when advancing pawns in your games – they cannot be moved back again.
0-1
Game 67
Kosten – Chabanon
Cannes 2004
710
Position after: 5...e5
Black wants a reversed Botvinnik setup. This is playable, but accuracy is required – White has an extra
tempo and good chances to gain control over the weak d5-square.
6.0-0 Nge7?!
This seems logical, developing a piece. Actually, it is the wrong move order.
6...d6! is stronger – this move narrows down White’s options. After 7.Ne1 Be6 8.d3 Nge7 Black is
ready for ...d5 before the white knight gets to e3. So, after 9.Nd5 0-0 10.Nc2,
711
Position after: 10.Nc2
the c2-knight will go to e3, but this knights setup is less flexible than the one in the game – the knights
should be placed on c3 and d5 (the c1-bishop would not be blocked and the move e2-e3 would be
available, covering the d4-square).
7.Ne1!
7...0-0
10...a5
A standard reaction, preventing the move 11.b4, but the b5-square is now weak.
11.Bg5
712
Position after: 11.Bg5
A very typical move in such positions. White wants to eliminate the e7-knight, which controls the weak
d5-square.
11...f6
This is the best move, but the g7-bishop is now shut-off and can only be reactivated after advancing the
f-pawn again. This will inevitably lead to the creation of some new weaknesses – probably the g5-
square.
11...h6? is a well-known positional mistake: 12.Bxe7 Nxe7 13.Rb1 Bd7 14.b4!? gives White an edge.
[Or 14.Ne3 with the occupation of the d5-square.]
713
Position after: 13...Nd4
Black’s knight on d4 will be kicked back after e2-e3. Meanwhile, White’s piece installed on d5 will be
safe!
15.Bxd5 seems solid, but after 15...Bxd5 16.Nxd5 b5 17.e3 Ne6 it looks like White’s knight on d5 is
not completely safe – Black can offer its exchange by moving his knight to c7.
15...a4!?
If 15...b5 then 16.e3 Nf5 [16...Nc6 17.cxb5 Rxb5 18.Qa4 is clearly better for White due to the many
weaknesses on the queenside and lack of harmony in the black camp.] 17.b4 and the opening of the
position on the queenside must be in White’s favour – the white minor pieces are much better placed!
714
Position after: 15...a4!?
16.b4! axb3
If 16...Nb3 17.Rb1 and Black must choose one of two bad options: to play with the badly placed knight
on b3, or to play with a bad bishop pair against White’s dominant bishop and knight after capturing on
d2.
17.e3
17...Nc6
18.Qxb3
White now has the open b-file. Black cannot even use the a-file because the white knight will soon be
placed on b6. Also, the b7-pawn is more vulnerable than the a3-pawn. White has a comfortable
advantage.
18...Ne7 19.Nb6
715
Position after: 19.Nb6
19...f5
19...Nc8, insisting on exchanging, brings nothing good to Black after 20.Rab1 Nxb6 21.Qxb6 with
dangerous pressure on the queenside.
20.Rab1 g5
21.f4
716
Position after: 21.f4
21...gxf4 22.exf4!
Control over the d4-square is weakened, but it is not that important. White’s king will have a solid
shield of pawns, unlike Black’s.
22...Nc6 23.Qd1
717
Position after: 26.Nxd5
White has a more influential and safer knight, and a more secure king. Also, Black may have problems
with the b7- and f5-pawns. Hence, White must be better. With his next move, Black tries to get rid of
one of his weaknesses. However, he tried to get rid of the wrong one.
26...b5?!
26...e4!? looks like a preferable option. After 27.dxe4 fxe4 28.f5 Nf3+ 29.Rxf3 exf3 30.Qxf3 White
looks better, but nothing is clear.
27.fxe5 dxe5?!
28.Bg5!
718
Position after: 28.Bg5!
28...Qe8
31...e4
A solid attempt in search of counterplay. The idea is also to exchange pawns in the hope of surviving
the endgame.
719
Position after: 33.Kg2!
Simple and strong. White avoids forks, places his king on a light square and closer to the centre.
33...Ra8?
This is the simplest. White exchanges material and eliminates Black’s strong bishop which controls the
important diagonal and secures the position of the black king.
36...Bxf6
720
Position after: 36...Bxf6
37.Nxf6!
37.Rxf6? Rxf6 38.Nxf6 Kg7 39.Ne4 Rxa3 40.Nxc5 Ra2+ with good chances for a draw.
721
40.Rg8+?!
40.Nh5+ looks even better. After 40...Kh7 41.Rff8 [41.Rc8 Rxa3 42.Rxc5 is also very good.] 41...Rxa3
42.Rh8+ Kg6 43.Nf4+ looks easily winning for White.
40...Kf7 41.Rh8 Kg7 42.Rh7+ Kg6 43.Rxa7 Rxa7 44.Ne4 Rxa3 45.Nxc5
After a more or less forced series of moves, White has two extra pawns in this endgame. It is not that
simple to convert this advantage due to the limited material on the board. In the end, with the help of
some tactics, White managed to win, although both sides made some bad moves...
45...Nf5 46.Rf4 h5
With the idea of exchanging this last pawn and to restrict the activity of the white king.
This fine response proves that Black’s temporary initiative is definitely not serious counterplay.
722
Position after: 49.Kh4!
49...Nxh2 50.Ne5+ Kg7 51.Rf7+ Kg8 52.Rf5 Rc3 53.Rg5+ Kf8 54.Kxh5
Black assumed he was simply exchanging a couple of pawns, but now White’s pieces are dangerously
active.
723
59.Ne5+
59...Ke7 60.c6?!
¹ 60.Nc6+
White’s pieces are surprisingly cramped and the win is now in doubt.
62.Kh4
62.Kh6 Ne4 63.Rh5 looks better, although after 63...Kd6 Black may save the game.
62...Ne4 63.Rf5
63...Ke6?
724
Position after: 63...Ke6?
64.Nf3! Rc4
66...Kd6
66...Rxc6? 67.Rf6++–
725
Position after: 68.Kf5
68...Rc1
69.g5 1-0
Black resigned. From a theoretical and strategical point of view, this was a very important game,
despite the mistakes made by both players in the endgame.
726
Pawn Chains
Game 68
Paulsen – Tarrasch
Nuremberg 1888
6.Bd3?!
This move was popular even in the 19th century. In the second half of the 20th century, it was played
with a completely different idea behind it. 6.Be2 or 6.a3 (see the next game) are more normal.
727
Position after: 7...Bd7
8.Be2?
Of course, this move is not recommended – White just loses an important tempo. However, authorities
back then considered the elimination of central tension as a benefit to White, even worth a tempo.
A) 8.0-0 Nxd4 9.Nxd4 Qxd4 10.Nc3 was a largely tested gambit in the 20th century. However, in our
computer era, it is considered as quite harmless. This is the reason why White’s 6th move is not very
popular. 10...a6 was shown to be the simplest way of parrying White’s initiative.
B) 8.Bc2? Nb4 with the idea of ...Bb5, with an initiative for Black on the queenside.
8...Nge7
728
Position after: 8...Nge7
9.b3
9.Na3 Nf5 [9...Ng6 10.0-0 Be7 with ...f6 coming soon is also good for Black.] 10.Nc2 is another way
to protect the d4-pawn.
729
11...Be7
Tarrasch’s biggest opponent, Aron Nimzowitsch, later suggested the amazing and beautiful line: 11...0-
0! 12.g4 Nh6 13.Rg1 f6! 14.exf6
14...Rxf6! and after 15.g5 Rxf3! 16.Bxf3 Nf5 Black is clearly dominating. Actually, Black can go for
this even with the bishop still on c8 (if White doesn’t lose a tempo with his light-squared bishop).
Black has solid compensation for the lost material.
730
Position after: 11...Be7
12.g3
White patiently regroups. The idea behind Tarrasch’s last move is that after 12.g4 he could play
12...Nh4. Black exchanges his knight, which was attacking d4, for a piece which was defending it.
Meanwhile, White’s king becomes vulnerable and Black would organise an attack down the f-file.
12...a5!?
A very interesting move. Before White activates his pieces, Black goes for queenside action.
13.a4
13...Rc8 14.Bb5
731
Position after: 14.Bb5
14...Nb4?!
There was no need for this. Black’s king will be safe in the centre and it is logical to use the weak b4-
square. However, it was more natural to try and exploit White’s passivity. 14...0-0 followed by ...f6
would be more unpleasant for White.
15.Bxd7+
This helps Black finish development. Later, Nimzowitsch correctly suggested 15.Nc3 Bxb5+ 16.Nxb5
732
Position after: 16.Nxb5
as better. Now, a big mistake would be 16...Nc2? 17.Rc1 Nce3+ 18.fxe3 Nxe3+ 19.Ke2 Nxd1
20.Rxc8+ Kd7 21.Rxh8 Nxb2 22.Rc1+–.
15...Kxd7 16.Nc3
16...Nc6
18...Qxa7 19.Qd3
733
Position after: 19.Qd3
This was White’s idea. By exchanging the knight, he hopes to cover the weak light squares with his
queen and to consolidate the position after Kg2 and Rhc1. Alas, Black has an important resource. His
next move probably shocked Paulsen.
19...Qa6!
Excellent. White must capture the queen, otherwise Black’s rook penetrates on c2. White cannot benefit
from the doubled a-pawns. This is actually good for Black, he has even opened the b-file!
734
Position after: 22...Rb8
Everything is going smoothly. For a long time, White will not even be able to try for activity on the
kingside. He is being completely outplayed.
Of course, Black has done a good job. White has maintained material balance but his position is
735
hopeless.
26...Rb2
A) 26...Ra3? 27.Rc1„
B) 26...Bb4 immediately was probably even better.
27.Bd2
27...Bb4 28.Bf4
Black has achieved a lot. Collecting some material on the queenside is only a matter of time. Seeing
perfectly well that White is hopeless, Black goes for the well-known principle: Don’t rush! With his
next move, he eliminates White’s active intentions on the kingside forever.
736
Position after: 32.Ba3
Avoiding this exchange earlier, White now offers it himself! Another proof that his position is
hopeless. Black could take, but prefers to build pressure on the d4-pawn.
This is a desperate attempt at counterplay... anywhere. Black, naturally, ignores the kingside.
737
Position after: 38.a5
38...Ra4!
41.Rd1 Rb3
The knight has returned to its best spot. It is stable on f5, attacking two pawns and protecting a weak
one... can we expect any more from a single knight?!
46...Nxd4 47.Na6+
738
Position after: 47.Na6+
47...Kd8!
739
the game is drawn due to a perpetual check.
Another piece of advice: be careful until the very end! One bad move in the endgame can simply ruin
the many good moves that got you there.
51.Nb5
53.f4 a4 54.Rb1 a3 55.f5 a2 56.Ra1 Ra4+ 57.Kh5 Kg7 58.fxe6 fxe6 59.Rg1+
740
Position after: 59.Rg1+
59...Kh8
59...Kh7 60.Rg7+ Kh8 61.Rh7+ Kg8 62.Rg7+ Kf8 would also win.
White resigned. A historical clash which made an enormous contribution to the entire Advance
variation. This game was the basis of a very detailed and complex part of Nimzowitsch’s work further
down the line.
0-1
Game 69
Clarke – Petrosian
Munich 1958
741
Position after: 6.a3
This move is very popular in our time. The idea is to gain space by advancing the b-pawn, or at least to
control the b4-square which might have been used by the black knight or bishop.
6...c4
This is an old move, whose idea is to fix the weak b3-square and prevent the move b4. In many cases,
Black is able to activate his queen or bishop on the a4-d1 diagonal.
742
Position after: 8.Bg2
8...0-0-0
One of many options, but more common is to delay castling. 8...Na5 is more logical because, sooner or
later, it will be played.
743
A very useful move in many French lines – the g5-square should be taken away from the white knight.
Since g3-g4 would be weakening, this knight doesn’t need the support of a pawn on h5.
14...Be7 15.Re1
15...Qb3!
Preparing infiltration.
16.Qe2
The king heads to safety. Also, there may be a need to transfer the rook to the b-file.
17...Qc2 is also good, of course.
18.Rad1
744
White gets a moment to activate the rook.
The centre is blocked. However, after deeper inspection, it becomes clear that Black is better. He
controls all the important squares. So, it is permitted for him to attack on the flanks.
Despite the bishop and knight being placed on the queenside, Black expands on the kingside. These
queenside pieces are ready for action as soon as they are needed.
20...g5!
745
Position after: 22...Rdg8
23.g4?
White is afraid of Black’s growing initiative. It was better to take no defensive measures.
The bishop protects the king and is very stable on g4. However, Black has more resources!
746
25...Nc6!
Bringing the knight back to the kingside! White’s position becomes critical.
30...Rxh3!?–+
31.Bxh3 Rxh3 32.Qg2 Qh7 33.Ne3 Ng6 34.Ng4 Nf4! 35.Bxf4 gxf4 36.Kf1 Rg3
747
Position after: 36...Rg3
37.Qf2
White resigned. He did not feel danger until it was too late. After Black’s 20th move, it was clear that
White was in trouble. His reaction on move 23 was a mistake which resulted in the black pieces
obtaining open files, which they successfully used. One of Petrosian’s very linear games, started in his
style and ended in an uncharacteristic attacking manner. 0-1
Game 70
Nimzowitsch – Salwe
Karlsbad 1911
Nimzowitsch was the first to explain details in this line. He gave prospects and evergreen ideas for both
sides. Thanks to him, many great masters of the last century were honoured to test and add to his
colossal work.
3...c5 4.c3
748
Position after: 4.c3
For the next two moves, Black naturally chooses two out of the three following moves: ...Nc6, ...Bd7
and ...Qd7.
4...Nc6
4...Bd7 5.Nf3 Qb6 can be played with the idea of ...cxd4 followed by ...Bb5. It is good for Black to
exchange light-squared bishops, even though some time will be wasted.
5.Nf3 Qb6
5...Bd7 here can lead to positions where Black plays for ...f6 after ...Nge7-g6 and ...Be7. Very often,
various move orders just lead to transpositions.
6.Bd3
749
Position after: 6.Bd3
6...Bd7?!
This is known to be imprecise. Nimzowitsch later explained that 6...cxd4 7.cxd4 Bd7 is the correct
move order. He explained that the lines after 8.Bc2 or 8.Be2 are very promising for Black. Nowadays,
players who opt for 6.Bd3 usually sacrifice the d4-pawn, seeking the initiative.
7.dxc5!
That is the point – the black knight and queen are now without prospects. The c5-bishop will be driven
back and the d7-bishop cannot be exchanged.
7...Bxc5 8.0-0
750
Position after: 8.0-0
8...f6?!
Another dubious move. Black hopes that he will be able to undermine what’s left of White’s pawn
chain. However, he should have foreseen that the white pieces will be installed on the squares vacated
by the pawns.
A) 8...Nge7? 9.b4+–
B) 8...a5 was the best choice.
Overprotecting e5.
751
Position after: 12.Bxe5
12...Nf6
12...Bf6 can be tried in order to eliminate the blockader 13.Qh5+ g6 14.Bxg6+ hxg6 15.Qxg6+ Ke7
16.Bxf6+ Nxf6 17.Qg7+ Kd6 18.Qxf6 was shown by Nimzowitsch as a potential continuation, but the
simple move 13.Nd2 also looks good.
752
Position after: 14...Bd6
White is definitely better. He has fixed Black’s hanging pawns in the centre and must now maintain this
blockade.
15.Qe2
15.Bd4 would be wrong due to 15...Qc7 16.Qe2 Ng4 17.h3 [17.Bxh7+ Kxh7 18.Ng5+ Kg6 19.Qxg4
Bxh2+ 20.Kh1 Qf4 is very good for Black.] 17...e5 and the blockade is no longer.
18.Rae1
Nimzowitsch’s play in this game produces a strong impression. He takes care of centralisation and
supporting the blockade simultaneously.
18...Bxe5?!
18...Ne4 should have been tried. 19.Bxe4 dxe4 20.Qxe4 Bb5 21.c4 Bxc4 22.Nxc4 Qxc4
753
Position after: 22...Qxc4
23.Qxe6+ [23.a3 keeps some advantage, but this should not be significant – Black’s pieces are very
active.] 23...Qxe6 24.Rxe6 Bxb4 25.Bxa7 Ra8 26.Be3 Rxa2 27.Rb6 Bd2 28.Bxd2 Rxd2 29.Rxb7 is an
interesting and long variation showing that Black still had a better option than the text move. This
endgame should be an easy draw.
754
White’s pieces are dominating. When controlling the centre, you should be able to play on either flank.
In this game, logically, White chooses the kingside – all of his pieces are targeting Black’s king!
21.Qc2
White’s hopes to create a weakness on the kingside. Also, rather importantly, the rook joins the attack.
Black overlooked this nice tactical shot. 23...Ne4, hoping for an endgame with opposite coloured
bishops, was his last practical chance, even if losing a pawn. 24.Bxe4 dxe4 25.Re1 is very bad for
Black, but still a better option than the text move.
24.Bxh7! e5
24...Nxh7 25.Qg6+–
White has gained a pawn and destroyed the black king’s shelter. White is winning.
755
Position after: 30...Kg8
Black has exchanged material to avoid direct threats on his king. White’s pieces dominate and he
consolidates his queenside. No need to rush.
This is the simplest. Not having a direct attack, White just transfers the game into a completely winning
endgame.
756
Position after: 36...Kd6
37.Bxf6
Again, the simplest solution. Very soon, two connected passed pawns will be created.
Black resigned. A very instructive performance by the great Aron! He convincingly proved one of his
postulates: a pawn chain should be attacked from both sides (both the base and the front) only if the
opponent’s pieces cannot be installed on the vacated squares. In this game, Nimzowitsch installed his
pieces on the vacated squares and created an irresistible blockade! A fabulous game!
1-0
Game 71
Petrosian – Lutikov
Tbilisi 1959
1.Nf3 Nf6 2.c4 g6 3.Nc3 Bg7 4.e4 0-0 5.d4 d6 6.Be2 e5 7.d5
757
Position after: 7.d5
Petrosian chose his favourite line against the King’s Indian, later named after him. He was the first who
practiced and suggested different paths for White, explaining all the pros and cons of the immediate
advance of the d-pawn. In those years, castling was usually played. White waited for Black to play
7...Nc6 in order to advance the d-pawn with a tempo.
7...Na6
Nowadays, 7...a5 is the most popular move, with the idea to secure the c5-square for the knight.
8.Bg5
A typical prophylactic Petrosian invention. He is ready to transfer his bishop to h4 and even g3. The
idea is to prevent Black from easily playing ...f5, or to provoke the move ...g5 which would create some
light-squared weaknesses.
8...h6 9.Bh4
758
Position after: 9.Bh4
9...c5?!
Black probably wants to radically prevent White’s expansion on the queenside. However, this move
cannot be good – it makes a fool of the a6-knight. White will also easily prevent any counterplay
involving ...b5. 9...g5!?, directly eliminating the pin, is possible, though this would weaken the light
squares.
10.Nd2 Bd7?!
It is apparent that there is no coordination in the black camp. Black must prepare two strikes against the
white pawn chains, ...b5 and ...f5, but it looks too difficult to even achieve one of them. The black
minor pieces are on strange squares. With his next fine move, Petrosian demonstrates a new idea.
¹ 10...Nc7!? with the idea to prepare ...b5, suggested by Petrosian, was probably a better option.
11.Nb5
759
Position after: 11.Nb5
11...Be8
A strange place for the bishop. However, the move was played with the idea to exchange the b5-knight
for a knight. 11...Bxb5? 12.cxb5² … Nc4+/ –
12.a3
12...Qd7
It is clear that Black has gone astray. Just one look at his position is enough to see that he’s in trouble.
So much time is needed for him to regroup, repress White’s initiative and eventually strike the bases of
White’s pawn chain. 12...Nc7 13.Nc3! a6 14.b4 with an advantage for White.
760
Position after: 12...Qd7
13.g4!?
Another one of Petrosian’s trademarks. White uses the fact that the centre is blocked to play on both
flanks. The idea of this expansion is to prevent ...f5 and cramp Black’s pieces. Even the h4-h5 strike
will be possible after the bishop retreats. The downside is that there is a risk involved with delaying
castling and weakening the kingside.
A) 13.Rb1 was a good choice, of course.
B) 13.0-0 was probably the best and most logical.
13...Nc7
Petrosian expected (13.g4!?) 13...Nh7 (… ... Bf6-g5) and planned to play 14.Bg3 Bf6?! 15.h4!.
14.Nc3 a6
761
Position after: 14...a6
15.a4!?
15.b4 was natural. Although Black can answer with 15...b6 [Or even 15...b5 with sharp play.],
implementing a waiting strategy on the queenside.
15...Qc8?!
¹ 15...a5 and it will be very difficult for White to prove that he can win the game on the kingside.
16.h3
16.a5! was a better choice, fixing the black pawn structure and keeping the option to open the position
on the queenside if needed.
762
Position after: 19.Nd1
Both players decided not to advance their pawn to a5, preferring to finish development and regroup
instead.
19...b5 20.a5
Finally, White played this move, but with a completely different idea: to restrict the black pieces.
763
Position after: 22.Ne3
22...Ne7?!
The knight is doing nothing there. It was more flexible to keep it on g8. 22...b4 was a better solution.
Black blocks the queenside and is ready to counter White’s initiative on the kingside. Only White can
benefit from opening the queenside at any moment.
23.Bh4
23.b4! creating a passed pawn was very good, but White played it later.
23...Qe8 24.b4!
24...Nc8
26...Bxb5 27.Qxc5+–
27.Bxb5
764
Position after: 27...Nd4„
would give Black counterplay. Although, after 28.Bxa6, White must be winning.
29...Rf7
29...h5!? 30.Ndc4±
765
30.Ndc4 Rb4 31.Be1! Rb7 32.Bc3
Attacking the e5- and f5-pawns, White wants to break the tension.
32...h5
32...fxe4 was better, although after 33.fxe4 Black is obviously in trouble: no coordination, bad minor
pieces, a bad pawn structure, weak squares...
766
Position after: 34.exf5
34...e4 35.Kh2+–
35.fxe4 Bxc3 36.Qxc3+ Rg7+ 37.Kh2 Qxe4 38.f6 Rf7 39.Ne5+– was a faster win. However, Petrosian
chose a safer line.
767
Position after: 36...Bd4
Black tries to attack something. Too little too late – the game is over.
37.Qd3 Bf6 38.Rg1 Kh7 39.Bxf6 Rxf6 40.Qc3 Qf8 41.Rg6 Rf7 42.Rg5 1-0
Black resigned. A very instructive and interesting battle. Quite simply, Black was unable to deal with
the new pattern suggested by Petrosian in this game.
768
Chapter 6
Coordination and Harmony
The title of this chapter is self explanatory. Of course, harmony can only be established among
developed pieces. However, developing pieces is just the first stage of the process – the second, and
also the most important, is making them collaborate. It is not enough to just develop pieces;
development without harmony is nothing! There are many positive aspects of establishing harmony – it
is easier to carry out an attack, but also easier to defend.
During a game, harmonisation is a frequent problem. Also, it may seem difficult to learn how to
establish harmony but, fortunately, there are many masterpieces out there (led by the brilliant
Capablanca, for instance), which make it much easier to understand. This chapter (and book), will shed
a light over the entire concept.
Game 72
Rubinstein – Duras
Karlsbad 1911
7.Nd5!?
769
I like this move. White wants to get the bishop pair advantage without damaging his pawn structure.
Black faces a dilemma.
7...Bf8
7...Nxd5 8.cxd5 Nd4 9.Ne1! will cause some problems to Black – the d4-knight cannot find a
comfortable and safe place.
8.d3 h6
Preventing Bc1-g5.
If 10...Be6 then 11.e4, with some disorder in the black camp. White is ready to soon play d4, with an
advantage in the centre.
12...c5
13.dxc6 Nxc6
13...bxc6 is bad. After 14.d4! exd4 15.Nxd4, White is clearly better due to the weak black pawns on c6
770
and d6.
14.d4 Bg4
15.d5
15...Ne7
15...Nd4 16.Bxd4 exd4 17.Qxd4 Bxf3 18.Bxf3 g6 is a reasonable option, knowing the game
continuation. Though it is difficult to decide to give away the pawn this way. Black has a better bishop
and it will be difficult for White to convert his extra pawn.
16.Qd3
This Rubinstein move and his next are about regrouping his troops towards the queenside. White has
more space and the pawn chain lights up the way for White’s activities.
16...Qd7
16...Nc8 was an interesting solution, with the same idea as White – regrouping. The bishop on f8
should be reactivated via e7 and d8. The knight goes to b6 and perhaps d7.
17.Nd2
771
Position after: 17.Nd2
17...Bh3?
Black’s previous move should have been made with the idea of connecting rooks. The idea of
exchanging the light-squared bishop is very bad – and Black cannot even dream about attacking the
white king. After the exchange, White’s dark-squared bishop will clearly dominate over his black
counterpart. Also, the white knight would be much stronger. Black’s minor pieces will not collaborate
well with the rest of the troops.
18.a4!
Allowing Black to exchange first and taking space on the queenside, all the while securing an excellent
position for the knight on c4.
772
Position after: 22.Ra3!
Protecting the b3-pawn and doubling on the a-file to attack the a7-pawn. Such multi-purpose moves
should be made automatically.
22...Ng6?
23.Rfa1 a6 24.Bc1
White does not forget about his bishop. Before finding a solution to invade, it is important to activate
all pieces – a trademark of Rubinstein’s.
24...Rb7 25.Be3 f6
Another strange move. It is clear that bad moves are made when good moves are not available.
773
Position after: 25...f6
However, every move should be part of a plan. 25...f6 is definitely a move without an idea behind it.
A very simple solution. One small step backwards will lead to many steps forwards. White renews the
threat to the d6-pawn. Also, after removing the knight from c4, the a6-pawn will fall!
Chess is such a simple game... when Rubinstein is playing!
774
Position after: 29.Qc4!
The a6-pawn is lost. For a long time now, Black has done nothing with his minor pieces. So, reducing
material by exchanging queens favours White.
29...Qxc4 30.Nxc4
30.bxc4? Rb2
775
30...Rab8 31.Nd2 Rc7 32.Rxa6
Finally.
34.Rxa2 Be7
35.Kf2
39...Bc7
Black is hopeless. Finally, he has managed to regroup his minor pieces towards the queenside, but now
they are stuck there.
40.g4
776
40...Bd8 41.Ra6 Bc7 42.h4
White has put his pieces on the best squares and now it is time for pawn play. Firstly, the pawn goes to
h5, to fix a target on g7.
Now it is time for the b-pawn. White has the idea to support the move b5 by getting the king to a4.
This leads to full paralysis but, anyway, the game was over.
777
Position after: 49.b6
Black resigned. Rubinstein superbly punished his opponent for neglecting to activate his minor pieces.
Simply, Black was unable to establish harmony and order within his army.
Game 73
Capablanca – Chajes
New York 1915
1.e4 e5 2.Nf3 Nc6 3.Bb5 a6 4.Ba4 Nf6 5.0-0 Nxe4 6.d4 b5 7.Bb3 d5 8.dxe5 Be6 9.c3 Be7 10.Nbd2
Nc5
778
Position after: 10...Nc5
All very well known theory, even back then. The next move is logical – White keeps his important
bishop...
11.Bc2
11...d4!?
12.Ne4
779
Position after: 12.Ne4
12...dxc3
Black wants to damage White’s pawn structure, but even isolated the white pawns would not be weak.
After playing his last move, Chajes should have chosen 12...d3!? now. After 13.Nxc5 dxc2 14.Qxd8+
Rxd8 15.Nxe6 fxe6
780
16.Be3 [16.Bf4 0-0 17.Bg3 g5! with excellent prospects for Black.] 16...Rd5 17.Rfc1 Nxe5 18.Nxe5
Rxe5 19.Rxc2 Kf7 with a visual, but not significant advantage for White.
It is an illusion that Black’s position is comfortable. His centralised forces are mostly hanging. The c3-
pawn is actually very strong, restricting both the black knight and bishop. Black’s queenside pawns are
exposed. Also, the space advantage for White is obvious. Black must proceed with precision.
17...Ne7
Black simply eliminates tactical shots and is ready to reactivate this knight. Capablanca goes for his
trademark moves – establishing harmony while causing chaos in the opponent’s camp. 17...0-0?! would
give White the chance for the tactical blow 18.Be3!? [18.Bg5 of course, would be more solid.]
18...Bxe3 19.Rxd7 Rxd7 20.Bxc6 Rd3 21.fxe3 Rxc3 Although, Black is actually OK here, it is still very
difficult to give such an opportunity to Capablanca.
18.Nd4!
781
Position after: 18.Nd4!
An amazing multi-purpose move. White takes control over the f5-square, keeping the black minor
pieces passive for a while. At the same time, the f2-pawn is no longer pinned and may support the
pawn on e5. And, perhaps most importantly, White will soon occupy the weak c5-square with great
effect.
18...h6
Preventing Bg5. However, the bishop has an even more important diagonal!
782
Position after: 20.Ba3
There is a notable difference in the pieces’ activity and harmony. Please also note another very
important fact – Black is out of any active pawn play, while White has a clear plan of using his
kingside majority. The principle is: he who doesn’t have a reasonable plan for pawn play is actually in
big trouble.
20...h5
This is solid. Black wants to stop White’s pawn avalanche and is also getting ready to activate the rook
using the 6th rank.
21.Rd3
21...Bg4 22.Rxd8+ Kxd8 23.Nc5 Rh6 24.h3 Bc8 25.Rd1+ Ke8 26.Kf1
The previous moves were natural. The king gets closer to the centre.
783
Position after: 26.Kf1
26...g5
Preventing f4. Now however, the black pawns on the kingside are exposed.
27.Nd3
Preparing Bc1.
784
Position after: 28...Rxf6
Black has somehow activated his pieces, but he is still in trouble. In return, he has exposed his kingside
pawns and, more importantly, his king is under attack!
29.Re1!
Very nice. Capablanca supports his initiative by making threats on the e-file.
29...Be6 30.Bf3!
Black’s pieces are hanging on the e-file. White attacks the h5-pawn while opening the file for the rook.
30...Rh6
30...h4 31.Ne5! and Black is hopeless. There is no reasonable move for him!
785
Position after: 32.Bg4
The rest is simple and the game is over. The technical part of the game was never an issue for the
ingenious Cuban.
34...Kd6 35.Bxe6 Kxe6 36.Bxg5 Ba5 37.Bd2 Kd5 38.h4 Ne5 39.Nxe5 Kxe5 40.h5 c5 41.g4 Kf6
42.Ke2 c4 43.f4 Kf7 44.Kf3 Bd8 45.Ke4 a5 46.Kd5 Be7 47.g5 Kg8 48.f5
Black resigned. A technically brilliant game, perfectly led by Capablanca. It is no wonder his games are
recommended when learning about strategy and realisation! A highly instructive game on the topic of
harmony and supporting the initiative!
1-0
Game 74
Rosselli del Turco – Rubinstein
Baden-Baden 1925
786
Position after: 3.Bc4
3...Nxe4?!
This move is a bit risky. There is more sense in capturing on e4 after 3...Nc6 4.Nf3 Nxe4.
5.Bb3 is another option but 5...Be7, preparing to castle, gives Black comfortable play. [5...Nc6 6.Nb5
g6 7.Qf3 f5 8.Qd5 Qf6 9.Nxc7+ Kd8 10.Nxa8 b6 leads to a wild position with an advantage for
White.]
787
Position after: 7.Bb3
Intending 8.Nd5.
7...Nf5!
Excellent move! Black intends 9...Nd4 himself. Also, the text move allows the pawn setup c6+d5,
which will perfectly restrict the c3-knight and b3-bishop. If 7...c6 then 8.d4 Nf5 9.d5 with a small
space advantage for White.
8.Nf3
788
Position after: 10...Na6!
One idea is to capture the bishop on b3 after 11...Nc5. An even better plan is to transfer the knight to
e6. Black’s knights on e6 and f5 would collaborate perfectly with the pawns on c6 and d5, controlling
the entire centre. Such principles of harmony and central strategy were a trademark of the great
Rubinstein.
11.d4 h5!?
12.Ne2!
White feels a lack of harmony in his camp and desperately goes for exchanging material. Maybe he
wanted to simplify the position and offer a draw to his great opponent?! Alas, that is a questionable
approach if your opponent is an endgame and strategy wizard.
789
Position after: 14.Ng3?!
16.Bd2?
Big mistake.
16.Bc2 was normal.
16...Bf5!
790
Position after: 16...Bf5!
17.Re3
17...Kd7 18.Rc1
...surprisingly he once again changes plan! It is clear that 16.Bd2 was a bad move, so now White wants
to spend more time to exchange the perfect bishop on f5. So much time wasted, so many unfinished
plans – this gives Rubinstein a signal for action!
791
Position after: 20...Rae8!
Black is clearly better. He has more active pieces, full harmony and a space advantage. Also, he has the
more flexible pawn structure, giving him promising possibilities on both flanks. However, before any
active pawn moves, all pieces must be placed on the best squares!
792
Position after: 25.Re1
A key moment in the game. With all pieces perfectly placed, it is time for pawn action! But where?
25...c5!
An absolutely amazing and shocking move! Indeed, it is usually bad to have isolated pawns in the
endgame. However, there is something more important. After exchanging pawns, White cannot
comfortably protect the g3-pawn! Another example of when tactics help after strategical goals have
been achieved.
A) 25...g4 26.Nh2 is not dangerous for White.
B) 25...h4 26.gxh4 g4 27.Nh2 g3 28.Nf1 also gives nothing.
26.dxc5
White cannot allow ...c4. After that, the d2-bishop would be even more restricted. Black would have
more space and excellent prospects on the queenside.
26...Bxc5 27.Kf1™
793
Position after: 27.Kf1™
29...Bxd4!
794
The best continuation. In the endgame, the knight will dominate over the bishop.
33...Nh4 34.g3
34.Kf1 Ke6 is a funny position: White has no moves to play and Black just wants to bring his king
over. 35.g3 What else? The position was almost a zugzwang. 35...Nf3 36.Rg2 Rh1+ 37.Ke2 Kf5–+
795
Position after: 37...Kf5–+
34...Nf5
A knight on f3 is only visually strong. From f5, it attacks both the d4- and g3-pawns. Once again White
cannot move a muscle!
White can only wait while Black patiently improves his position.
In the next stage of the game, Rubinstein demonstrates one of the most important endgame principles:
“Do not rush!”. Well, if the opponent is lacking any real counterplay and is forced to stay passive, it is
very useful to patiently improve your position, switching playing fronts and perhaps waiting for a
mistake by your opponent. Generally, patient play includes only piece moves – pawn action will take
over if patient play does not result in a win.
796
Position after: 42...Rh7
43.Ba5 Rh8 44.Bb4 Rc8 45.Ba5 Ng5 46.Bd2 Ne4 47.Ba5 Kg6 48.Bb4 f5!
Patient play did not lead to progress and Black wants to find the right moment for ...f4.
49.Ba5 Rh8 50.Ke3 Re8 51.Kd3 Rc8 52.Bb4 Rc7 53.Ba5 Rh7 54.Ke3 Re7 55.Kd3
797
Position after: 55.Kd3
55...f4!
White did not make any mistakes and Black decides to go for direct play.
Once again, direct play! Of course, the knight is optically much stronger than the bishop, but after this
exchange Black easily converts his positional advantage into a full point.
58.Kxd2 Rh3
798
Position after: 58...Rh3
59.f3
What else?
799
Position after: 64...Re4
800
Game 75
Jacimovic – Jakovljevic
Tivat 1995
1.d4 Nf6 2.c4 g6 3.Nc3 Bg7 4.e4 d6 5.Nf3 0-0 6.Be2 e5 7.0-0 Nc6 8.d5 Ne7
Mar del Plata, or the Gligoric variation, was played. Both sides are ready to advance pawns in
accordance with their pawn chains, but...
...there is a surprise. White wants to block the position on the kingside, which would leave the opponent
without active play. Black must play very accurately.
11...f4
12.h4
801
Position after: 12.h4
White gets ready to close the position on the kingside in case of any advance.
12...h6
13.Rf2
Securing the kingside and preparing the potential doubling of rooks on the queenside.
13...Bf6 14.Rh2
802
Position after: 14.Rh2
14...Kg7
Black has an idea to reactivate the e7-knight – it is traditionally one of Black’s problems in the King’s
Indian Defence.
14...c6 was still a very reasonable and solid option.
Black’s manoeuvre achieved something – the white rook and knight are misplaced. Still, Black’s
kingside pieces are cramped.
803
Position after: 18.Bf2
After regrouping, White’s kingside is now safe. Still, White has not yet started queenside activities.
Black goes for a typical approach. His next move makes sure that a lot of material will be exchanged in
case White expands on the queenside.
18...a5 19.Ne1
19...b6
Black definitively goes for a static setup. He will never play ...c6 and wants to be ready against the c5-
advance.
804
Position after: 21.b3
White feels it is not yet time to advance to b4. He wants to prepare it more first. This is a good strategy
because Black lacks space and White can more easily regroup.
21...Qc8 22.Rg2
22...Rf7
23.Rc1 Kh7
805
Position after: 23...Kh7
24.b4
White goes for the advance. He is not afraid of the opponent’s control of the a-file – it will bring
nothing to him.
806
27...Qa8?
A typical positional mistake. He did not want to damage his pawn structure, but he locks out his entire
army after White’s next move. 27...dxc5 was the only move. Black accepts to have an isolated and
weak c7-pawn, but he gets the d6-square for his pieces, especially his knight. He would also get rid of
the bad e7-bishop after White recaptures the c5-pawn.
28.c6!
Of course, White takes the opportunity to paralyse the black pieces. This move simply splits the black
army into two separate parts. Connection between them will be possible only via the c8-square – this
will cause serious disorder. White’s plan is clear. He wants to exchange Black’s active pieces on the
queenside. After that, Black’s cramped pieces on the kingside would be helpless when faced with
White’s infiltration on the queenside. If needed, a sacrifice on c7 or d6 will crush Black’s defence.
807
Position after: 30...Ba6
31.Nc4
31...Bxc4
Without that bishop, Black can only dream of counterplay on the kingside – all sacrifice motifs are now
gone.
32.Bxc4
This bishop will later infiltrate into Black’s camp via the c8-square.
808
Position after: 35.Rb2
38...Ra8
809
39.Ne1?!
39...Nfe8
39...Nxg4?! 40.fxg4 Bxh4 was perhaps the last practical chance for Black, but objectively it’s still
winning for White.
Step-by-step, the white pieces cover more and more squares on the queenside, neutralising the black
queen and rook.
If 44...Ra5 White can bring the knight to the queenside attack with 45.Ne1.
White has definitely done a great job. However, in order to make progress, he must transfer his pieces
810
to the queenside. Temporarily, the f2-bishop and g2-knight must protect the h4-pawn. So, let’s protect
it with the king! It is worth noting that Black cannot do the same and regroup his pieces to the
queenside. It is possible only via the c8-square, which cannot be accessed by the black minor pieces.
White’s advanced c6-pawn split the board in two parts – and Black was unable to establish
communication between them!
48.Kh2
The king is ready to protect the h4-pawn, liberating both the knight and bishop.
811
Position after: 51.Bd3
Very patiently, White neutralises Black’s last active piece by forcing its exchange.
51...Qa4 52.Qc2 Qa3 53.Bc3 Kf8 54.Qb2 Qa7 55.Be1! Qa4 56.Bf2 Kf7 57.Bb5 Qa5 58.Ne1
812
61.Qb7 is useless, White’s queen can do nothing even after getting to c8. Black simply plays 61...Qa2.
The queens get exchanged at last. The rest is simple. White transfers his entire army to the queenside.
68.hxg5 would eliminate the possibility of sacrificing a piece, but would liberate the black pieces after
68...Bxg5! followed by ...h5.
68...Nf6 69.Nb5
813
Position after: 69.Nb5
If Black doesn’t sacrifice now, then it will be impossible to sacrifice after the white bishop comes to a5
or b8.
The c7-pawn is protected, but only temporarily. The white bishop is headed to d7.
814
Position after: 74...Ke7
75.Bf5
There is nothing wrong with 75.Bd7 as after 75...Nf6 76.Bf5 Ne8 77.Bg6 the game is over.
75...Kf7 76.Bd7 Ke7 77.Bxe8 Kxe8 78.Bxc7 Bxc7 79.Nxc7+ Ke7 80.Ne6 g4 81.Ng7
Black resigned. Black made only one obvious mistake, allowing White to advance to c6. Although
Black’s resistance was long-lived, the result of the game was never in doubt. Be careful of long pawn
chains in your games, make sure to have good communication between flanks. In this game, Black
could only transfer pieces from one flank to the other via the c8-square. Unfortunately, his minor pieces
were unable to access this transfer point.
1-0
Game 76
Nimzowitsch – Rubinstein
Dresden 1926
815
Position after: 5.e4
A revolutionary Nimzowitsch novelty. He wasn’t afraid to play with a backward pawn. Some
advantages would be gained, including space and an accelerated development.
5...Nb4
5...Nxc3 6.dxc3!, yes. This move leads to pawn symmetry, but Black will have problems with his
advanced c5-pawn. It causes issues on the b5- and d5-squares, and c4 will be a perfect spot for a white
knight, bishop or king in the endgame (this piece would be safe after advancing a4). Numerous games,
even at the top level, are proof that Black’s position is uncomfortable. [6.bxc3 g6 7.d4 will transpose to
the Grunfeld.]
6.Bc4
816
Position after: 6.Bc4
6...e6
Too passive. But, in 1926, theory on this line did not exist. Rubinstein was a player who always
preferred to avoid risks.
A) 6...Nd3+ was logical. 7.Ke2! Nf4+ [7...Nxc1+ 8.Rxc1 Nc6 9.Bb5 Bd7 10.Bxc6 Bxc6 11.d4 cxd4
12.Qxd4² is slightly better for White.] 8.Kf1 with the idea of 9.d4 with tempo leads to very interesting
lines. Some gambits can be found among them.
B) 6...Be6!? 7.Bxe6 Nd3+ 8.Kf1 fxe6 9.Ng5 leads to a sharp and interesting double-edged position.
817
Position after: 8.d3
The idea is to push d3-d4 one day, preparing it with a3 and Be3.
8...Nd4
Of course, this looks good for White as he gets rid of the backward d3-pawn. In fact, Black was unable
to prevent the advance d4.
8...Be7 9.a3 Na6 10.Be3 e5? leads to an awful position after 11.Bxa6 bxa6 12.Nd5±.
9.Nxd4 cxd4
10.Ne2 a6
11.Ng3 Bd6
818
Position after: 11...Bd6
Black will castle on the next move. Still, that is not enough – Black’s army is mostly undeveloped and
scattered. No harmony whatsoever, while the white pieces are ready to harmoniously attack on the
kingside. The next move is logical and is a starting step in that direction.
Nimzowitsch was very familiar with psychology and knew that Rubinstein would not go for
complications... 13.a3 should perhaps be preferred. 13...Nc6 14.Qg4 leads to an undisputed advantage
for White. [14.e5 is also interesting.]
13...Kh8?!
13...Nc2! 14.Rb1 Qb6 and placing the knight on e3 will give Black some play.
14.Bd2
14...f5
819
Position after: 14...f5
That was Rubinstein’s idea. It looks very logical – the f4-pawn is now blocked and the entire white
army behind it looks passive. Still, Black is behind in development...
A very interesting position, and one of the most fabulous diagrams ever. Black has advanced some
820
pawns and visually has more space. Alas, space without development is nothing. Actually, the gained
space would just cause problems! Advanced pawns cannot be moved back and there are a lot of weak
squares for Black to cover. Look at the squares d5, e6, g5, h5... Look at the a2-g8 diagonal. It is also
important that the white queen controls the important light squares. The rooks will dominate on the e-
file. The d2-bishop awaits its mission. There is practically no harmony in Black’s camp, while White’s
entire army work well together. Well, with the exception of the knight. So... what about the knight? The
scene is set for one of the most beautiful manoeuvres ever played.
18.Nh1!
Chess and its beauty in the purest form. The knight was bad on g3 and it is now on its way to an oasis –
the g5-square.
22...Bc6
23.Qh5
821
White has done a lot to synchronise the activities of his troops, while the black army is still in disarray.
23...g6?!
Black’s point. Opening the 7th rank to protect his king, but new dark-squared weaknesses have arisen.
Black is in big trouble now.
A very interesting and deep idea. White wants to deflect the black bishop from the kingside.
25.Ng5 h6 26.Ne6+ was also good, but White would rather keep attacking potential on the board.
25...Bc5 26.b4
26...Bb6?
27.Qh4?
A strange mistake by Nimzowitsch. But the chess public should be grateful to him – it will lead to a
very beautiful finale. 27.Qe1 was winning on the spot. It also prepares 28.Re7, but the point is that
28...Re8 is impossible.
27...Re8 28.Re5
822
Position after: 28.Re5
28...Nf7
This looks logical, attacking the rook practically forces White to capture the knight...
A) 28...Rxe5? 29.fxe5+– Qxe5 30.Qh6+ Kh8 31.Qf8#
B) 28...Qd7 was best, preparing to reactivate the b6-bishop. White would then require a special effort
to convert the superior position – a big part of the advantage would have been lost.
29.Bxf7!
Actually good news for White. His light-squared bishop is no longer needed – the game will be decided
by occupying the dark-squared weaknesses.
823
Position after: 31...Bxe8
32.Qe1!
32...Bc6
32...h5 would make space for the king but the game is lost anyway after 33.Qe7+ Kh6 34.Qxb7.
33.Qe7+ Kh8
824
Position after: 33...Kh8
There are many ways to win the game, like 34.Ne6 or 34.Nf7. But, Nimzowitsch is consistent. He
wants to include all his pieces in this triumph. The d2-bishop was patiently waiting and now is his time
to shine.
34.b5! Qg7
Black would rather give a piece away. No more comments are needed.
A) 34...Bxb5?! 35.Qf6+ Qg7 36.Qxb6+–
B) 34...axb5 35.Ne6 h5 36.Qf6+ Kh7 37.Bb4+–
825
Position after: 37.Bb4+–
Bringing the last piece into action. Next up is Ng5+ and Bf8+.
35.Qxg7+ Kxg7 36.bxc6 bxc6 37.Nf3 c5 38.Ne5 Bc7 39.Nc4 Kf7 40.g3 Bd8 41.Ba5 Be7 42.Bc7
Ke6 43.Nb6 h6 44.h4 g5 45.h5 g4 46.Be5
Black resigned. A truly magnificent game. Advanced pawns left many weaknesses behind them.
Black’s undeveloped and disorganised troops were unable to reckon with White’s harmonious and
collaborative pieces. A breathtaking manoeuvre by White’s knight was a prelude to the beautiful finish.
1-0
Game 77
Zajic – Petkov
Kragujevac 2015
826
Position after: 4.d3
Both players finish development in “Giuoco piano” style – the bishop on b5 is not a significant
difference.
827
Black offers the exchange of the light-squared bishops in order to free his pieces and transfer the knight
to g6.
11.Bc2
White decides to keep the bishops on the board. The c2-bishop might look passive but it protects the
e4-pawn, making the advance of the d-pawn safer. Also, Black’s d7-bishop is hindering its colleagues.
Both sides patiently finish their development, and White is the first to take action.
A strange move. It is difficult to find the idea behind it. Gaining space without further prospects should
not be considered an idea. White’s reaction is natural and in the spirit of the Ruy Lopez.
17.a4!
Suddenly Black has problems on the a-file. Capturing on d4 gave a tempo to White. White simply
threatens to capture on a7 and then b5, harming Black’s pawn structure on the queenside. This, in turn,
will lead to the loss of harmony in Black’s camp. So, Black decides to capture himself.
A very fine move. Before recapturing on a4, White gains a tempo in order to activate the knight.
828
19...Bd7 20.Bxa4
20...c5?
If the strange 16th move was labelled as such, this one must simply be labelled as a mistake. There is
no reason to invite the knight to the perfect outpost in the “Ruy Lopez” and “Giuoco Piano” – f5. Also,
the d6-pawn will be backward and weak. The effects of Black’s 16th move are now evident. The a6-
and d6-pawns are weak and the rook on a7 is another reminder that Black has done a bad job – his
pieces are without coordination.
21.Ndf5
21.Nc6 was also solid, but White preferred to keep the knight on the board.
21...d5
This was Black’s idea – he wants to radically open the centre and activate his pieces. However, the rest
of the game does not seem to support his ideology.
829
Position after: 24...Qxd5
After a series of exchanges, White is obviously better. In open positions, it is very important to have
more active pieces. Adding a better pawn structure and the turn into the mix – the evaluation is clear.
With his next move, White seizes the initiative.
25.Rd1 Qb3?
26.Rd8+ Kh7
830
Position after: 26...Kh7
27.Nxg7! Rd7
27...Kxg7 28.Nf5+ Kh7 29.Qe3 Ng8 30.Rxg8 Kxg8 31.Qxh6 f6 32.Qxg6+ Kf8 is a very nice winning
variation – the importance of the f5-square is evident. 33.Qxf6+
28.Rxd7 Nxd7
831
29.Qd2?!
Wrong move order. White allows the exchange of the good g7-knight for the bad one on d7.
29.N7f5 with the idea of attacking the h6-pawn was a simpler way to win.
29...Kxg7!
33...Kg8
¹ 33...Qb3 A direct win is no longer on the horizon. White needs more troops – only a queen and
knight cannot bring victory. After 34.f4! Qe6 35.Qxc5 White would be forced to show good technique
and accuracy in order to convert.
832
Position after: 35...Qb8+
36.f4!
36.g3? Qe5! and centralisation would save Black at the last moment.
After a short excursion, the white queen is back to an active position on the kingside.
833
Position after: 41.Ng4
41...h5?
Alas, Black answered with a blunder, although the endgame is winning for White despite technical
difficulties.
42.Qxh5
Black resigned. White convincingly exploited a few imprecise moves Black made in the middlegame,
allowing for the appearance of pawn weaknesses.
1-0
Game 78
Werle – L’Ami
Leeuwarden 2005
1.Nf3 d5 2.d4 c6 3.c4 Nf6 4.Nc3 e6 5.Bg5 dxc4 6.e4 b5 7.e5 h6 8.Bh4 g5 9.Nxg5 hxg5 10.Bxg5
834
Position after: 10.Bxg5
This Slav line is named after the former world champion Mikhail Botvinnik. Thanks to his efforts,
many important resources were found and even today many of his ideas remain very relevant.
10...Nbd7 11.g3
White intends to place the bishop on the longest diagonal and to castle kingside.
835
Position after: 14...Bh6
Black wants to eliminate this bishop, which is protecting the f6-pawn. He is not afraid to weaken his
dark squares as he plans to advance the queenside majority and exchange his bad light-squared bishop.
15.Be3!
A very good move, protecting the d4-pawn and posing an “x-ray” threat to the black queen. The bishop
cannot be taken because the f1-rook would protect f6.
15.h4 would protect the f6-pawn, but the h-file would be opened, compromising White’s king safety.
After 15...Bxg5 16.hxg5 c5 17.d5 b4 the situation is unclear. Black has more than enough
compensation.
15...c5
The situation gets complicated. Black is ready to use the pin on the d-file to activate his queenside
majority and the knight. White needs to be accurate. He managed to find the best response.
15...Nxf6? 16.Qf3! and Black has problems involving the knight and f-pawn.
836
Position after: 19...Qc6
20.Ne4!
Excellent move. White keeps the knight by placing it on by far the most influential square. This
unstable and hanging knight will be a huge strength for White! Relativity makes chess more beautiful.
There will be constant threats of discovered attacks and, more importantly, White gets to keep the
queens on the board. One reason for this decision is that his king is safer. The other is that Black’s more
advanced (and more dangerous!) majority cannot be advanced that easily with queens on the board.
837
Position after: 23.a3
After this move Black cannot activate his majority without opening the a-file. But there are no other
promising options.
Black bravely takes a risk – which was a bad option. The advance should have been kept for later, after
exchanging queens if possible. On the other hand, it is very difficult to find another plan. Moreover,
White’s amazing 27th move was quite unpredictable.
838
Position after: 26...Kb6
27.Qh1!!
A really amazing move. It looks like an answer to some study. Take a look at Black’s centralised pieces
and at White’s surrounded lone knight – like a white pigeon among black falcons. Other white pieces
are on the rim, and the queen just joined them! Still, White’s move is the best! That is chess in all its
beauty. There is no chess principle that is always valid. So, why that move? As we have seen, the black
king is without a pawn shield and the a1-rook could pose problems. Naturally, White should find a plan
to transfer the queen to queenside. The queen should be transferred to a2 via b1! By transferring the
queen to one corner via another, White actually achieves harmony. The queen both protects the knight
and attacks the black king!
27...Ra5
839
Position after: 29.f3
After exchanging a couple of rooks, White doesn’t need to keep the 2nd rank closed. The knight gets
protection and the queen is ready for action.
31.Qg1
31...Qb6 32.Kg2!
840
Position after: 32.Kg2!
Black has no good moves. White patiently brings his king closer to the centre and anticipates the check
on f4 after launching the g-pawn.
32...Rd3
What else?
33.Qxb6+
33...Kxb6 34.g4 Bf4 35.g5 c3 36.bxc3 bxc3 37.Rc2 Bd2 38.Kf2 Kb5 39.h5
Black resigns. White’s pawns are much faster. Readers can analyse the possible continuations
themselves, if they wish. A very instructive game with a remarkable manoeuvre Qh1-Qb1-Qa2,
showing chess beauty in all its glory.
1-0
841
Chapter 7
The Initiative
Finishing development is a prerequisite for going for the initiative. Or, at the very least, better
development than your opponent. Playing actively is not the same as having the initiative. It is just a
prelude to seizing the initiative. The initiative is not synonymous to an attack either. It simply means
that we lead the play and the opponent must take care of our activities and threats. Generally speaking,
development leads to the initiative and the initiative leads to an attack. Throughout this process, it is of
the utmost importance to be aware of the opponent’s counter-chances.
When dealing with the initiative, psychology has a greater influence than usual. It is very important to
intuitively “feel” the moment for attack, or counter-attack, and manage to predict the opponent’s
reaction. Practice serves an important role in learning to manage the initiative, along with analysing
games of great legends of the past such as Alekhine, Tal or Fischer.
Game 79
Tkachiev – Mikhalevski
Ohrid 2001
6.Qa4+!?
6.Nf3 Nc6 would lead to a typical Rubinstein variation. White wants to benefit from the light-squared
diagonal before the g1-knight closes it.
842
6...Qd7
6...Bd7!? 7.Qb3 Nc6 8.Qxb7 Nd4 leads to a sharp and double-edged position.
7.Nf3
White wants to exploit the fact that the black queen blocks her other pieces and to prepare the move d4.
It looks like White will develop his troops more rapidly, so it is natural to open the position. 7.Qxd7+
Nxd7 8.Nf3 e5 is primitive and not that aggressive.
7...Qxa4?!
This move liberates the queenside pieces but accelerates White’s initiative in the centre. As a result,
Black will suffer right until the end of the game.
7...Nc6 8.0-0 e5 is more normal, although both queens are developed on strange squares.
8.Nxa4 Nd7
843
Position after: 11.Kd1!
this odd move is very strong and Na4xc5 is the immediate threat. 11...a5 12.Nb6 Rb8 13.Nxc8 Rxc8
14.Ne5 Rb8 15.Nc4 with a much better position for White.
9.d4!
Simple and strong. White exploits the pressure on b7 and fights for the initiative. Also, very soon it will
844
become clear that White will be the first to control the open files. In open positions, rooks on open files
supported by a fianchettoed bishop can be devastatingly strong. Actually, all the white pieces will soon
be better placed than Black’s. Black is in big trouble after only 9 moves, without making even one
obvious mistake. That is the beauty of chess, the relativity of principles.
9...cxd4 10.Nxd4 e5
What else? Black wants to gain a tempo to finish development as soon as possible.
This is the fastest way to finish development – activating the rooks. When seeking for the initiative,
every tempo is important.
13...Nb6
This brave move could lead to the damaging of the pawn structure, but the open a-file would
compensate for that. The idea is to reduce the pressure by exchanging one of White’s menacing
knights. Alas, Black missed a dangerous response after which White increases his advantage.
A) 13...0-0 was better, although White’s advantage remains undisputed after 14.Rhc1 Ne6 15.Nac5 [Or
15.Na5].
B) 13...Ke7 happened in one of my games 17 years later. My opponent improved on Black’s play, but
after 14.Rhc1! Ne6 15.Na5 [15.Nc3 is also very good.] 15...Rb8 16.Nc3 White kept a stable advantage.
14.Rhc1! Ne6
845
A) 14...Nxa4?! 15.Rxc7 is winning.
B) 14...Na6 would transpose later on.
15.Nac5 Rb8
16.Na5!
Excellent. Forcing Black to take first, accelerating White’s development. This stage of the game is very
instructive, even for advanced players.
White has completed development, becoming the master of the queenside. Black is hopeless.
Everything is going smoothly and White should convert his big advantage.
18...0-0 19.Rc7
19...Be6
846
Position after: 19...Be6
20.b3!
A great, simple move. The pawn restricts the activity of Black’s minor pieces.
After some exchanges, the situation is stable. White has a winning position: an extra pawn, a big
847
positional advantage and the white pieces are more active. White fully activates his rook.
An excellent decision. Once again, we see the “Do not rush” principle in action. Black’s knight is out
of play and the e5-pawn is blocked – Black’s rook remains passive.
28...Nd7 29.Nb7
Now is the moment to remember Tartakower’s quote “All rook endgames are drawish!” Indeed, why
exchange an active knight for a passive one?
31...Rd7 32.Ra6+–
32.Nxa7
848
Position after: 32.Nxa7
After some fine manoeuvring, White has collected another pawn. There are still some technical issues
which were perfectly solved by Tkachiev.
34.b4 was also natural and perhaps even better. Choosing a plan and the move order is a matter of style.
34...Ng5 35.Nc6
849
Position after: 35.Nc6
White returns the pawn, but the game is simplified. The win is trivial.
39...e4 40.Nd6++–
41...Kd5
41...Nb4 42.Kc3+–
42.Nd3
42...Kd4 43.a5 Nc3 44.Nc5! Nb1+ 45.Kc1 Nc3 46.Ne6+ Ke3 47.Nc7 Ne2+ 48.Kb2 Nd4 49.a6 Nc6
50.b4
After doing his best to postpone defeat, Black finally resigned. Indeed, that was an amazing game.
Unfortunately, it did not find its place in many books – though that fact helped me win my game easily.
The opponent, after being shocked by White’s 6th move, started spending too much time and finally,
after a long resistance, could not keep his position together in zeitnot. That is another thing worth
remembering: also analyse games that are not frequently published – this may lead you to some easy
850
victories in the future.
1-0
Game 80
Fine – Alekhine
Netherlands 1938
Alekhine chooses one of his favourite setups against the Ruy Lopez. It looks flexible, but actually the
bishop on g7 very often remains closed in or strongly restricted by the c3-pawn.
I like this move. White simply keeps the advantage due to more space or better harmony, depending on
Black’s next move.
8...Nxe5
Black wants to exchange material. 8...dxe5 would lead to a position where Black may soon be
frustrated – the c6-knight and g7-bishop are badly placed.
851
Position after: 10.f4!
Very inventive play by Fine. Before Black finishes development of the kingside, White opens the f-file.
Very often, energetic play is needed in order to seize the initiative when having better development.
Alekhine was probably unsettled by Fine’s suggestive and direct play. Alekhine was known as a great
attacking player, and only seldom was he attacked first. In such moments, opponents could have their
chance against the great champion. This game is a perfect example. The text move is bad – the f7-pawn
is now hanging and Fine seizes the opportunity.
11...b5 was better. Although after 12.Qb3 Black is clearly behind in development, which should result
in problems very soon. White has threats both on the f-file and probably even the a-file (after the move
a4). If 12...exf4 then 13.Bxf4 must be in White’s favour.
12.Qxd7+ Kxd7
852
Position after: 12...Kxd7
13.fxe5
853
Position after: 14...Rf8
15.Nd2! Bxe5
16.Nb3
16...Bxf4 17.Rxf4 b6
It looks like Black has consolidated his position. However, White’s next move proves that the initiative
is still alive and well.
18.a4!
Excellent. Using the fact that the black troops are on the kingside, White attacks on the queenside!
18.Nd4+ Kd7 [18...Ke5 19.g3 followed by Raf1 is obviously bad for Black.] 19.a4 with the same idea
as in the game is also solid for White.
18...Ke5?!
18...Nf6 19.Nd4+ Ke5 20.g3 with the threats of Nc6 and Raf1 is better for White.
854
19.g3
19...Nf6
20.Nd2
20...Nh5
20...Ke6 21.a5 b5 22.Nb3 Nd7 23.Nd4+ Ke7 24.Nc6+ Ke6 25.Nb4 is a forced line showing that
White has various possibilities on the queenside for his knight.
21.Rf2!
855
Position after: 21.Rf2!
21...Ke6
If Black tries to eliminate the threats on the f-file with 21...f6 then 22.a5 leaves Black’s queenside in
ruins. 22...b5 23.Nf3+
23...Ke6 [23...Kxe4 24.Rd1 Rd8 25.Nd4+–; 23...Kd6 24.Rd1+ Kc6 25.Nd4+ Kb7 26.Ne6+–]
24.Nd4+ Kf7 [24...Kd7 25.Nb3 Kc6 26.Raf1+–] 25.Raf1 are just a few lines proving that Black is
856
hopeless.
22.a5 Ra8
23.Raf1
23...Rhd8
Black managed to somehow protect the queenside, but the danger is now on the kingside. This is a
perfect illustration: better development, better communication lines and play against two or more
weaknesses allows for the conquering of one of them.
23...Rhf8 also loses after 24.g4 Ng7 25.axb6 cxb6 26.Rf6++–.
24.Nf3 Ke7
857
Position after: 26.Ng5
28.Nf3 g5 29.Nd4
This knight has performed miracles in this game. Fittingly, his majestic role decides the game.
858
Position after: 31.Rff7
Look at Black’s army. All the pieces are terribly placed. The king is the most active piece and faces
mating threats. Black must exchange material, leading to further material loss.
35...g4 36.Rg6
859
Position after: 36.Rg6
36...Nd7
39...Rd8 40.Nf3 Nd3 41.Rd5+ Ke7 42.Rxd8 Kxd8 43.b3 Ke7 44.Nd2 a5 45.Kf1 b5 46.Ke2 1-0
One imprecise move was enough to ignite Fine’s fine attack. He seized the initiative at the right
moment and maintained it until the end of the game. Very instructive play against several weaknesses.
The reader may wish to analyse lines himself (without the engine!) that were not presented here.
Game 81
Zlatanovic – Djuric
Lipnicki Sor 2008
The line chosen by White doesn’t pose many problems to Black. Still, some accuracy is needed.
3...d4
860
This move forces play. 3...Nf6 is the most common reply.
7...Bc5?
7...d3!? 8.Ned4 should be in White’s favour, although the position would be double-edged.
8.b4!
10.Qxa5 Bxa5
861
Position after: 10...Bxa5
11.Nb5
The point is the d6-square. This knight will perfectly collaborate with the bishop that will soon be
arriving on a3. 11.Nxc6 looks promising 11...bxc6 12.Ba3 Nf6 13.Bd3 followed by Ke2 and activating
the rooks looks much better for White. However, the text move also gives White a strong initiative.
11...a6?
Definitely bad. There is no reason to force the knight to the d6-square. If you cannot prevent a good
move, don’t force your opponent to make it – play some useful moves instead!
862
Position after: 14.Ng5
Often it is required to support the initiative with unusual measures. White’s minor pieces are knitting
some kind of net around the black king. Meanwhile, Black faces big problems with finishing
development.
14...Nd8
16.Bd3 keeping the king in the centre was also very good, but White did not want to block the d-pawn.
863
Position after: 18.Nf3
The knight has done its job by causing disharmony in Black’s camp. It goes back to recover before the
upcoming events.
18...Nf7 19.Nb7!
Not only played with the idea to gain a tempo before advancing d4 but it is also good to keep pieces on
the board when you have a space and development advantage.
20...Rc8 can be chosen with the same idea of exchanging material. Although, after 21.Nd2!
864
Position after: 21.Nd2!
The player with the initiative must play aggressively, or it may disappear. The d5-pawn restricts the d8-
knight and d7-bishop. The d4-square is also vacated for the f3-knight.
865
22...Kf7
Capturing will just boost White’s initiative. 22...exd5 23.exd5 and Black is unable to prevent the
infiltration on the e6-square.
23.Rfd1
23.Bd1 was another good possibility. The idea, of course, is to place the bishop on b3 and support
pressure on the e6-square. The number of promising options for White is a testament to just how bad
Black’s position is.
23...e5
This move blocks the position and slows White’s attack but, on the other hand, a strong protected
passed pawn has appeared. White has lost some aggression, but gained a long-lasting advantage which
is enough to guarantee the win.
24.Ne1 h5
Preventing a potential Bg4 after capturing on d7, though White is not obliged to capture the bishop.
Black’s other bishop is more valuable as it covers many weak squares on the queenside. The knight is
perfectly placed on c5 and White regroups patiently behind it.
The pawn setup in the centre suggests that White should exchange the light-squared bishops. In fact,
866
this would help Black reduce the pressure. The text move is much better, White gains a tempo and the
black pieces remain clustered.
White patiently puts all his pieces on their best squares. It is time to double the rooks.
28...Nb7 29.Nb3
White sees the variation with infiltration along the c-file and so he now goes for exchanges.
31...Bxa5 32.Nc5
867
Position after: 32.Nc5
32...Nf4
A) 32...Bc8? 33.Nb3+–
B) 32...Be8 33.Nb3 Bb6 34.Rc8±
33.Nxd7
33...Rxd7 34.Rc6
Black has an unpleasant choice: to capture the e2-bishop and continue playing with a worse bishop, or
to play against a dangerous bishop pair. White also has much better pieces and pawn structure, and
even a safer king. The position is almost won for White.
868
Position after: 35...Ng6
36.Bd1
36.f4! was winning immediately. 36...Ne7 [36...exf4 37.Bxh5 Rh8 38.e5!] 37.fxe5 fxe5 [37...Nxc6
38.e6+] 38.Re6+– White missed this because he was focused on the queenside – all White pieces target
the queenside and it was unexpected that a blow was possible on the kingside. White instead transfers
the e2-bishop to a more important diagonal, a2-g8. This also wins easily.
36...Ne7 37.Bb3
Black’s king must escape – the white bishops are too dangerous.
37...Kg6 38.Re6 b4
869
Position after: 38...b4
One bishop is shut off, but the other will inherit an amazing diagonal (Ba4).
39.Bb2 Bc7?!
870
Position after: 41...Rxd7
Further resistance was redundant, as are comments. With a few trivial tactical shots, White easily
converts the advantage.
42.Rxc7 Rxc7 43.d6 Rc6 44.d7 Rxe6 45.d8=Q Kf7 46.Bc1 Rc6 47.Bd2 Rc2 48.Bxb4 Nc6 49.Qd5+
Kg6 50.Bc5 Na5 51.f4 Nc4 52.f5+ Kh7 53.Ke1 Nb2 54.Bf8 Rc1+ 55.Ke2 Rc2+ 56.Kf3 Nc4 57.Qf7
Nd2+ 58.Ke3 Nf1+ 59.Kd3 Rd2+ 60.Kc3
Black finally resigned. An instructive game on the topic of seizing and maintaining the initiative.
1-0
Game 82
Zlatanovic – Lekic
Smederevska Palanka 2016
Transposing, the game switched to the Pirc Defence. On his 4th move, White chose the most aggressive
continuation. But now, instead of playing the main line 5.Nf3, he preferred the immediate advance of
the e-pawn. This move has not yet been analysed too deeply and gives White very promising positions,
in my opinion. The game was played in a rapid event. In such events, it is good to go for rare lines that
you are familiar with.
871
Position after: 8.Nd5!?
8...Kd8
8...Nf2+? 9.Ke1 c6 [9...Nxh1 10.Nxc7+ Kd8 11.Nxa8 is almost winning for White.] 10.Nc7+ Kd8
11.Nxa8 Nxh1 12.Be3! is very bad for Black.
9.Ke1 Nc6
9...c6 gives White two options. 10.Ne3 [10.Nc3 can be played with the idea to exclude the black knight
from play after h3 and g4.] 10...Nxe3 11.Bxe3 leads to a slightly better position for White.
872
Position after: 9...Nc6
10.c3
This move was played instinctively. The c3-pawn keeps the c6-knight under control and is also useful
against the g7-bishop, which will be released at some point after ...f6. 10.Nf3 is probably a better
option.
13...Bxf6 is possible, but Black will need time to get rid of the isolated e7-pawn.
873
Position after: 15...Kf7
Both sides put their kings on the safest squares and soon the rooks will also be involved. Black will
need time to activate the g7-bishop – the f6-pawn cannot move due to the check on g5. It is White’s
turn and he decides to combine finishing development with creating positional threats.
16.Bb5
A logical move. Damaging Black’s queenside pawn structure could benefit White.
16...Bd5
17.Rhd1 Ne7
874
Position after: 17...Ne7
The knight returns to protect the bishop. It looks like 16.Bb5 missed its mark. However, White is still
able to use the bishop.
18.c4 Be6
18...a6 19.cxd5 axb5 20.d6 would evidently be very risky for Black.
19.Bd7!
The point! Very often, the initiative can only be supported with drastic measures. White wants to
eliminate the e6-bishop, which controls the d7-square. Also, capturing on e6 with a check would give
White tempi to activate the knight via the route f3-d4-b5.
19...Nc6
875
Position after: 19...Nc6
Perhaps a key moment in the game. Black is ready to play with doubled pawns, but White has other
plans.
20.f5!
With this positional sacrifice, White secures a lasting initiative. The f5-pawn should fall eventually and
White will use the f5-square himself.
A) 20.Bxc6 bxc6 21.Nd4 Bd7 gives nothing to White. 22.Nb5?
876
Position after: 22.Nb5?
20...gxf5
That is the point. Neither the king nor the knight can move due to the loss of the f5-pawn. Running out
of good moves, Black decided to allow it anyway.
22...Ne5
22...Rhd8 23.Rad1 and it is difficult to suggest a normal plan to Black. Meanwhile, White has
resources: Bf4 with capturing on d8 followed by Nd4, or even Nh4.
877
Position after: 24.Nxf5
24...Rhd8
A) 24...Nxc4 25.Rc1!+–
B) 24...c6 25.Rd4 with ideas of Nd6 and Bf4.
878
Position after: 28.Rxc7+
28...Kg6 [28...Ke6 29.Nxg7+ Kd6 30.Rxb7 gives White a winning position.] 29.Nh4+! Kh5 30.Rxg7
Kxh4 31.Rxh7+ Kg5 32.Kxe3 and Black’s position looks lost.
27.b3
The situation has stabilised. White has managed to harm Black’s pawn structure and install a knight on
f5. However, Black’s forces are centralised. White’s next task is to secure the position of the knight on
f5 and, if possible, to eliminate the e5-knight.
31.g4
879
Position after: 31.g4
31...b6?
The check on c5 will actually give nothing to Black, so this move is simply bad. 31...h5 was needed in
order to undermine the position of the f5-knight. 32.Rd7 hxg4 33.hxg4 Rc8 [33...Kg5 34.Rxc7 Kxg4
35.Ne3+ Kf4 36.Nd5+ and Black is in trouble.] 34.Kf3 looks passive for Black, but nothing direct is
apparent.
32.Ng3
White prevents ...h5 and is ready to place the knight on the more dominant e4-square. It was necessary
to calculate that Black’s counterplay is not dangerous and is only of temporary character.
880
Position after: 34.h4!
White’s majority is launched. Black’s king will be driven back and the knight will be placed on f5
again.
34...c6?!
This forces White to place the rook on an even better square, but Black’s position was bad anyway.
34...e3 35.Rd7 Rf8 36.Ne4 with great winning chances.
35.Rf5 e3 36.g5!
881
Position after: 36.g5!
With the idea to create mating threats after Rf6 and Nf5.
White stops the e-pawn and starts thinking about a mate on e8.
882
Position after: 42...Rd8
The rest is simple. Capturing the c-pawn was also easily winning.
43.Nxe3 a4 44.Nf5 axb3 45.axb3 Ra8 46.Rxc6 Kg8 47.Rc7 Re8+ 48.Kf3 Ra8 49.Nh6+ Kf8 50.g7+
1-0
883
Game 83
Spassky – Kavalek
Montreal 1979
1.d4 Nf6 2.c4 d6 3.Nc3 Nbd7 4.e4 e5 5.d5 Be7 6.Nf3 0-0 7.Be2 Nc5 8.Qc2 a5
Kavalek chose a sort of Indian Defence. Spassky decides to close the centre immediately. Traditionally,
there is a small and stable advantage for White – he has more space and more possibilities, even
regarding castling. On the other hand, Black’s position looks solid and without weaknesses. With his
last move, Black attempts to secure the good position of the c5-knight. So, White’s next move is also
logical...
9.Be3 b6 10.h3
Preventing 10...Ng4.
10...h6
884
Position after: 10...h6
We have arrived at a very important crossroads for White. He can castle short side, followed by patient
organisation and expansion on the queenside. Or, as was played, he can castle long, with an ensuing
expansion on the kingside. Spassky chose the more inventive and more forceful continuation. We have
to admit that his king will be absolutely safe on the queenside – by advancing his b-pawn, Black lost
the possibility to easily open the position on the queenside with ...c6.
11.0-0-0 Nh7
A flexible and very solid manoeuvre. Black wants to exchange dark-squared bishops when the time is
right.
12.g4
Yes, it creates a hole on f4 but it also prevents 12...f5. White is ready to launch a pawn attack directly,
aimed at the enemy’s king.
12...Ng5 13.Nd2
885
Position after: 13.Nd2
Not only keeping pieces on the board due to a space advantage, it also prevents the exchange of the
dark-squared bishops. Black must spend more time in order to achieve that.
After some psychological games, Spassky decides to allow the exchange. The knight will be more
useful on e3, which will be vacated after exchanging bishops.
886
Position after: 18.Nxe3
18...g6?!
A very interesting idea. Black creates a kind of “Hedgehog” setup, in Petrosian style. He will now be
able to block the position on the kingside, regardless of which white pawn advances. On the other hand,
the move does create some dark-squared weaknesses.
18...Qf6, with control over the f4-square, was a logical move.
19.Rdf1?!
Actually not a dangerous move. It will be very risky for White to advance the f-pawn and open the file,
because Black would gain the perfect outpost for his knight on e5. During the next moves, both players
patiently regroup, gently improving their positions.
19...Bd7 20.Kb1 Qe7 21.f3 Kg7 22.Rf2 Nf6 23.Qd2 Rae8 24.Bd1 Nh7 25.Bc2
887
Position after: 25.Bc2
Even the bishop’s position is improved, the point will soon be clear.
25...Rb8 26.Nb5?!
It looks bad for Black to capture that knight, but in fact the consequences remain uncertain. Anyway,
the pressure on c7 is not fatal for Black, and the knight will end up returning to c3.
888
Position after: 27...Rh8
When commenting the game for the tournament magazine, the legendary David Bronstein suggested
that Black should organise an escape for his king, transferring it to the queenside. There is a dose of
truth in this but in the game, with tension and deep calculation, it is very difficult to reach such a
decision.
29...h5
30.Nf5+!
This resource was perhaps overlooked by Kavalek. Though, to be fair, it was not something he could
have prevented. The game suddenly becomes complicated and very interesting, and it is almost forced.
32...e4!?
889
A very inventive defence. Black temporarily closes the diagonal of the c2-bishop and gets an outpost
on e5.
Again, a very interesting and solid solution. Black is ready to play with less material, but his pieces are
active.
35...Bg4 still looks more precise – g4 is definitely the bishop’s spot, closing the g-file, so that move
should have been played immediately.
36.gxh7 Bg4
890
Position after: 36...Bg4
The situation has changed dramatically. Spassky once again demonstrates his top class by perfectly
understanding this. Black is now behind in terms of material, but with the initiative on the kingside.
Spassky immediately goes for the counter. He attacks on the queenside. In fact, this will eventually
result in a breakthrough in the centre!
37.a3! Rcf8
A) 37...a4 can lead to the loss of this pawn. White could continue 38.Rf2 Rxf2 [38...Rcf8 39.Rxf4 Rxf4
40.Nxc7] 39.Qxf2 Nxe4 40.Qf7 with a probably winning position.
B) 37...Nxe4 leads to collapse after the very fine 38.Qc1, keeping an eye on the f4-rook and with the
idea to create a pin on the e-file. After 38...Nc5 39.Re1 Qf6 40.Nxc7, White wins.
38.Qd4
38.Nxc7 was also logical and probably better. Spassky was afraid of Black’s active pieces and
transferred the game into an endgame with a solid advantage
38...R8f7
Protecting the e4-pawn and securing the advance of the b-pawn. After his excursion, the knight returns
to c3 at the right moment.
891
Position after: 40.Nc3
Black cannot oppose White’s queenside expansion and must try to find counterplay on the kingside.
…d6
892
Targeting the h4-pawn. White must act quickly!
45.b4 axb4 46.axb4 Ng6 47.Rh2 Kg7 48.c5 bxc5 49.bxc5 Kf8 50.Ba4 Rf6 51.Kb3
Again, the situation has changed. With his ingenious 37th move, White managed to increase his
advantage. In the process of activating pieces, the king should not be forgotten.
53...Rf7
53...Nxh4
893
Position after: 53...Nxh4
54.d6+! cxd6 55.Nd5+ Ke6 56.Rb7 dxc5 57.Be8 with an upcoming mate would be an even more
beautiful end to the game.
55...Kf8
894
55...Kxd6 56.Rb6++–
56.Rd2
56.Rb8+ Kg7 57.Be8 Ra7 58.Nb5 is another winning method – a matter of style.
Black resigned. Let’s summarise with one of Bronstein’s comments that the game was perfectly led by
both players.
1-0
Game 84
Alekhine – Teichmann
Berlin 1921
Teichmann was one of the greatest fighters ever. He was never afraid of that era’s elite. This game, full
of shots and fine tactics, is proof.
895
All this is well-known. Teichmann chooses a more active and forcing continuation.
11...Bg4
12.Nxe4 dxe4
13.Qd5
An improvement that Alekhine had in mind. It is unpleasant for Black, but he should be OK with
precise play.
13.Bd5 Nxe5 [13...exf3 14.Bxc6 fxg2 15.Qxg4 gxf1=Q+ 16.Rxf1 Rb8 17.Rd1 Qc8 18.Rd7 gives White
more than enough compensation for the material.] 14.Bxe4 Nxf3+ 15.Bxf3 Qxd1 16.Bxd1 leads to an
equal endgame.
13...Qxd5
Analysing the game, Kasparov later suggested that after 13...exf3 14.Qxc6 fxg2 15.Qxg2
896
Position after: 15.Qxg2
897
Position after: 16...Rad8
After a series of exchanges, White should be better due to the better mobility of his pieces. Many
pawns are exposed: a6, b5, e5... Inventive and active play is needed. Other players may fail to
understand this, but not Alekhine. This is one of his most concrete games – every move carries some
kind of threat...
17.a4!
White strikes first. Due to the ultimate activity of the c6-bishop, Black cannot activate the rooks
properly and White doesn’t waste time by going for a direct attack. However, Black’s reaction is also
classy...
17...f6!
17...b4 would keep the a-file closed, but the pawn structure would be ruined after 18.cxb4 Bxb4
19.Rac1 and White is better.
18.axb5
Suddenly the white king will be in trouble if White captures on f6. 18.exf6? Rxf6 with the idea of ...Rg6
is unpleasant.
Keeping the king far from the centre and removing the bishop from the b-file, rendering the move
898
...Rb8 useless.
White collected Black’s exposed pawns on the queenside but lost the e5 pawn at the same time – all the
weak pawns are gone. However, new ones have appeared: c7, e5, f3. With his last move, White
attacked the e5-pawn and is ready to play Bc5 at some point, securing that spot for the rook. But it is
Black’s turn and he immediately notes that White also has weaknesses. Very typical of Teichmann –
the first unforced move must be an active one!
22...Rd1! 23.Bd5!
An exclamation mark is given because this is the only chance for White to play for a win. The idea,
even should it not be enough to win the game, is still grandiose. Not many players would find this
possibility – Alekhine found one of the most beautiful ideas ever.
A) 23.Rxd1 Bxf3+ 24.Kg1 Bxd1 25.Rxe5 Bd6 would not satisfy White – Alekhine definitely wanted
more than a draw.
B) 23.Rxe5 Rxf1 24.Kxf1 Rxf3+ 25.Kg2 Bd6 is also drawish.
899
Position after: 26...Rf8
27.Kd3!
A miracle! What is the point? The point is that the e5-pawn just blocks the black bishop, causing a
mess in Black’s camp.
The rest of the game confirms Alekhine’s idea. White simply wants to place the king on e4 and, after
establishing control over the entire centre, to advance his queenside pawns. It is important, by the way,
that the white bishop is dark-coloured, so that the endgame with the bishop and h-pawn is winning –
Black cannot just sacrifice his bishop to eliminate White’s queenside pawns.
27.Rxe5 Bd6 28.Rh5 g6 with centralisation of the black king would give Black an easy draw.
27...Kg8?!
27...e4+ was better, although White benefits by capturing the pawn back while centralising the king.
After 28.Kxe4 Bd6 29.h3 White is better, but Black is probably able to hold without much difficulty.
28.Ke4
900
Position after: 28.Ke4
28...Rb8?
A bad move. Black cannot stop the white pawns by keeping the rook in front of them. White’s
centralised army easily supports the pawn majority.
It was better to continue the king’s centralisation: 28...Kf7!.
Everything is going smoothly. Evidently Black’s counterplay on the kingside is slow and Black must
take care of the queenside.
31...Kd7 32.Ra7
901
Position after: 32.Ra7
32...Bd6?
33.Kd5
White could also win with 33.b6, profiting from the pin.
33...e4 34.b6!
902
Position after: 34.b6!
Black resigned. White inevitably advances the pawn to the 7th rank, with an easy win. One of the most
beautiful games I have ever seen. It was truly fascinating, full of tactics in order to achieve strategical
goals. You will not often see such a dynamic and beautiful game. Both players deserve applause.
1-0
Game 85
Kasparov – Kramnik
Astana 2001
1.e4 e5 2.Nf3 Nc6 3.Bb5 Nf6 4.0-0 Nxe4 5.d4 Nd6 6.Bxc6 dxc6 7.dxe5 Nf5 8.Qxd8+ Kxd8 9.Nc3
903
Position after: 9.Nc3
The Berlin variation. One year prior, it helped Kramnik dethrone Kasparov in their famous match that
Kramnik won 8.5 : 6.5. Kasparov couldn’t pose serious problems in the Ruy Lopez and a few games
later he switched to the English. After losing the title, he was probably keen to prove himself again in
the Berlin. In this game, he presented his artillery: persistent pressure, direct play in search for the
initiative, active play when having the initiative...
9...h6
904
Position after: 13.Rad1
In this game, Kasparov goes for rapid activation and the centralisation of all his troops. He hopes to
create problems for the black king.
13...Ne7
One of the possible manoeuvres in this line. The knight goes to a safer spot on g6, vacating the f5-
square for the bishop. Generally, the idea is to patiently exchange pieces in order to reach a comfortable
ending.
14.Rfe1 Ng6
15.Ne4
905
Position after: 15.Ne4
15...Nf4?
Black naturally wants to place the knight on the blockading e6-square. This is too slow, the third move
in a row for the knight. Moreover, it just so happened that Kasparov was in great shape.
15...Bf5 with the intention of reducing White’s attacking resources by exchanging some pieces was
better.
16.e6!!
Excellent move, and practically the only chance to support the initiative. White must not allow the
blockade on e6, which would also block the pieces behind the e5-pawn. Another reason is, of course,
the opening of the e-file – Black’s king is in big trouble.
16...Nxe6
906
Position after: 16...Nxe6
17.Nd4
17...c5 18.Nf5
907
Position after: 18.Nf5
18...Rh7
18...Rg8? 19.Nxh6!+–
19.Bf6
19...Rc8
20.Bxg7!?
Once again, according to Kasparov it was better to launch the f-pawn with 20.f4! Bc6 21.Nfg3 with the
deadly threat of advancing f5.
20...Bxg7 21.Nxg7+ Rxg7 22.Nf6+ Ke7 23.Nxd7 Rd8 24.Ne5 Rxd1 25.Rxd1 Nf4
908
Position after: 25...Nf4
After a series of forced moves, we have reached a fairly simple endgame. Due to Black’s doubled
pawns, White is practically a pawn up, but Black has some initiative. Two pawns are under attack and
White needs to find a strong response.
26.Kh1!
Kasparov finds the only move that gives him the chance to fight for an advantage. Paradoxically,
moving the king into the corner is the best move – another proof that chess is a magical game.
26...Rg5
With nothing happening on the g-file, Kramnik decides to transfer the rook to the queenside.
A) 26...Nxg2? 27.Rg1+–
B) 26...Rxg2? 27.Nd3+–
28.Rxd5 Nxd5 29.Nxh6 Nb4 gives excellent counter-chances to Black due to a more active king and
more advanced pawns.
909
Position after: 29...Rd2
30.Re5!
Once again the most active, and actually the only move.
30...Rxf2?
This is a big mistake by Kramnik. Capturing the c2-pawn, Black enters a deadly pin
¹ 30...Rxc2 31.Rf5 Rxf2 32.Ng4 Rxg2 33.Rxf4 Rxa2²
910
Position after: 34.Rf2+–
As a result, White has a winning position. Still, some technical accuracies are required.
Kasparov chooses a concrete line. He perfectly calculated that Black’s queenside counterplay is not fast
enough.
36...c4 37.h5 cxb3 38.axb3 Rc5 39.h6+ Kf8 40.Nf6 Rg5+ 41.Kh1 1-0
A very nice win and very convincing play from Kasparov. Unfortunately for him, he was not able to
find such a promising response to Kramnik’s Berlin the year before. An extremely instructive example
on the topic of supporting the initiative.
Game 86
Keres – Kotov
Parnu 1947
1.e4 c5 2.Ne2
911
Position after: 2.Ne2
Keres was always recognised as a great expert of the Sicilian Defence – he repeatedly crushed Black, in
so many different ways. He was also recognised as a great inventor and he probably prepared
something for his opponent. Kotov always felt uncomfortable playing the Sicilian as Black against the
great Paul. So, he decided to deviate from well-known theory and to play originally. Alas, that was a
very bad decision...
And it is time to stop for a while... What is the idea behind Black’s strange last move? Certainly, the
idea is to accelerate the queenside expansion and to advance the b-pawn before the white knight gets to
c3. It looks like Black will benefit from this premature advance – he plays 3...b5 without needing to
prepare it with ...a6 like in a normal Sicilian. In fact, this is not the case. In a few moves it will be clear
that White gains tempi. At this point, let’s just remind ourselves of the remarkable and useful principle:
“If your opponent plays on the flank, counter in the centre!”
912
Position after: 5.d4!
5...cxd4
5...Nd7 is another satisfactory option, but still White’s position should be preferred due to a space
advantage and control of the centre. Also, Black determines the position of the queenside knight – it
can no longer be developed to c6.
6.Nxd4 a6
It becomes clear that Black did not save even a single tempo – the move ...a6 is played! We are now in
some strange Najdorf and White uses the fact that Black’s kingside pieces are on their initial positions
to seize a huge initiative.
913
Position after: 8.Re1
White threatens to advance his e-pawn. Black eliminates this threat with his next move.
8...Qc7?!
8...e5 was later suggested as a better option. Although, after 9.Nf5 g6 10.Ne3 Be7 11.Nc3 White is
evidently better due to control of the weakened d5-sqaure and better development. Black also has
weaknesses on the kingside and the lack of harmony in his camp is apparent.
9.a4!
914
Position after: 9.a4!
Now White gets the initiative, which he will keep until the end. Black will be unable to finish
development or even castle. His kingside troops are undeveloped and his queenside pawns are
vulnerable after his uncareful advancing. Finally, we see that White is the one who benefited from
Black’s strange 3rd move.
9...bxa4
9...b4?! 10.c3!
915
Position after: 10.c3!
A) 10...a5 11.cxb4 axb4 12.e5! dxe5 [12...Bxg2 13.exf6+–] 13.Nb5 Qc8 14.Bf4!! looks devastating.
The reader may wish to pursue this on their own.
B) 10...bxc3 11.Nxc3 Nbd7 [11...e6 12.Nd5! exd5 13.exd5+ Kd8 14.Bg5 is also winning. Black’s king
is in the centre and cannot be successfully defended. All the white pieces are attacking.] 12.Nd5 Nxd5
13.exd5 leads Black to a hopeless position. He is unable to castle kingside without losing material. The
e7-pawn is vulnerable and there is no satisfactory defence against the moves Nc6, Bg5, etc.
10.Rxa4
10.Nc3 was perhaps even better. White wants to get this knight to d5.
10...Nbd7
11.Bd2!?
Black played the opening in original style (and badly). Keres well understood that the first phase of the
game was now over – he logically and successfully countered Black’s strange 3rd move. It is time for a
crushing plan to be found. Intuition told Keres that a5 was the best square for this bishop.
The natural 11.Nc3 was also a good option: 11...e6 12.Nd5!?.
11...Nc5 12.Rc4!
Take a look at White’s setup. His queenside knight is waiting to be activated. It will have a role later.
916
The rook and bishop on the queenside are very strong pieces, even though they are strangely placed. If
the opponent plays the opening strangely, it is sometimes necessary to employ even stranger measures
to refute it! The c5-knight is in trouble.
14.Nc3 with the occupation of the d5-outpost was simple and evidently strong. However, Keres
preferred to play in a more tactical manner.
14...Ne6 15.Ba5
917
Position after: 15.Ba5
In many games, we observe “bishop scissors” on b2 and g2. But, in this case, a5 and h3 are much better
options!
15...g6
918
is winning for White. With an exposed king and disharmony in his troops, there is nothing Black can do
against White’s pawn avalanche on the queenside.
16.Ne3 Rc8
Last but not least, the knight joins the battle. Black is hopeless.
17.Nc3
White’s minor pieces terrorise Black. The black king is in the centre, surrounded by weaknesses...
17.Nd5?! Nxd5 18.Rxc8+ Qxc8 19.exd5 Qc5!„
919
Position after: 19.b3
It may appear as though Black has survived. However, after some deeper analysis, it becomes clear that
Black can do nothing. Black is just delaying the inevitable.
19...Nc5?
920
23.Nd5!!+–. What an incredible and beautiful blow! Game over.
B) 19...Nd4!? looks very promising, although there are still some amazing tactical shots. 20.Nd5!
Nxd5
21.Nxe5! [But not 21.Qxd4? Nf4! 22.Nxe5 Nxh3+ 23.Kg2 Qc8∞ and White should still be better, but
the result is far from set in stone.]
B1) 21...Qc5 22.Nc4 Be7 [22...Nf6 23.Bb6+–] 23.Bg2 [23.exd5?? Qxd5–+] 23...Nf6 24.Bb6+–
B2) 21...dxe5 22.Qxd4!± as later shown by Keres. White should be positionally winning after 22...f6!
[22...exd4?! 23.exd5++–] 23.exd5 Qxd5 24.Qxd5 Bxd5 25.Rd1. Such a big difference in piece activity
should result in a win for White.
20.Nxe5!
921
Position after: 20.Nxe5!
Black can choose between getting mated (Qd8#) and losing a queen. He decided to resign. A terrible
defeat indeed! Many coaches suggest the games of the great Paul Keres to learn how to seize and
support the initiative. I agree with this, and particularly love this game.
1-0
922
Chapter 8
Blockades and Prophylaxis
The title contains two seemingly unrelated terms. However, there is a strong connection between them.
Blockading (probably a pawn) means that the opponent’s pieces will remain passive. The great Aron
Nimzowitsch astutely stated that “a blockade never has a local character”. Imagine a blockade
established in front of an opponent’s isolated pawn. Their pieces would protect that pawn (because it
would be weak!), and would become active should that isolated pawn disappear! In effect, by
blockading the isolated pawn, we are keeping the opponent’s pieces passive! Naturally, they should
remain passive – the pawn should be taken at the right moment. Hence, the connection between a
blockade and prophylaxis is evident.
The reader will find many useful tips when carefully analysing the games presented in this book. We
will explore illustrative and instructive points about managing and maintaining a blockade, securing the
blockading piece on the dominating square, preventing the activation of the opponent’s troops,
eliminating counterplay and so on.
Game 87
Rubinstein – Salwe
Lodz 1908
Nowadays, this line – named after Rubinstein – is considered as the most dangerous for Black. The
bishop will attack the vulnerable d5-pawn from g2. Of course, White would capture on c5, after Black
923
plays ...Be7.
A) 7...Be7 8.dxc5 Bxc5 9.0-0 0-0 10.Bg5 is another reasonable option for Black. White keeps a small
edge, pressuring d5.
B) If 7...c4 then 8.Ne5 is a good option. [8.Bg5 Be7 9.0-0 0-0 10.b3 also looks promising for White.]
8.Nxd4 Qb6
9.Nxc6!
9.Nb3? d4 10.Ne4 Nxe4 11.Bxe4 Bh3 suddenly gives the initiative to Black.
924
Position after: 11.Na4
That is the point. Black now has a hanging pair of pawns in the centre instead of an isolated pawn.
Importantly, he is unable to advance it to c5. With the text move, White starts the operation of
occupying the weak c5- and f4-squares and blocking the black pawns.
925
Everything is going smoothly. It is, indeed, a great pleasure to analyse Rubinstein’s games – his plans
are so natural and clear. Moreover, they are always supported by logic and dedicated to centralisation.
This makes him one of my chess mentors – his games are so instructive and I couldn’t recommend
analysing them highly enough.
13...Bg4 14.f3!
Once again, Rubinstein shows his skill. He rightly felt that the move f3 will be useful for White. It
looks like a waste of time and a bad idea due to the blocking of the g2-bishop (if the move f4 follows,
Black will exploit the hole on e4!). However, the bishop will be reactivated via the f1-square – it is no
longer needed on the long diagonal because the d5-pawn is stable. Also, the f1-rook will be transferred
to c2 via f2. Rubinstein always tried to find multi-purpose moves.
14...Be6 15.Bc5
It is useful to exchange all of the opponent’s pieces that control the weak squares!
926
Position after: 18.Qd4!
Beautiful and simple centralisation. The queen protects both the a4-knight and b2-pawn, while also
securing domination over the c5-square.
Not 20.e4, of course, as simplifications would favour Black – his pieces would have more space.
20...Qb7 21.Nc5
927
Position after: 21.Nc5
In front of the opponent’s weak pawns are good squares for our pieces. Occupying them will result in a
strong blockade, as illustrated by Rubinstein.
All the black pieces and central pawns are placed on white squares, leaving the dark squares horribly
weak. White’s pieces – knight, rook and queen – will use the c5-square at their leisure. The king will
even use it in the endgame. Meanwhile, the black pieces are without prospects. The only thing Black
can do is... wait, and try to resist for as long as possible.
White practically has no bad moves. He will patiently put pressure on a6 and/or c6. Domination in the
centre gives him the ability to play on either flank. In this case, simplification will not help Black.
26...Ra7?
29...Qb7 30.Kf2
928
Position after: 30.Kf2
Vacating the c5-sqaure for the rook and attacking the a6-pawn.
A desperate attempt.
Black resigned. The game is just one of many convincing Rubinstein victories which left the opponents
confused about where they went wrong. Control over the blockading squares c5 and d4 gave White full
control over the entire board, and led to the paralysis of Black’s queenside.
1-0
Game 88
Smyslov – Denker
Moscow 1946
929
Position after: 6.Be3
6...Nd4?!
7.Nce2!?
This is an interesting move. White wants to play c3, and later on d4. This is why Black should jump to
d4 only after Ng1-e2.
7...d6
7...Nxe2 8.Nxe2 Bxb2 9.Rb1 White wins back the pawn. Now, a big mistake would be 9...Qa5+?
10.Bd2 Qxa2 11.Rxb2 Qxb2 12.Bc3+–.
8.c3 Nc6
9.d4 cxd4
930
Position after: 9...cxd4
10.Nxd4
White had this recapture in mind since his 7th move. The point is that Black’s pawn structure
(d6+e6+g6) is fairly weak – Black’s dark-squared bishop cannot simultaneously be fianchettoed and
protect the d6-pawn.
10.cxd4 would give Black many solid options: 10...d5 or 10...Nge7 or 10...Qa5+ 11.Nc3 Nf6.
10...Nxd4 11.Bxd4
931
Position after: 11.Bxd4
11...e5!?
A) 11...Nf6 12.e5 dxe5 13.Bxe5 Qxd1+ [13...0-0 14.Qe2 is slightly better for White.] 14.Rxd1 poses
another kind of problem to Black – the queenside is paralysed.
B) 11...Bxd4 12.Qxd4 e5 13.Qa4+ Bd7 14.Qa3 Qb6 is relatively OK for Black, although White should
be somewhat better.
12.Be3
12...Ne7
932
Position after: 14.0-0
A) 14...d5? 15.exd5 Bxd5 [15...Nxd5 16.Bc5±] 16.Qa4+ Qd7 17.Qxd7+ Kxd7 18.Rad1±
B) 14...0-0 should be OK for Black.
15...d5?! 16.Bc5!
16.Rfc1
933
Position after: 16.Rfc1
16...f5
16...b5 would be risky in view of 17.a4! a6 [17...bxa4 18.Rxa4 a5 19.Rca1 preparing b4.] 18.Rd1 and
Black is in trouble.
Black hopes to advance the d-pawn after eliminating the e4-pawn, but...
19.Nxe4
934
Position after: 19.Nxe4
19...Nxe3
19...Nd4 20.c5! d5 21.Ng5 Bf7 22.Nxf7 Qxf7 23.f4 with a strong initiative for White.
20.Qxe3
20...h6
935
Position after: 20...h6
White has harmoniously placed his pieces and now is the time to fight for the d5-square. Black’s bishop
pair is useless, especially the dark-squared bishop.
21.Rd1 Rfd8
A) 21...Bxc4? 22.Rac1+–
B) 21...Qxc4 22.Rxd6±
936
Position after: 24.Nc3!
The white pieces are optimally placed and it is time to find the correct plan. Certainly, the d5-square
should be occupied. Doing so with the knight could give Black a chance to play with opposite coloured
bishops – White would still be better, but Black may have chances to survive. Black’s bishop on e6 is
his most valuable piece, so White should exchange it. The white knight will dominate over the bad
bishop on g7. The strong blockading squares d5 and e4 will be occupied by the white pieces.
24...Qe7
24...Kh7 25.Be4!ƒ with the idea of advancing the h-pawn gives White a very strong attack.
937
Position after: 28...Rf7
29.Ne4!
The d6-pawn is Black’s main weakness, so the knight belongs on e4. 29.Nd5 doesn’t give White
anything – why block the d-file? The pawn should be conquered.
29...Bf8 30.Rd5
938
Preparing to triple on the d-file – the queen goes behind the rooks. The main goal has been achieved: a
firm blockade. Black’s central pawns are fixed targets which paralyse the pieces behind them.
30...Qg4 31.R1d3
31.Nxd6 Bxd6 32.Rxd6 Qxd1+! 33.Rxd1 Rxd1+ with excellent drawing chances.
31...Be7
33.c5!+–
32.Nxd6
939
Position after: 32.Nxd6
White precisely calculated that the f-file would bring nothing to Black.
940
The game is over. The next stage is a convincing Smyslov realisation.
41...Qf5 42.Rd1 Qc5+ 43.Kg2 Qe7 44.Rf1+ Kg8 45.Qf6 Qe8 46.Qf5 g4 47.Rf2 Qe7 48.Qd3
48...Rg5
48...Qb7+ 49.Qd5++–
49.Re2
Game 89
Tarrasch – Teichmann
San Sebastian 1912
1.e4 e6 2.d4 d5 3.Nc3 Nf6 4.Bg5 Be7 5.e5 Nfd7 6.Bxe7 Qxe7 7.Qd2 0-0 8.f4 c5 9.Nf3 Nc6 10.g3 a6
11.Bg2 b5 12.0-0 cxd4 13.Nxd4 Nxd4 14.Qxd4 Qc5 15.Qxc5 Nxc5 16.Ne2
941
Position after: 16.Ne2
We have a well-known pawn structure which often arises from the French Defence. White is ready to
install a blockading knight on d4 and organise a pawn attack on the kingside. Black intends to carry out
active play on the queenside using the semi-open c-file. Due to fixed pawns on d5 and e6, it is good for
him to exchange his bishop. On the other hand, White should aim for an endgame without rooks and
with Black’s bad light-squared bishop. The game is quite balanced and everything depends on the
players’ strategic skillsets. Teichmann was a fun player and sharp in middlegames full of combinatory
and tactical play. In this position, however, it is no surprise the great Dr. Tarrasch outplayed him.
16...Bd7?
942
Position after: 19.Ke3
19...Re8?
20.Rf2 Nb7!?
943
Position after: 20...Nb7!?
Interesting, and not such a bad move. Although it was, unfortunately, part of a bad plan. It was still
good to put the pawns on h5 and g6.
21.Bf1 Na5
21...h5!
22.b3 h6?
A) 22...Rc3+? also gives nothing. After 23.Kd2 Rc7 [23...b4?? 24.a3+–; 23...Rec8? 24.b4! Nb7 25.a4!
Black’s position collapses.] 24.Rf3 there is the interesting and promising possibility for White to use
the 3rd rank to exchange rooks. After exchanging rooks, Black’s weakened queenside will be in danger.
B) 22...h5 was still a good option.
23.Bd3
944
Position after: 23.Bd3
23...Nc6?
A key mistake! Black should leave the pieces to cover the weak dark squares on the queenside. White’s
knight on d4 is a monster, of course, but his king will be no less dangerous there!
24.Nxc6!
24...Bxc6 25.Kd4!
25...Bd7 26.g4
945
Position after: 28...Kg7
32.h6+ Kh7 33.fxg5 Rhc8 34.Rf2 Be8 is much better for White, but no direct win is visible.
946
Position after: 35...Ke7
36.g6?
Imprecise move. Do not rush! 36.Rh7! Kf8 37.g6 fxg6 38.Bxg6 Kg8 39.Rf7 was the correct path to
victory.
947
39...Rc3??
948
Position after: 5...Be7
6.Bxc6?!
White has better development, more space and a better majority. Black’s position is compact and he has
949
the bishop pair.
10...Nc5!
Generally, it is good to exchange passive pieces for active ones. Also, the knight heads to the excellent
e6-square. The point will soon be clear.
An excellent decision. Smyslov wants to open the position for his bishop pair and sets a positional trap.
Many players would automatically advance the e-pawn.
13.e5?
Including Bondarevsky! It looks natural, but it is a terrible positional mistake. The e5-pawn will be
blocked. With precise play by Black, the blockading knight on e6 will be eternal. The e5-pawn will
actually restrict three white pieces: the bishop, knight and rook. Always try to advance or exchange
pawns that are protected by three or more of your pieces!
13.Bg5 Bxg5 14.Nxg5 h6 15.Nf3 fxe4 16.Nxe4 Nxe4 17.Rxe4 Bf5 18.Re2 [18.Re7 Bxc2 19.Rxc7
Rf7=] 18...Bg4 19.Re3 leads to draw.
950
Position after: 14...g5!
Logical and strong. First of all, Black gains space on the kingside – a good strategy for the side with the
bishop pair. Secondly, this move restricts the white minor pieces. And, perhaps most importantly, the
text move maintains the blockader on its perfect position on e6. White may play Ne2 with the idea to
exchange the blockader after Nf4 or Ned4. Thus, Black’s last move is both aggressive and
prophylactic.
15.Ne2 c5!
16.Bc3 b5
Gaining space on both flanks and preparing a fianchetto for the light-squared bishop.
17.b3 Bb7
951
Position after: 17...Bb7
You do not need to be an expert to see that Black is much better. His powerful pawn avalanches on
both flanks will destroy everything in their paths.
18.Ng3
White intends to penetrate behind the opponent’s pawns, perhaps hoping for an endgame with opposite
coloured bishops. In fact, this knight will be out of play on f6.
952
Position after: 23.Rad1
White’s knight on f6 is useless. If he wants, Black can reach an opposite coloured bishop endgame with
an extra pawn (after the move exf6, this pawn will fall). Thus, Black decided to simplify the position by
exchanging all the rooks – his minor pieces dominate the board and are collaborating with pawns on
both flanks.
953
Taking the g4-pawn is forbidden. Black’s king even gets to f5 now.
27.Nd1 Bxf6!
This is by far the simplest way to realise the huge positional advantage. The point is that Black will
collect White’s queenside pawns while keeping the white minor pieces paralysed.
Preventing the activation of the d1-knight. White cannot escape, his queenside pawns are helpless.
34.Nd2 a5 35.Kf2
954
Position after: 35.Kf2
35...Nd4
35...c4 36.Nxc4 Bxb3 37.Nxa5 Bd5 would be a funny line! The tables have turned – now the black
bishop completely paralyses the white knight!
955
40.bxa4 c5 41.a5 c4 42.a6 d3+
Black is faster. White resigned. White made only one important mistake, on the 13th move. Even with
better play afterwards he would probably not have been able to save the game. Excellent realisation by
Smyslov.
0-1
Game 91
Szostko – Zlatanovic
Plovdiv 2015
6...Be7
This move is played with the idea of preventing some moves like Bg5 or Ng5.
7.Bb5 Ncb8
Black prevents White’s idea of doubling the pawns and prepares the exchange of the light-squared
bishops.
8.0-0 b6 9.c3 a5
956
9...Ba6 immediately is bad. After 10.Bxa6 Nxa6 11.Qd3 Black is forced to retreat, wasting time.
10.a4 Ba6
11.Bxa6
11.Bf4
A) 11...Bxb5 12.axb5 leads to the momentary paralysis of Black’s queenside troops. Black can break
free with the move ...c6, but then ...c5 would no longer be an option after the exchange of pawns.
Undermining the pawn chain with the advance of the a- and b-pawns would be too slow – White will
have enough time to seize the initiative on the kingside.
B) 11...c6!
957
Position after: 13.Rc1
The first important moment in the game. One idea for White in this line can be to open the position
with the move c4. The weak b5- and c6-squares can cause Black some problems.
13...c4
Black decided to radically eliminate that possibility. This is risky: by blocking the queenside, he must
organise an attack further down the chain – on the c3-pawn. This is time consuming. However, Black
has achieved a lot by exchanging the light-squared bishops and eliminating White’s threats on the
kingside by taking away the g5-square. Certainly, White must carry out a direct pawn attack on the
kingside, but Black is ready to face it.
14.Nbd2 b5!?
15.axb5 Nc7
958
Position after: 15...Nc7
16.Ne1
16...0-0 17.f4
959
17...Qb8
A very fine move. Black wants to recapture on b5 with the queen. The knight will be needed on c7.
Black could stop White’s attack directly with 17...f5, but he wanted to provoke White’s next move.
18.g4?!
A logical continuation.
18.f5 was an option, but after 18...exf5 19.Rxf5 Qxb5
Black is even slightly better – the knight from c7 will head to the perfect blockading square on e6. Even
the rook can go to a6 to support the kingside counter-attack with ...f6.
18...f5!
960
Position after: 18...f5!
This move is even stronger with White’s pawn on g4. The position on the kingside will be opened and
advancing the g-pawn will actually weaken White’s kingside.
19.exf6
A) 19.g5? is very bad, of course. White blocks the side on which he is determined to attack, giving
Black freedom to organise queenside play.
B) 19.gxf5?! Rxf5 with a perfect outpost for the black pieces on f5.
19...Nxf6 20.g5?!
20.h3 looks more solid, not allowing a blockade on the light squares. But it would also be a sign of
White’s hesitance.
20...Nfe8
The knight goes to the ideal d6-square, from where it can jump both to e4 and f5.
21.Qg4 g6
Black played this move to block the g-pawn and secure an outpost on f5.
961
Position after: 21...g6
White’s natural attack on the h-file cannot easily be organised. It has become clear that White’s attack
has been parried and Black’s blockade on the weak light-squares in the centre will be the decisive
positional factor.
22.Ndf3 Bd6
It is important to control the e5-square and capture the white knight when it gets there. The black
knight will travel to f5 via g7.
962
Position after: 25...a4
Black has recaptured the pawn and is ready to install pieces (knights initially) on the weak central light
squares. Advancing the a-pawn with the idea to infiltrate on the queenside is also on the agenda.
Black avoids the clever trap set by White. 27...Bxf4? 28.Nxf5 Rxf5 29.Bxf4 Rxf4 30.Rxe6! and Black’s
position is in ruins.
28.Rxe3
963
Position after: 28.Rxe3
28...Rae8
Once again, the f4-pawn was poisoned. Now Black threatens to capture it.
A) 28...Rxf4? 29.Rxe6!+–
B) 28...Bxf4? 29.Rxe6!+–
964
Position after: 30.Rxe5
Black is clearly better due to a much better minor piece. Although there are many problems with
converting this advantage. White maintains pressure on the e-file, which can be transferred to the h-file.
Black must put a knight on f5 or e4. Black must also try to exchange queens and a pair of rooks. The
endgame R+N against R+B would be a dream come true for Black.
Bringing the queen back to defend and vacating the b5-square for the knight.
965
Position after: 34.h4
34...h5?!
Both sides were in time trouble so Black missed a better continuation, being afraid of the attack on the
h-file. Actually, Black wanted to play on the kingside himself after White’s “en passant” – he was
worried he would not be to able realise his advantage due to an overblocked position. If White doesn’t
capture “en passant”, the kingside will be blocked permanently and White’s position will collapse on
the queenside.
34...Ne4 was still a better option. Now 35.h5 would be met by the powerful 35...e5!.
37.Reg2 Rg8
966
Position after: 37...Rg8
38.h5?
967
Position after: 41...Qf7
The e6-pawn will need protecting. The h6-pawn can be taken at any moment.
After some repetition, Black found a good plan to realise the advantage. White’s queen is temporarily
out of play and Black regroups to organise a dangerous doubling down the h-file.
968
Position after: 47.Rh2
47...Kg7
The game is over. Such a difference in power between the minor pieces is decisive. It is fairly rare to
see such a good knight and such a poor bishop. The conversion is simple. Black’s rook penetrates down
the h-file and the knight goes to e4, vacating the f5-square for the king.
50...Rh8+ 51.Kg2 Kf6 52.Kf2 Nd6 53.Rg1 Ne4+ 54.Ke2 Rh2+ 55.Ke1
969
Position after: 55.Ke1
55...Kf5
White’s pieces are forced to retreat. Meanwhile, the black trio are organising a mating attack.
56.Rf1
The game was played in the last round. In the manner of a real gentleman, White decides to let himself
be mated.
60.Kf1 Rc2–+
60...Nf2#
970
Position after: 60...Nf2#
The final position is very beautiful and is the logical result of the endgame. The endgame is everything
Black had hoped for when playing his 13th move. A very typical game that explores the total
domination of a knight over a bishop. Also an instructive example on the topic of how a middlegame
plan should be based on the arising endgame.
0-1
971
Game 92
Rauzer – Riumin
Leningrad 1936
6...d6
More common is 6...b5, forcing White to make one more move with his bishop.
7.c3 b5 8.Bb3
This is the difference. Playing 6...d6 instead of 6...b5, Black gave White the opportunity to play 8.Bc2.
972
Position after: 10...Qc7
After an unusual move order, we are back in a popular Ruy Lopez variation.
12.d5 was also a good choice. With this move, White will force the black knight to retreat once again.
973
This knight uses its usual route, going to f1 via d2...
15...Be6 16.Ne3
...but now White deviates. Usually, the knight goes to g3 and then f5, keeping the diagonal for the dark-
squared bishop open. But, the text move is very good too – the knight also eyes the d5-square.
Black’s last move is very interesting. Of course, Black prepares to double rooks on the d-file. But,
Black also sets a small positional trap. What is the point? Black’s e6-bishop is undoubtedly a good
piece and the rook protects it. It looks like if White captures the bishop, Black will recapture with the
rook.
19.Nf5!
White responds perfectly. He goes for the e6-bishop another way, keeping the d5- and f5-squares
accessible!
19.Nxe6 fxe6! is the point, Black protected the bishop on e6 with the rook to recapture... with a pawn!
Black’s pawns are doubled and isolated, but they control very important central squares. The e6-pawn
is perfectly placed, controlling the important d5- and f5-squares, restricting the white knight. The white
bishops are also restricted. Black has comfortable play and can go for the initiative on the queenside
with the following plan: ...c4, ...Nd7-c5. [19...Rxe6 would be bad. After 20.Nd5 Qb7 21.Bg5 White is
clearly better.]
974
19...Bxf5
19...Rd7 20.Nxe6 fxe6 21.Nxe7+ Rxe7 22.Bg5 is bad for Black. Comparing it to the line above after
move 19.Nxe6, White got rid of the e3-knight and his dark-squared bishop is already very active.
20.exf5!!
Correct decision! The e4-pawn restricted the entire white army: bishop, rook and queen. Transferring it
to f5, the rook will work perfectly on the e-file and the queen will dominate on the long diagonal
together with the bishop which will be placed on e4! White will have excellent prospects on both
flanks. He can organise a pawn march on the kingside, directly attacking the black king. Or he can use
the a-file and diagonals g1-a7 and h1-a8 to attack the opponent’s weakened queenside. From this point
onwards, it is unclear how Black could improve on his play. His position simply looks hopeless.
This bishop will clearly be the most influential piece on the board. From the perfect blockading square,
it will target both flanks simultaneously, while paralysing the black pieces by blocking the e5-pawn.
22...Bf6
Blocking the f5-pawn, which closes the b1-h7 diagonal. However, the bishop is now very passive.
23.Be3 Ne7
975
Position after: 23...Ne7
24.b4!
Now this! The dark-squared diagonal is opened, and Ra7 is another threat.
24...c4 25.g3
White enjoys a perfect position. Black’s pieces are without prospects due to White’s perfectly placed
bishops. Instead of the “slow” text move, White could even have gone for an invasion on the a-file.
The idea of g3 is to play h4, to prevent potential attempts to exchange the dark-squared bishops.
25...Rd7
If 25...Bg5 then 26.Bc5 Rd7 27.h4 Bd2 28.Red1 and Black will lose material.
976
Position after: 28...Kh8?
29.g4! Ng8
977
Brutal realisation. The bishop on e4 finds activity on another diagonal.
32...Bxf6
33.gxf6 Nxf6 34.Bc2 Rd8 35.Bxh6 Rxd1+ 36.Bxd1 e4 37.Bf4 Qd8 38.Qe2 Nd5
Black resigned.
A short game but a very instructive and helpful one for understanding the central complex and
occupying and blockading on weak squares. Rauzer also perfectly demonstrated the power of the
bishop pair.
1-0
Game 93
Solmundarson – Smyslov
Reykjavik 1974
Both players chose Tarrasch’s setup. White’s next move prepares the advance of b4 after dxc5. Black
decides to parry this in original fashion.
6.a3 Ne4!?
978
7.Nxe4?!
Why not 7.Qc2, intending to prove Black’s last move was a waste of time?
7...dxe4 8.Ne5
White goes for symmetry, but Black will soon be a pawn up...
After a strangely played opening, the position is very interesting. Black has an extra pawn, but White
certainly has compensation. Black must find a safe spot for his king.
13...Bd7
979
Position after: 18.e4
White has the initiative. However, Black shouldn’t be in much trouble. There are a few logical peaceful
continuations for Black. Having said that, Smyslov was never a fan of defence. He would much rather
play with the initiative as compensation for material, so his next move is understandable. Still, had this
game been played at an international team event, or at a more important tournament, I don’t think he
would have chosen the text move.
18...g6!?
One cannot say that the move is bad. It is simply solid. But, should it be chosen? Perhaps Smyslov
wanted to confuse the opponent. Maybe he underestimated him.
18...fxe4 19.fxe4 Qh4 was evidently a good option for Black. It is difficult to prove that White’s
initiative is worth a pawn. This move was definitely better, objectively. Smyslov based his decision on
psychology...
980
Position after: 20...Qxh8
Objectively, there is a dynamic balance. White has a small material edge but his rook cannot be used
effectively. White’s weakened dark squares are the most important factor in the position, but it is
currently unclear how Black can benefit from them.
21.Bd3?
A horrible mistake. White misses his last chance for active play. Having a rook on the board, White
must open some files!
21.exf5 was a must. After 21...exf5 both sides will have their chances. The weakness of the f3-pawn is
not significant – Black would only be able to attack it twice.
981
Position after: 22...f4!
After this move, White is unable to find an open file for his rook. Black is now better because he has
setup a blockading net all over the board – only he has chances to organise active play.
What is the idea behind this king manoeuvre? It is to prevent White’s potential expansion on the
queenside. White needs some open files for his rook. The h-file cannot be opened – Black would easily
prevent it. On the queenside, it will also be impossible to open files properly because it would
jeopardise the safety of the white king. Transferring it to the kingside would just be ridiculous, because
of Black’s incoming pawns. Another idea behind Black’s king evacuation will soon be clear...
982
Position after: 27...g5
A very important move. A battery on the long dark-squared diagonal would not bring anything to
Black. On the other hand, White could potentially advance his pawn to e5, liberating his bishop. By
giving away that pawn, White could achieve some active play.
983
Position after: 33.Be2
33...a5
34.Ka2 Be6
The next few moves were probably played with the idea to delay any serious action and wait for the
40th move, when players receive more time.
35.Kb1 Kf6 36.Kc2 h6 37.Kb1 Bf7 38.Rd1 Bh5 39.Bf1 Bf7 40.Be2 Be6 41.Rh1 a4
984
Position after: 41...a4
After getting additional time, Black goes for the kill. Before striking on the kingside, he fixes the
position on the queenside.
42.Kc2
Black’s pieces are on their ultimate squares. In such situations, they logically need additional help.
Evidently, the pawns cannot help – expanding would open the position... Eureka! The king!
42...Kg6!
There is a route for the king! The queen will vacate the h4-square and the king will penetrate.
42...Qg3 43.Qf1 still gives nothing to Black.
985
Position after: 46.b3
46...b5
986
Position after: 51...Kg3
White resigned. A very instructive game. White missed the chance to open a file for his rook, and so his
defeat is the logical result. Dear reader, in your games, choose a pawn structure that favours your
pieces. Don’t forget, ultimately, active pieces need extra support. In some cases, especially in
endgames, the king is the answer!
0-1
Game 94
Zlatanovic – Brankovic
Paracin 2016
987
Position after: 6...a5?!
Played with the idea to provoke ...h6. The point will soon become clear.
Black intends to play ...b5, with comfortable play on the queenside. But...
988
Position after: 13...Nc7
14.Nb5!
The planned and typical 14.b4 is solid. After 14...axb4 15.axb4 cxb4 16.Nxb4 Nxb4 17.Rxb4 b5
18.cxb5 Nxb5 19.Nxb5 Rxb5 20.Rxb5 Bxb5 21.Qb3 White is slightly better, but without serious
chances to play for a win. It would be unsatisfactory for White.
14...Nxb5
What else?
15.cxb5
15...Ne5
Suddenly, Black is lacking piece harmony and space and must play very precisely. White is planning to
organise a pawn march on the kingside.
989
18...d5!
19.e4
A must. Black intended to play 19...d4, stopping the pawn on e2 and liberating the d5-square for the
knight.
19...b6?
19...c4! should have been played, with reasonable practical chances. After 20.exd5 [20.dxc4 dxe4
21.Ne3 also leads to an unclear position.] 20...cxd3 21.Ne3 the position is double-edged.
990
Position after: 21.Ne3
Black probably decided to play passively because of the tournament standings. The game was played in
the last round and either a draw or a win would bring him the silver medal. White, on the other hand,
had to win.
20.Ne3!
991
Played with the clear idea to install the knight on c4 after eliminating the d5-pawn.
20.e5 Ne8 21.d4 is also promising.
20...d4?
¹ 20...e6 21.e5²
21.Nc4
After this move, the game is almost over. Black is without any real counterplay and he can only wait
and watch White’s growing initiative on the kingside. Establishing a strong blockade on c4, White will
also be the one creating threats on the queenside.
21...Ne8 22.f5
22...e5?!
Black has the idea of playing ...g5 and ...Bf6 to be ready, after White’s h4 and hxg5, to recapture with
the bishop. This would achieve the strategical goal of exchanging the dark-squared bishops.
23.h4!
Not only preventing ...g5, but also preparing Bh3 with the idea to potentially exchange the light-
squared bishops.
992
23...Bc8
The c4-square is the most important square on the board and it is extremely important to have
continuous control over it. White must be ready to recapture with a piece, and not with a pawn! Soon,
White’s queen will dominate on c4. Later, perhaps the bishop will – or even the king, in the endgame,
could use the route b3-c4-d5.
An interesting position!
993
Position after: 28.Bg4!
White not only has a better dark-squared bishop, but a better light-squared one too! Soon, it will
dominate on the a2-g8 diagonal, paralysing the c8-bishop and potentially exchanging it at any time.
Black’s position is hopeless. There is nothing he can do against White’s initiative on the kingside.
White simply follows his plan of a kingside invasion, while Black’s queenside pieces are without
prospects.
994
Position after: 32...Rh8
33.Bd1!
A simple and logical idea! The queen on c4 only uses one diagonal. So, the queen and bishop should
swap places!
33...Rxh5 34.Rxh5 Rh8 35.Rxh8 Kxh8 36.Bb3 Kg7 37.Qc1 Qd8 38.Qh1 Qe7
38...Qg8 was a better defence. Still, after 39.Qh5 Kf8 40.Qh6+ White should win the game.
995
Position after: 40...Bd7
41.Kf3
The most direct winning idea. White is not afraid of exchanging a good bishop for a bad one!
43...Bxg5 44.Qxg5+ Qxg5+ 45.Kxg5 f6+ 46.Kh4 Be8 47.g4 Kh6 48.Be6ʘ
996
Position after: 48.Be6ʘ
Zugzwang!
Eliminating Black’s last chance: 51...c4. Black resigned. It is hard to find Black’s mistakes. It looks
like his only bad move was 20...d4?, after which Black could no longer save the game. White’s control
over the important blockading c4-square and closed queenside left Black without counterplay. White
was unstoppable on the kingside.
1-0
Game 95
Capablanca – Ragozin
Moscow 1935
1.d4 Nf6 2.c4 e6 3.Nc3 Bb4 4.a3 Bxc3+ 5.bxc3 d6 6.Qc2 0-0 7.e4 e5
997
Position after: 7...e5
Such setups for Black were fashionable between the two world wars. Nowadays, Black favours more
dynamic approaches.
8.Bd3 c5?!
This cannot be a good move. As Nimzowitsch stated, Black should try to provoke d5, liberating the c5-
square for a knight. With his last move, Black blocks the centre; but this will not be in his favour as his
knights can no longer find outposts. 8...b6 is another, better option.
998
Position after: 11...Nd7
12.h4
12...Nb6
13.g4
White goes for a kingside expansion. He cannot do much on the other flank.
13...f6 14.Ng3
999
Position after: 14.Ng3
White is about to organise a kingside attack. Black is evidently unable to find appropriate counterplay –
the centre is closed and he is undeveloped. It is uncertain whether Black can defend successfully – it is
always a problem when the opponent has all the time in the world to prepare an attack. Hence, Black is
almost forced to go for a king escape. He starts the evacuation immediately.
14...Kf7 15.g5?!
This move is not in Capablanca’s patient style, but it is understandable that he wants to attack while the
king is still on the kingside.
15...Ng8
Moving a piece back allows White to strike once more in the centre.
A) 15...Ke8 is bad in view of 16.Nh5.
B) 15...Nd7 was needed in order to strengthen the centre.
16.f4! Ke8
1000
Position after: 16...Ke8
17.f5!
Once again, an excellent solution. By advancing this pawn (and setting pawns on the opponent’s bishop
colour!), White grabs more space and paralyses the black army. Now, the g-file may be opened at some
point and used for infiltration by White.
Pressuring g7.
19...Kc7 20.gxf6
Capturing at the right moment – Black must recapture with the pawn.
20...gxf6
1001
Position after: 20...gxf6
21.Ng7!
That knight threatens to jump to e6, which would be a bone in White’s throat. Black’s position is
hopeless.
21...Bd7 22.h5
Bringing the pawn into the attack, White will secure the knight’s position and have time to regroup the
other pieces. Do not be surprised by White’s play. Indeed, he did not finish development. However, in
blocked positions, this principle does not carry as much weight.
1002
Position after: 25.Rb1
25...Qf8 26.Be2!
After installing the knight on g7, White reactivates the other pieces. The bishop aims for the h5-square.
Temporarily protecting the c4-pawn and preparing to advance the a-pawn. Later, the king should go to
d3 to unchain the queen.
28...Qd8 29.Bd2
1003
Position after: 30...Nb6
It is time to strike. White opens another front. Black’s problems with space and communication lines
mean that he is unable to take care of both flanks.
31.a4! Rb8
1004
Position after: 35.a6
What a funny position! Only Black’s queen has moves. White must find a plan to crush Black’s
defences.
Black could not resist – he decides to try and liberate his army. However, this attempt will just lead to
defeat.
1005
Position after: 41.Qa3
Removing the pawn from c5, both the white queen and bishop get beautiful diagonals.
Everything is in place for the move Ne6 with further infiltration down the g-file. Further resistance is
redundant, the game is decided.
1006
Position after: 46.Ne6
A terrible defeat. Knights are not automatically better than bishops in blocked positions – they need
outposts. To be fair, there is no guarantee a bishop will dominate over a knight in an open position; that
is the beauty of chess. In our game, the white bishops found good diagonals and that was enough. On
the other hand, the black knight – without outposts – started hindering the other pieces. Very soon,
Black’s camp was a real mess. Always be careful when thinking about blocking the position.
1-0
Game 96
Soysal – Marjanovic
Banja Vrujci 2017
6...c6
Black decides to play passively, but his position still looks solid and without weaknesses. White,
having a space advantage, prepares a typical advance in the centre.
1007
9.b3 a5
With the idea to stop White’s potential expansion on the queenside and advance ...a4 at the right time,
creating threats on the a-file.
Naturally, White goes for the initiative, enhancing his space advantage.
11...Rc8
Acting as a submarine against the white queen. White ignores this and finishes development.
11...dxe4 is a typical response. After 12.Nxe4 Nxe4 13.Qxe4, it becomes clear that the a6-knight is
badly placed. It should be on d7, controlling White’s e5-outpost and intending to jump to f6.
12.Bb2
12...Qc7
Black continues to patiently develop his pieces. He is definitely not afraid of White’s expansion.
12...c5 would be too risky. After 13.dxc5 Nb4 [13...Nxc5 14.exd5 exd5 15.Nh4 Black loses material.]
14.Qe2 Bxc5 15.a3 Na6 16.e5 followed by capturing on d5, White is clearly better.
13.e5
1008
With the idea to gain more space and organise a kingside attack.
13...Nd7 14.Qe2
I like this move. The queen is ready to be active on the kingside. The c-file is vacated for a rook, which
will oppose the black queen. Finally, the a6-knight can no longer jump to b4 with tempo.
14...Qb8 15.h4!
15...Nc7
On the other hand, Black prepares ...c5 – it will free his play and activate his pieces.
16.Rac1
16.cxd5 immediately was a logical reaction – White would keep the centre closed and go for a kingside
expansion. He did it one move later.
16...Qa8?!
Black decides to further control the longest diagonal... which remains closed.
16...c5!? should have been preferred. After 17.cxd5 [17.Ng5 opening the diagonal for the bishop
deserves serious attention.] 17...Nxd5 18.Nxd5 Bxd5 19.dxc5 Nxc5 White’s advantage is not
significant.
1009
17.cxd5!
17...cxd5
18.a4
White wants to block the position on the queenside. This could eventually leave Black without any
counterplay.
20.axb5
1010
Position after: 20.axb5
20...Bb7 21.Bf1
The bishop belongs on d3. From there it can play on both flanks.
21.Ng5?! could lead to wild complications after 21...h6 22.Nxe6 fxe6 23.Bh3 Kh8 24.Bxe6.
1011
White has the initiative, but it is questionable whether he needs to go for complications. The path
chosen by White looks promising. He decided to gradually organise kingside play while keeping an eye
on Black’s play on the queenside.
21...Rxc1
After exchanging some material, the situation has stabilised. White is definitely better due to much
more promising pieces. The black knight and light-squared bishop are especially bad. On the other
hand, Black doesn’t have any weaknesses and it will be very difficult for White to break through. The
good news for White is that Black lacks any active plans – the thematic ...f6 break is very risky with the
queens on the board. Also, evacuating the king looks very slow and quite dangerous. Black is forced to
carefully parry White’s kingside activities, which will be unpleasant. White has many possibilities and
as much time as he likes.
24.Qd1!
A very fine starting move. The bishop goes to d3 and the queen controls two important diagonals. A
battery on the b1-h7 diagonal could also be on the agenda.
1012
Position after: 25...Bb4
Black takes the chance to make an “active” move and crosses the halfway line. However, the focus
should be on finding a good defensive kingside setup.
26.h5! Qc7
27.Kg2
27.h6 was simple and strong – now and on the next move.
1013
Position after: 30.Nf3
The knight goes back. White admits his 28th move led to nothing. Nonetheless, White’s advantage is
stable. The opponent lacks active play, so various plans can be tested. The position is blocked and
White has many more prospects for his pieces.
1014
Of course, White could stop Black’s next move, but he decided to allow it, feeling that after the queens
come off, some weak squares would be available on the queenside (he was probably thinking of the
knight infiltrating via b4). Interesting and clever. Still, it should always be better not to give a choice to
the opponent. Black decided to go for it...
Both the b5- and d4-pawns are stable. White wants to prove that the black queen is practically out of
play – the action is happening on the kingside.
1015
Position after: 36...h6?
37.h6
37...g6 38.Nh2!
1016
The f6-square is under Black’s control, so the knight aims for g5.
Intending to play Bd2 or to use the a-file for a queen infiltration after removing the bishop from d3.
41...Qb4?!
42.Qxb4
A concrete decision. White is not afraid of exchanging material. Without queens on the board, the
white pawns will be safer and his pieces can be fully activated. It looks like Black should not offer the
exchange of queens, and White should actually force Black into it.
One of the black minor pieces must stay on d7, paralysing the other.
45...Bc1
1017
Position after: 45...Bc1
46.g5!
Very inventive play. No, the game is not drawn due to the position being “blocked “. The knight goes
to f6. After its exchange, the white monarch can use the newly formed route via e5!
In case of 46.Bg5 Ba3 47.Kg3 White can prepare the advance f4-f5, but it will lead to further
exchanges and probably the activation of Black’s pieces. Furthermore, it is not clear whether White
could make progress if Black just decided to wait.
46...Kf8 47.Kf1
1018
Position after: 47.Kf1
It is funny to see how the white bishop on d8 paralyses the black army. Black wants to get his bishop to
a5 to liberate his other pieces. White, logically, improves the position of his king...
After eliminating threats to the d4-pawn, the white knight can go to f6.
1019
Position after: 53.Bc7
Don’t rush! White wants to place his pieces on the best possible squares before executing his plan.
55...Kh8 is another possibility. The readers may wish to find the win here.
56.Bxf8!
Once again, a concrete decision. White calculated until the end. The next moves are all forced.
56...Kxf8 57.Nh2 Bb4 58.Ng4 Be7 59.Nf6 Bxf6 60.exf6 Bd7 61.Kd2 Ke8 62.Ke3 Bc8 63.Kf4 Kd7
64.Ke5 Bb7
1020
Position after: 64...Bb7
It looks as though White cannot break through, but the next manoeuvre proves otherwise.
1021
70.Kd6! 1-0
Black resigned. A very interesting and highly instructive game. Both players were consistent: White
persistently improved his advantage while Black defended tenaciously. Both players deserve
recognition. Finally, Black collapsed due to a lack of space and harmony in his camp. Everything
probably started going wrong after the white pawn reached b5. The blockade was too powerful and
Black couldn’t regroup his pieces.
1022
Game 97
Petrosian – Peters
Lone Pine 1976
1.c4 Nf6 2.Nc3 c5 3.g3 Nc6 4.Bg2 e6 5.Nf3 Be7 6.d4 d5 7.cxd5
7...Nxd5
7...exd5 is another option. White follows Rubinstein’s line against the Tarrasch Defence and is ready to
create pressure on the d5-pawn.
1023
Position after: 9...exd5
Comparing this position to the aforementioned line, one can conclude that Black has achieved
something. There is no dangerous knight on c3 and there is no Bg5 move – normally an important
resource for White in this line.
White has the idea of playing 12.b4 and then fianchettoing the bishop. Black reacts logically.
11...a5
1024
Position after: 11...a5
Black stopped 12.b4, but the inclusion of the 11th moves is clearly in White’s favour. The important
b4-square is not available to the black minor pieces. Meanwhile, the weakness on b3 is not significant,
and b5 will turn out to be a great spot for White’s queen. The next stage of the game should shed more
light on White’s very fine 11th move.
12.Ne1
Again, a very nice manoeuvre by Petrosian. He understood that it was impossible to establish a
blockade on the natural d4-square – Black controls it perfectly well. White sends the knight to the
excellent d3-square, while attacking the d5-pawn.
12...d4
12...Be6 13.Nd3 Ba7 14.Nf4 gives White the advantage of the bishop pair.
13.Nd3
1025
Position after: 13.Nd3
The d4-pawn is now safe, but take a look at the black queen, knight and dark-squared bishop. They are
all restricted by the d4-pawn. The d3-knight is an eternal blockading piece, so the black pieces may
remain passive for quite a while. I often say to less advanced students: “Avoid protecting your pawn
with 3 or more pieces...” Indeed, the rest of the game confirms that these words are good advice –
Black never manages to activate his pieces at all.
1026
Position after: 15...Bg4
The previous moves were very logical. Black finished development and it looks like he has more space
and more active pieces. Even if this is true, it will soon become clear that Black has problems
establishing harmony in his camp.
Meanwhile, White’s pieces will start dancing around the weak d4-pawn, mostly using the weakened
light squares on the queenside, creating various threats.
From now on, Black will be unable to rest until the end of the game. Due to the weak pawn on b7,
Black’s queenside pieces are cramped.
18...Be4
Played with the idea to reduce the pressure on the long light-squared diagonal. The downside is that the
queenside light squares will be under White’s control.
The c8-knight is not protected, so White transfers the rook to an excellent position on c2 with tempo.
From there, it can both protect the e2-pawn and pose threats of infiltration.
1027
Position after: 23.Rc1
Not 24...Rxe2 25.Qf3 and after capturing the b7-pawn, Black will be in huge trouble.
After some more or less forced moves, the situation is clearer. White’s pieces dominate the board,
1028
while Black’s are desperately passive. They must control the infiltration squares on the c-file and
protect the weak pawns d4, a5 and b7. However, nothing concrete is visible for White and the win is
still far away – some strategical skills are required. Unfortunately for Black, his opponent is the
brilliant strategician Petrosian. Petrosian begins to showcase his trademark: patient play. It seems like
he believes he will crush his opponent’s defences anyway, so he is more focused on eliminating
potential counterplay. Remember this while observing his playing rhythm; after a few patient moves he
makes an “active” one, and so on. By choosing such a rhythm, he aims to “hypnotise” and confuse the
opponent, who will be unable to determine the right moment to react. Let’s see the next, very
instructive stage of this magnificent game.
26...Nc6 27.h4!
This “active” move has the idea of securing the g5-square for the bishop and to attack the opponent’s
king.
30.Kf1!
One of the most beautiful moves I have ever seen. After a few patient moves, Petrosian plays an active
move with a hidden point. The king protects the e2-pawn, liberating the rook. Also, the king is now
closer to the centre – after potential exchanges of the major pieces, it could head to d3 and directly
attack the weak d4-pawn. The final idea: the king can go to b1 and White will then launch a pawn
attack on the kingside! A very deep move with so many hidden ideas. Such king walks became another
one of Petrosian’s trademarks. A very good prophylactic measure!
1029
30...Re6 31.Qb5 Na7 32.Qb3 Nc6 33.h5
Once again, after a couple of patient queen moves, White plays an active one.
33...Ne7 34.Ke1
34...Nd5 35.Qb5
A sad fate for the black pieces. The bishop must directly protect both the a5- and d4-pawns; and the b7-
pawn indirectly. Also, the queen must protect the bishop. Only the knight and rook have options,
although none of them would be a part of a reasonable plan. Black simply waits for White to take
action.
35...Nf6
35...Nxf4 36.Nxf4 would just increase White’s advantage – the knight is much better than the bishop!
1030
Position after: 38.g4
Everything is going smoothly: White steadily realises the plan of attacking the opponent’s king.
It is very difficult to count the black knight’s moves. The other pieces are spectators.
43.Kb1
1031
Position after: 43.Kb1
43...Ne7?
Finally, after a long resistance, Black makes a decisive mistake. After White’s next move, the bishop
will be exchanged for the knight and Black’s defences will come crashing down. Without the knight on
the board, Black will be unable to prevent the infiltration of White’s major pieces.
46...Kh7
1032
Position after: 46...Kh7
47.Rf8
47.Nf4 with a check on the light-squared diagonal was also very good.
47...Qc7 48.f4
1033
Position after: 50.Rxf7
A brilliant game teaching everyone how to patiently improve a position, stop counterplay, confuse the
opponent and, finally, convert an advantage.
Game 98
Henneberger – Nimzowitsch
Winterthur 1931
1034
Position after: 4...Nf6
5.Ng3
5...c5
5...e5 6.Nf3 [6.dxe5 Qxd1+ 7.Kxd1 Ng4 and Black has an initiative.] 6...exd4 7.Nxd4 Bc5 and Black
is doing well.
6.Bb5+
This allows for the fastest development but now the black bishop will be exchanged – after the natural
...e6, the c8-bishop can be bad.
A matter of style.
8.Nf3
8...Qa5+!?
A very interesting solution. The great Aron Nimzowitsch often preferred, after exchanging the light-
1035
squared bishops, to immediately transfer the queen to the a6-f1 diagonal in order to prevent the
opponent from castling. A nice manoeuvre.
9.c3 Qa6 10.Qe2 Qxe2+ 11.Nxe2 Rc8 12.0-0 e6 13.Bf4 Be7 14.Rfe1 Nd5
The previous moves were natural. Now, Black goes for a logical and excellent plan.
15.Bg3
15...c4!
A powerful concept. First of all, Black gains space on the queenside. Secondly, this move secures the
knight’s excellent position on d5. Finally, it fixes the white pawns on the dark c3- and d4-squares,
restricting White’s minor pieces.
16.Ne5!?
Clever idea. White wants to exchange the d7-knight and then use the e2-knight to exchange the knight
on d5. 16.Nf4 gives nothing to White, because after 16...Nxf4 17.Bxf4 Nb6 Black still controls the
important outpost on d5!
Necessary prophylaxis! It is very important to keep the d5-knight alive. Black prevented the move
19.Nf4. Now, the advantage undoubtedly belongs to Black. White will soon feel the lack of space and
there will be no promising plans available to him.
1036
Position after: 18...g5!
19.f4?!
White still dreams about exchanging the knights, which is natural. However, knowing his next moves,
he should have gone for another plan.
19...h6!
Of course.
19...g4 looks natural, but after 20.f5! exf5 21.Nf4 Nxf4 22.Bxf4 Black is not better.
1037
Position after: 21...b5!
White’s pieces are cramped. He can only respond to Black’s activities. Black can organise active play
on both flanks. On the kingside he wants to play ...g4 and ...f5, so he still must wait. It is time to create
queenside play – Black stands better here because White’s minor pieces cannot take part in the struggle.
It is very difficult to find the idea behind this move. Black seizes the opportunity...
23...g4!
1038
Position after: 23...g4!
Perfect timing!
24.Rf1 f5!
Black played ...g4 with tempo and followed up ...f5. Now White is desperately lost. His minor pieces
would rather swap places... White can no longer play f5 – his minor pieces are fully paralysed.
25.Bf2 Rg8!?
1039
Position after: 25...Rg8!?
30...Ke7!
Black wants to optimally place all of his pieces before commencing pawn action. The king approaches
the d5-square (or even a4) in order to be ready for the endgame. If the opponent is in a hopeless
situation, desperately passive and can only react to our activities; if we dominate both in the centre and
on both flanks; if we have better “communication lines” due to a space or mobility advantage... the
most important advice is “Don’t rush!”. By playing patiently, we will probably confuse the opponent,
maybe even provoke a mistake, and reduce the chances of making a mistake ourselves.
1040
Position after: 33.Ra1
33...hxg3!?
Interesting move order. It looks like Black wants to exchange rooks on the h-file... and win the game on
the opposite flank.
33...Rch8 34.Bg1 holding on for dear life.
1041
Position after: 38...b4!
Notice the difference in activity between the black and white troops. Black is winning.
39.Kg2 a4
42...Kb5?
1042
Position after: 48.Ke3
43.Nc3+!
Now Black must show much more technique in order to win the game.
43...Bxc3! 44.bxc3
1043
Position after: 44.bxc3
44...Kc6
It is clear that Black must get his king to e4. The knight must be used to deflect the white troops, maybe
using zugzwang motifs...
48...Kd6!!
Triangulation! The white king cannot do the same – the squares d2 and f2 are taken by the black
knight!
48...Nd6 gives nothing. After 49.Bd2 Nb5 50.Be1 Na3 51.Bd2 Nb1 52.Be1
1044
Position after: 52.Be1
Black achieves nothing. It is clear that with White to move, it’s a zugzwang. So, Black must lose a
tempo. But, if the black king makes a triangle, the white king will do the same! No progress is possible!
51.Ke2
1045
51.a3 Nd6 52.Bd2 Nb5–+
Mission accomplished!
54.Bc1
A picturesque situation. Both minor pieces are paralysed. How to proceed? Black needs to lose a tempo
to obtain the same position with White to move. White’s king cannot triangulate because it must
control the d2-square!
1046
Position after: 60...Kf3
61.Bb2! axb2!
61...Kxg3? 62.Bxa3 Kf3 [62...Kxf4 63.Bd6+] 63.d5 exd5 64.Bc5 and, surprisingly, White wins!
This move secures the win. The point will soon be apparent.
1047
64.a6 g3 65.a7 g2 66.a8=Q g1=Q+ 67.Kxb2 Qg2+!
68.Qxg2+ Kxg2 69.Ka3 Kf3 70.Kb4 Kxf4 71.Kxc4 Ke3 72.d5 exd5+ 73.Kxd5 f4 74.c4 f3 75.c5 f2
76.c6 f1=Q
White resigned.
Finally, Black won. What a roller-coaster! A few times, it looked like White may survive. However, the
black pieces were led by Aron Nimzowitsch, a great master whose trademarks included positions with a
knight dominating over a bishop and prophylactic tendencies. Thanks to his bad move, 42...Kb5, we
now have the opportunity to enjoy that endgame over and over again. Black’s knight danced around,
ended up being paralysed, and then sacrificed while the black king triangulated twice! Indeed, an
absolutely amazing endgame!
0-1
Game 99
Saunders – Jacimovic
Pula 1997
Not as popular a line as 3...Nf6 or 3...c5. Though this move deserves a better reputation.
1048
4.Ngf3 Nf6 5.e5 Nd7
Black’s knight retreats to d7 and the thematic ...c5 blow is unavailable. However, Black has chances to
advance ...f6 in some lines, undermining White’s centre. Meanwhile, White’s d2-knight hinders the
other pieces and his kingside initiative is momentarily delayed.
Other options included 6.Bd3, 6.Be2, 6.Bb5, 6.c3 – Black always gets some play.
6.Nb3 a5 7.a4
7.Bf4 a4 8.Nc1 Bb4+ 9.c3 a3 is an interesting line, illustrating the various possibilities available to
Black.
7...Be7
It is very important for Black to keep the f3-knight in check. While on f3, it closes the diagonal for the
white queen.
8.c3 b6
1049
Position after: 8...b6
9.Bd3
9.Bf4 0-0 Black would wait for the f1-bishop to move before offering its exchange on a6.
9...Ba6
9...Ncb8 is another option, perhaps even more flexible. Black would be able to recapture on a6 with the
knight while giving way to the c7-pawn.
1050
Position after: 11...0-0
12.Re1
White could “gain” a tempo with 12.Qd3, but actually it would just lead to a transposition.
12...Ncb8 13.Be3
13.Qe2 was probably more accurate. In case of 13...c5 [13...Ra7 is more precise.], White would have an
important resource available to him: 14.c4. The point is that Black cannot protect the d5-pawn with a
knight and this should give White the initiative.
1051
Position after: 15.Qe2
15...Ra8
The game has entered a middlegame which is very comfortable for Black. White has no advantage at
all and probably started to feel uncomfortable. Many players in such situations make a similar mistake
– they start to play sharply. White’s next move is a very typical mistake that you should remember. He
thinks he should attack on the kingside, but there is no attack. Instead, White should consolidate his
position patiently, waiting for the right moment for an attack.
15...Ra7 would lead to faster doubling later on. However, Black wanted to leave the a7-square free for
the knight in case the white queen came to b5.
16.g4?
1052
Position after: 16.g4?
A bad move, only weakening White’s kingside. Black’s knight is not even on f5! So, what ideas could
be behind this move? Perhaps to advance f4-f5. But Black can easily parry this by playing ...f5 himself!
In the game, White was inconsistent – after this move he switched to play on the queenside. Indeed,
inconsistency, not flexibility! Be consistent in your games, carefully choose and follow your plans.
16...Re8
Black places the rook opposite the white queen and vacates the f8-square for the bishop or knight.
16...Rc8, keeping the rook on the f-file to keep ...f5 as a resource, was also OK.
17.Kg2 Qc8
1053
Position after: 17...Qc8
I like this manoeuvre. Black starts using the weak light squares and prepares to exchange queens.
Without queens on the board, the action would take place on the queenside – which is clearly in
Black’s favour.
19...Rxa6 20.Nb1!
1054
Position after: 20.Nb1!
20...Rc8
20...c4 is perhaps more precise – the point is that White cannot play 21.b3.
21.Ne1
21...Raa8 22.Na3 c4
Black is consistent. He transfers the game into an endgame in which the white bishop will be
desperately bad.
23.Nec2
1055
Position after: 23.Nec2
23...Na7!
The c8-rook acts as a deterrent against the move b3. Black also prepares the advance ...b5. Very good
prophylaxis – Black has time to organise queenside play, there is no need to rush.
24.Rcb1 b5
25.Nxb5
25.axb5 a4! Black will recapture on b5 later on, with ensuing threats on the b-file.
1056
Position after: 27...Rcb8
28.Na3?!
White wants to protect the b5-pawn. However, this just gives Black the chance to exchange the bishop
for the knight at the right moment, transferring from a complex endgame into a dream endgame with an
excellent knight versus a bad white bishop.
1057
Position after: 32...Kc7
33.Bd2
33.f4 should be played sooner or later. White’s only chance is to get some counterplay going on the
kingside. Playing only on the queenside would result in a hopeless situation for him.
33...Rh8!
Psychologically, a very important moment. The great Nimzowitsch would call it a “mysterious rook
move”. The point is clear: after the move f4, Black will strike back with ...h5, provoking new
weaknesses on the kingside.
34.Kf3
34...Rb8 35.Ke2
1058
Position after: 35.Ke2
White decides to wait. However, some activity was required in order to survive.
37.f4 was correct. Black’s rook cannot easily be transferred to h8 to support ...h5.
1059
41...Bxa3
42.Rxa3
42...Nxb5 43.R3a2
Black is better in this endgame, though it is difficult to make progress. There are no open paths for
infiltration. Furthermore, White does not have two weaknesses. The b2-pawn, together with the weak
squares on the queenside, can be counted as one weakness. Hence, according to the famous principle,
Black must create another weakness on the kingside. Otherwise, it would probably be impossible to
win the game. So, his plan is clear. The first phase is regrouping on the queenside – the knight should
protect the a4-pawn and the rooks should be doubled on the b-file. The threat of ...a3 must be persistent
in order to paralyse the white pieces. The second phase is the creation of a weakness on the kingside.
1060
Position after: 46.Bg5
46...Kd7!
Preventing 47.Be7!.
1061
Position after: 54.Bd2
54...f6
Capturing on e5 would give nothing – White would activate the bishop after dxe5.
58.Rf2
58...g6
1062
Position after: 58...g6
59.Rf1
Preventing ...a3.
61.gxf5 exf5! Black’s king is close to the kingside where Black will prepare ...g5, after transferring the
knight to e6.
1063
Position after: 62...Rf8
63.Rf2
63.g5?! h6 64.h4 hxg5 65.fxg5 [65.hxg5 Rh8 is very uncomfortable for White.] 65...Rh8 66.Rh1 Rh5
67.Ra1 Rb5 68.Bd2 Ra5 69.Rh2 was perhaps another option to hold.
1064
63...fxg4!?
A typical approach in such a pawn setup. Black creates an outside passed pawn and obtains the f5-
square for his pieces.
His e-pawn should be able to stop the two white pawns.
64.hxg4 h5
65.g5?
During the entire game, White opted for static defence. That was the last chance to get some activity.
65.gxh5! gxh5 66.Rg2! was a better defence, although it is difficult to play with Black’s rooks behind
the pawn after 66...Rh8 [66...Kf7 would be an interesting move and should be analysed]. However,
White would actually have dangerous counterplay after 67.f5! exf5 68.Rg7+
1065
Position after: 68.Rg7+
65...Ra8 66.Rh2
66...Kf7
The king goes to g7. Black will be ready to sacrifice the h-pawn in order to deflect the white rook from
1066
the queenside. Again, good prophylaxis.
66...Kd7 was more logical. The king is needed more on the queenside. Black should not be afraid of the
f5-advance as he will always have ...exf5.
Now Black’s plan is clear. He wants to sacrifice the a-pawn to vacate the square for the knight. White
will lose either the a- or c-pawn in force. Black’s h-pawn can also be sacrificed to deflect the white
rook from the protection of the c3-pawn, which is why the black king controls the h-file.
1067
Position after: 71...Kf7
72.Bd2?
72...Rxa3 73.Rh2?
1068
Position after: 74...Nc8
is much better for Black. The knight has two good routes: ...Nc8-e7-f5 and ...Nc8-a7-c6-a5-b3.
73...Ra2+ 74.Kc1
74...Nxc3
1069
75.Rh3 Ne2+ 76.Kd1 Nxd4 77.Bb4 Ra4 78.Bd6 Nf5 79.Rc3 h4 80.Ke2 Ra2+ 81.Kf3 h3 82.Rc1 h2
83.Rb1 d4 84.Kg4 Ke8 85.Bc5 Kd7 86.Rd1 Ne3+
White resigned. A very instructive game, demonstrating how to use prophylaxis and how to create
pressure in positions with no promising active play for the opponent. Analysing the game more deeply,
it looks holdable for White. However, this is no easy task in a real chess game. White did miss some
chances for active play, but Black’s patient and logical play still deserves credit and attention. Black
did his best to make White’s task as complicated as possible.
0-1
Game 100
Johner – Nimzowitsch
Dresden 1926
1.d4 Nf6 2.c4 e6 3.Nc3 Bb4 4.e3 0-0 5.Bd3 c5 6.Nf3 Nc6 7.0-0
7...Bxc3
No wonder this defence is named after the great Aron Nimzowitsch. He was the first to give detailed
explanations of plans for both sides. With his significant contributions, the Nimzo-Indian Defence is
one of the most popular openings today. With his last move, Black wants to damage White’s pawn
structure and neutralise White’s bishops – especially the dark-squared one.
8.bxc3 d6
1070
Position after: 8...d6
In this position, patient manoeuvring is on the agenda. White wants to somehow force Black to capture
on d4, which would activate the c1-bishop. Black, on the other hand, wants to keep the pawn stable on
c5 – it is extremely important to keep the a1-h8 diagonal closed.
9.Nd2!?
Played with an interesting prophylactic idea. White wants to control the a5-square and prevent Black
from obtaining the typical setup with ...b6, ...Ba6 and ...Na5.
9.e4 e5 10.d5 Na5∞ [10...Ne7!?]
9...b6
Black should avoid closing the position with 9...e5 10.d5 when the b1-h7 diagonal is still open for the
d3-bishop. It is better to wait for White to play e4 first.
10.Nb3
10.f4!?
1071
Position after: 10.f4!?
was suggested as better by some commentators because it prevents the move ...e5. However, 10...Ba6
with the idea of playing 11...d5 gives Black solid play.
10...e5!
This is a logical reaction now! Black cannot put pressure on the c4-pawn as the a5-square is taken!
1072
Hence, the bishop does not belong on a6. Using the fact that the white knight is temporarily out of play,
Black activates his pieces towards the kingside. The c4-pawn will be a weakness for a long time –
Black can attack it later!
11.f4
11...e4!
11...Qe7 12.fxe5 dxe5 13.d5 Nd8 14.e4 Ne8 and installing the knight on the ultra-powerful d6-square
is fine for Black, but he wants more...
12.Be2
12...Qd7!!
As Aron Nimzowitsch stated in his important work My System: “Black spots that White has a
qualitative kingside pawn majority with his f-, g- and h- pawns. The text move involves a complicated
procedure to restrain it!” According to Nimzowitsch, only this move gives Black the chance to play for
a win. This is the prelude to one of the best and most beautiful prophylactic manoeuvres ever.
12...Ne8 13.g4 [13.f5 Qg5] 13...f5 14.dxc5!? [14.d5 Ne7 15.g5 results in a closed position that
Nimzowitsch wanted to avoid.] 14...dxc5 15.Qd5+ Qxd5 16.cxd5 Ne7 17.Rd1 Nd6 leads to a very
interesting and unclear position.
1073
13.h3
13...Ne7
14.Qe1
A) 14.Bd2
A1) 14...h5 is one good option: 15.Be1 [15.Bxh5? Nxh5 16.Qxh5 Ba6 winning the very important c4-
pawn back and being left with the much better bishop.] 15...Nf5 16.Bf2 h4 with promising play on both
sides.
A2) 14...Nf5 pressuring the e3-pawn and intending to jump to g3 – simple and good.
B) 14.g4?! would be a risky attempt. After 14...h5 15.f5 [15.g5 Ne8 White is in trouble.] 15...Qc7
16.d5
1074
Position after: 16.d5
closing the b8-h2 diagonal. 16...b5! destroys White’s centre and enables access to the light-squared
weaknesses in White’s camp.
14...h5!
No doubt that Nimzowitsch had this in mind when playing his amazing 12th move. Now Black
gradually paralyses White’s kingside.
1075
15.Bd2
Isn’t chess beautiful? Black spent three moves on transferring his queen to h7!? Yes. Indeed, it is a
brilliant concept with an amazing prophylactic idea behind it. White only has chances on the kingside
due to his qualitative majority. The result depends on whether it can be activated or not. Black’s
strategy will prevail thanks to the astonishing Qd7-Qf5-Qh7 manoeuvre; White’s pawn avalanche will
be stopped. Furthermore, Black will use the pieces that he transferred to the kingside to orchestrate an
attack on the white monarch!
17.a4
Aiming for counterplay on the opposite flank, which is not the correct strategy. However, it is already
difficult to suggest something better.
17...Nf5
Threatening 18...Ng4.
18.g3
1076
Position after: 18.g3
18...a5
Nimzowitsch was always preoccupied with prophylaxis. Alas, his last move was not as necessary as
blocking White’s kingside avalanche.
18...h4 was a direct and stronger approach.
19.Rg1 Nh6
19...Kh8 with the same plan as in the game was also good. Black wanted to prematurely open his
bishop.
1077
Position after: 21...Rac8
Posing threats to the c4-pawn. In this stage of the game, Nimzowitsch’s play is not that good. Perhaps
he faced time trouble, or simply was not ready for aggression.
22.d5 Kh8!
Finally, after White definitively closes the centre, Black goes for a decisive attack on the kingside – the
g-file will come in very handy.
23.Nd2
1078
Position after: 25.Nf1
25...Rg7
25...h4 26.gxh4 [26.g4 Nhxg4+ 27.hxg4 Nxg4+ 28.Kh1 h3 is winning.] 26...g4 with infiltration on the
weak light squares on the kingside was good enough, but Nimzowitsch played methodically – he
wanted to double first.
1079
Position after: 28.Qd1
28...gxf4!
29.exf4 Bc8?
30.hxg4 [30.Kg2 Nh4+ What a picture! 31.gxh4 Ne3+–+] 30...h4 was winning immediately.
1080
Position after: 31...Nh4
32.Re3
1081
32...Bc8 33.Qc2
33...Bxh3! 34.Bxe4
34...Bf5
35.Bxf5 Nxf5
1082
Position after: 35...Nxf5
Please, take a look at the black pieces. They are all targeting the poor white king! Meanwhile, White’s
pieces appear almost randomly placed behind their ruined pawn structure.
36.Re2 h4
An amazing defeat. One of the most important games for understanding the concept of prophylaxis.
0-1
1083
Index of Games
1084
31. Karpov – Unzicker Nice 1974
32. Nimzowitsch – Capablanca New York 1927
33. Nimzowitsch – Tarrasch Breslau 1925
34. Petrosian – Unzicker Hamburg 1960
35. Sveshnikov – Balashov Moscow 1976
36. Marshall – Capablanca New York 1909
37. Erenburg – Murariu Las Palmas 2003
38. Radulov – Pinter Pernik 1978
39. Ivkov – Taimanov Belgrade 1956
40. Botvinnik – Zagoriansky Sverdlovsk 1943
41. Karpov – Sokolov Brussels 1988
42. Andersson – Tal Malmo 1983
43. Polgar – Anand Wijk aan Zee 1998
44. Geller – Bolbochan Stockholm 1962
45. Marshall – Capablanca New York 1927
46. Lasker – Capablanca Belgrade 1921
47. Flohr – Vidmar Nottingham 1936
48. Botvinnik – Szilagyi Amsterdam 1966
49. Petrosian – Bannik Riga 1958
50. Geller – Bertok Belgrade 1961
51. Fischer – Durao Havana 1966
52. Larsen – Nielsen Esbjerg 1953
53. Steinitz – Sellman Baltimore 1885
54. Ubilava – Timoscenko Soviet Union 1974
55. Karpov – Hjartarson Seattle 1989
56. Van der Sterren – Ljubojevic Amsterdam 1999
57. Alatortsev – Levenfish Tbilisi 1937
58. Karpov – Spassky Leningrad 1974
59. Guimard – Euwe Groningen 1946
60. Khalifman – Adams Groningen 1990
61. Petrosian – Botvinnik Moscow 1963
62. Krasenkow – Protaziuk Suwalki 1999
1085
63. Gorodetzky – Radovanovic Veliko Gradiste 2016
64. Alekhine – Chajes Karlsbad 1923
65. Smyslov – Letelier Venice 1950
66. Najdorf – Geller Zuerich 1953
67. Kosten – Chabanon Cannes 2004
68. Paulsen – Tarrasch Nuremberg 1888
69. Clarke – Petrosian Munich 1958
70. Nimzowitsch – Salwe Karlsbad 1911
71. Petrosian – Lutikov Tbilisi 1959
72. Rubinstein – Duras Karlsbad 1911
73. Capablanca – Chajes New York 1915
74. Rosselli del Turco – Rubinstein Baden-Baden 1925
75. Jacimovic – Jakovljevic Tivat 1995
76. Nimzowitsch – Rubinstein Dresden 1926
77. Zajic – Petkov Kragujevac 2015
78. Werle – L’Ami Leeuwarden 2005
79. Tkachiev – Mikhalevski Ohrid 2001
80. Fine – Alekhine Netherlands 1938
81. Zlatanovic – Djuric Lipnicki Sor 2008
82. Zlatanovic – Lekic Smederevska Palanka 2016
83. Spassky – Kavalek Montreal 1979
84. Alekhine – Teichmann Berlin 1921
85. Kasparov – Kramnik Astana 2001
86. Keres – Kotov Parnu 1947
87. Rubinstein – Salwe Lodz 1908
88. Smyslov – Denker Moscow 1946
89. Tarrasch – Teichmann San Sebastian 1912
90. Bondarevsky – Smyslov Moscow 1946
91. Szostko – Zlatanovic Plovdiv 2015
92. Rauzer – Riumin Leningrad 1936
93. Solmundarson – Smyslov Reykjavik 1974
94. Zlatanovic – Brankovic Paracin 2016
1086
95. Capablanca – Ragozin Moscow 1935
96. Soysal – Marjanovic Banja Vrujci 2017
97. Petrosian – Peters Lone Pine 1976
98. Henneberger – Nimzowitsch Winterthur 1931
99. Saunders – Jacimovic Pula 1997
100. Johner – Nimzowitsch Dresden 1926
1087
Table of Contents
Title page 4
Key to Symbols 5
Biography 6
Preface 7
Games 1-4 9
Games 5-8 52
Games 9-13 85
Games 14-16 141
Games 17-21 183
Games 22-26 236
Games 27-31 293
Games 32-35 347
Pawn Majorities (Games 36-39) 395
Isolated Pawns (Games 40-42) 439
Backward Pawns (Games 43-44) 465
Pawn Weaknesses I (Games 45-49) 491
Pawn Weaknesses II (Games 50-55) 548
Key Squares I (Games 56-61) 597
Key Squares II (Games 62-67) 657
Pawn Chains (Games 68-71) 727
Games 72-74 769
Games 75-78 801
Games 79-82 842
Games 83-86 884
Games 87-91 923
Games 92-96 972
Games 97-100 1023
Index of Games 1084
1088